1 |
205 |
julius |
\input texinfo @c -*-Texinfo-*-
|
2 |
|
|
@c Copyright 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000,
|
3 |
|
|
@c 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
|
4 |
|
|
@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
5 |
|
|
@c UPDATE!! On future updates--
|
6 |
|
|
@c (1) check for new machine-dep cmdline options in
|
7 |
|
|
@c md_parse_option definitions in config/tc-*.c
|
8 |
|
|
@c (2) for platform-specific directives, examine md_pseudo_op
|
9 |
|
|
@c in config/tc-*.c
|
10 |
|
|
@c (3) for object-format specific directives, examine obj_pseudo_op
|
11 |
|
|
@c in config/obj-*.c
|
12 |
|
|
@c (4) portable directives in potable[] in read.c
|
13 |
|
|
@c %**start of header
|
14 |
|
|
@setfilename as.info
|
15 |
|
|
@c ---config---
|
16 |
|
|
@macro gcctabopt{body}
|
17 |
|
|
@code{\body\}
|
18 |
|
|
@end macro
|
19 |
|
|
@c defaults, config file may override:
|
20 |
|
|
@set have-stabs
|
21 |
|
|
@c ---
|
22 |
|
|
@c man begin NAME
|
23 |
|
|
@c ---
|
24 |
|
|
@include asconfig.texi
|
25 |
|
|
@include bfdver.texi
|
26 |
|
|
@c ---
|
27 |
|
|
@c man end
|
28 |
|
|
@c ---
|
29 |
|
|
@c common OR combinations of conditions
|
30 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
31 |
|
|
@set COFF-ELF
|
32 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
33 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
34 |
|
|
@set COFF-ELF
|
35 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
36 |
|
|
@ifset AOUT
|
37 |
|
|
@set aout-bout
|
38 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
39 |
|
|
@ifset ARM/Thumb
|
40 |
|
|
@set ARM
|
41 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
42 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
43 |
|
|
@set aout-bout
|
44 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
45 |
|
|
@ifset H8/300
|
46 |
|
|
@set H8
|
47 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
48 |
|
|
@ifset SH
|
49 |
|
|
@set H8
|
50 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
51 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
52 |
|
|
@set abnormal-separator
|
53 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
54 |
|
|
@c ------------
|
55 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
56 |
|
|
@settitle Using @value{AS}
|
57 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
58 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
59 |
|
|
@settitle Using @value{AS} (@value{TARGET})
|
60 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
61 |
|
|
@setchapternewpage odd
|
62 |
|
|
@c %**end of header
|
63 |
|
|
|
64 |
|
|
@c @smallbook
|
65 |
|
|
@c @set SMALL
|
66 |
|
|
@c WARE! Some of the machine-dependent sections contain tables of machine
|
67 |
|
|
@c instructions. Except in multi-column format, these tables look silly.
|
68 |
|
|
@c Unfortunately, Texinfo doesn't have a general-purpose multi-col format, so
|
69 |
|
|
@c the multi-col format is faked within @example sections.
|
70 |
|
|
@c
|
71 |
|
|
@c Again unfortunately, the natural size that fits on a page, for these tables,
|
72 |
|
|
@c is different depending on whether or not smallbook is turned on.
|
73 |
|
|
@c This matters, because of order: text flow switches columns at each page
|
74 |
|
|
@c break.
|
75 |
|
|
@c
|
76 |
|
|
@c The format faked in this source works reasonably well for smallbook,
|
77 |
|
|
@c not well for the default large-page format. This manual expects that if you
|
78 |
|
|
@c turn on @smallbook, you will also uncomment the "@set SMALL" to enable the
|
79 |
|
|
@c tables in question. You can turn on one without the other at your
|
80 |
|
|
@c discretion, of course.
|
81 |
|
|
@ifinfo
|
82 |
|
|
@set SMALL
|
83 |
|
|
@c the insn tables look just as silly in info files regardless of smallbook,
|
84 |
|
|
@c might as well show 'em anyways.
|
85 |
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
86 |
|
|
|
87 |
|
|
@ifinfo
|
88 |
|
|
@format
|
89 |
|
|
START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
|
90 |
|
|
* As: (as). The GNU assembler.
|
91 |
|
|
* Gas: (as). The GNU assembler.
|
92 |
|
|
END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
|
93 |
|
|
@end format
|
94 |
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
95 |
|
|
|
96 |
|
|
@finalout
|
97 |
|
|
@syncodeindex ky cp
|
98 |
|
|
|
99 |
|
|
@copying
|
100 |
|
|
This file documents the GNU Assembler "@value{AS}".
|
101 |
|
|
|
102 |
|
|
@c man begin COPYRIGHT
|
103 |
|
|
Copyright @copyright{} 1991, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99, 2000, 2001, 2002,
|
104 |
|
|
2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
105 |
|
|
|
106 |
|
|
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
|
107 |
|
|
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
|
108 |
|
|
or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
|
109 |
|
|
with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
|
110 |
|
|
Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
|
111 |
|
|
section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
|
112 |
|
|
|
113 |
|
|
@c man end
|
114 |
|
|
@end copying
|
115 |
|
|
|
116 |
|
|
@titlepage
|
117 |
|
|
@title Using @value{AS}
|
118 |
|
|
@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Assembler
|
119 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
120 |
|
|
@subtitle for the @value{TARGET} family
|
121 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
122 |
|
|
@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
|
123 |
|
|
@sp 1
|
124 |
|
|
@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
|
125 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
126 |
|
|
@sp 1
|
127 |
|
|
@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
|
128 |
|
|
@sp 1
|
129 |
|
|
@sp 13
|
130 |
|
|
The Free Software Foundation Inc.@: thanks The Nice Computer
|
131 |
|
|
Company of Australia for loaning Dean Elsner to write the
|
132 |
|
|
first (Vax) version of @command{as} for Project @sc{gnu}.
|
133 |
|
|
The proprietors, management and staff of TNCCA thank FSF for
|
134 |
|
|
distracting the boss while they got some work
|
135 |
|
|
done.
|
136 |
|
|
@sp 3
|
137 |
|
|
@author Dean Elsner, Jay Fenlason & friends
|
138 |
|
|
@page
|
139 |
|
|
@tex
|
140 |
|
|
{\parskip=0pt
|
141 |
|
|
\hfill {\it Using {\tt @value{AS}}}\par
|
142 |
|
|
\hfill Edited by Cygnus Support\par
|
143 |
|
|
}
|
144 |
|
|
%"boxit" macro for figures:
|
145 |
|
|
%Modified from Knuth's ``boxit'' macro from TeXbook (answer to exercise 21.3)
|
146 |
|
|
\gdef\boxit#1#2{\vbox{\hrule\hbox{\vrule\kern3pt
|
147 |
|
|
\vbox{\parindent=0pt\parskip=0pt\hsize=#1\kern3pt\strut\hfil
|
148 |
|
|
#2\hfil\strut\kern3pt}\kern3pt\vrule}\hrule}}%box with visible outline
|
149 |
|
|
\gdef\ibox#1#2{\hbox to #1{#2\hfil}\kern8pt}% invisible box
|
150 |
|
|
@end tex
|
151 |
|
|
|
152 |
|
|
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
|
153 |
|
|
Copyright @copyright{} 1991, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99, 2000, 2001, 2002,
|
154 |
|
|
2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
155 |
|
|
|
156 |
|
|
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
|
157 |
|
|
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
|
158 |
|
|
or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
|
159 |
|
|
with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
|
160 |
|
|
Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
|
161 |
|
|
section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
|
162 |
|
|
|
163 |
|
|
@end titlepage
|
164 |
|
|
@contents
|
165 |
|
|
|
166 |
|
|
@ifnottex
|
167 |
|
|
@node Top
|
168 |
|
|
@top Using @value{AS}
|
169 |
|
|
|
170 |
|
|
This file is a user guide to the @sc{gnu} assembler @command{@value{AS}}
|
171 |
|
|
@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
|
172 |
|
|
@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
|
173 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
174 |
|
|
version @value{VERSION}.
|
175 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
176 |
|
|
This version of the file describes @command{@value{AS}} configured to generate
|
177 |
|
|
code for @value{TARGET} architectures.
|
178 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
179 |
|
|
|
180 |
|
|
This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
|
181 |
|
|
Documentation License. A copy of the license is included in the
|
182 |
|
|
section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
|
183 |
|
|
|
184 |
|
|
@menu
|
185 |
|
|
* Overview:: Overview
|
186 |
|
|
* Invoking:: Command-Line Options
|
187 |
|
|
* Syntax:: Syntax
|
188 |
|
|
* Sections:: Sections and Relocation
|
189 |
|
|
* Symbols:: Symbols
|
190 |
|
|
* Expressions:: Expressions
|
191 |
|
|
* Pseudo Ops:: Assembler Directives
|
192 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
193 |
|
|
* Object Attributes:: Object Attributes
|
194 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
195 |
|
|
* Machine Dependencies:: Machine Dependent Features
|
196 |
|
|
* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
|
197 |
|
|
* Acknowledgements:: Who Did What
|
198 |
|
|
* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
|
199 |
|
|
* AS Index:: AS Index
|
200 |
|
|
@end menu
|
201 |
|
|
@end ifnottex
|
202 |
|
|
|
203 |
|
|
@node Overview
|
204 |
|
|
@chapter Overview
|
205 |
|
|
@iftex
|
206 |
|
|
This manual is a user guide to the @sc{gnu} assembler @command{@value{AS}}.
|
207 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
208 |
|
|
This version of the manual describes @command{@value{AS}} configured to generate
|
209 |
|
|
code for @value{TARGET} architectures.
|
210 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
211 |
|
|
@end iftex
|
212 |
|
|
|
213 |
|
|
@cindex invocation summary
|
214 |
|
|
@cindex option summary
|
215 |
|
|
@cindex summary of options
|
216 |
|
|
Here is a brief summary of how to invoke @command{@value{AS}}. For details,
|
217 |
|
|
see @ref{Invoking,,Command-Line Options}.
|
218 |
|
|
|
219 |
|
|
@c man title AS the portable GNU assembler.
|
220 |
|
|
|
221 |
|
|
@ignore
|
222 |
|
|
@c man begin SEEALSO
|
223 |
|
|
gcc(1), ld(1), and the Info entries for @file{binutils} and @file{ld}.
|
224 |
|
|
@c man end
|
225 |
|
|
@end ignore
|
226 |
|
|
|
227 |
|
|
@c We don't use deffn and friends for the following because they seem
|
228 |
|
|
@c to be limited to one line for the header.
|
229 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
230 |
|
|
@c man begin SYNOPSIS
|
231 |
|
|
@value{AS} [@b{-a}[@b{cdghlns}][=@var{file}]] [@b{--alternate}] [@b{-D}]
|
232 |
|
|
[@b{--debug-prefix-map} @var{old}=@var{new}]
|
233 |
|
|
[@b{--defsym} @var{sym}=@var{val}] [@b{-f}] [@b{-g}] [@b{--gstabs}]
|
234 |
|
|
[@b{--gstabs+}] [@b{--gdwarf-2}] [@b{--help}] [@b{-I} @var{dir}] [@b{-J}]
|
235 |
|
|
[@b{-K}] [@b{-L}] [@b{--listing-lhs-width}=@var{NUM}]
|
236 |
|
|
[@b{--listing-lhs-width2}=@var{NUM}] [@b{--listing-rhs-width}=@var{NUM}]
|
237 |
|
|
[@b{--listing-cont-lines}=@var{NUM}] [@b{--keep-locals}] [@b{-o}
|
238 |
|
|
@var{objfile}] [@b{-R}] [@b{--reduce-memory-overheads}] [@b{--statistics}]
|
239 |
|
|
[@b{-v}] [@b{-version}] [@b{--version}] [@b{-W}] [@b{--warn}]
|
240 |
|
|
[@b{--fatal-warnings}] [@b{-w}] [@b{-x}] [@b{-Z}] [@b{@@@var{FILE}}]
|
241 |
|
|
[@b{--target-help}] [@var{target-options}]
|
242 |
|
|
[@b{--}|@var{files} @dots{}]
|
243 |
|
|
@c
|
244 |
|
|
@c Target dependent options are listed below. Keep the list sorted.
|
245 |
|
|
@c Add an empty line for separation.
|
246 |
|
|
@ifset ALPHA
|
247 |
|
|
|
248 |
|
|
@emph{Target Alpha options:}
|
249 |
|
|
[@b{-m@var{cpu}}]
|
250 |
|
|
[@b{-mdebug} | @b{-no-mdebug}]
|
251 |
|
|
[@b{-replace} | @b{-noreplace}]
|
252 |
|
|
[@b{-relax}] [@b{-g}] [@b{-G@var{size}}]
|
253 |
|
|
[@b{-F}] [@b{-32addr}]
|
254 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
255 |
|
|
@ifset ARC
|
256 |
|
|
|
257 |
|
|
@emph{Target ARC options:}
|
258 |
|
|
[@b{-marc[5|6|7|8]}]
|
259 |
|
|
[@b{-EB}|@b{-EL}]
|
260 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
261 |
|
|
@ifset ARM
|
262 |
|
|
|
263 |
|
|
@emph{Target ARM options:}
|
264 |
|
|
@c Don't document the deprecated options
|
265 |
|
|
[@b{-mcpu}=@var{processor}[+@var{extension}@dots{}]]
|
266 |
|
|
[@b{-march}=@var{architecture}[+@var{extension}@dots{}]]
|
267 |
|
|
[@b{-mfpu}=@var{floating-point-format}]
|
268 |
|
|
[@b{-mfloat-abi}=@var{abi}]
|
269 |
|
|
[@b{-meabi}=@var{ver}]
|
270 |
|
|
[@b{-mthumb}]
|
271 |
|
|
[@b{-EB}|@b{-EL}]
|
272 |
|
|
[@b{-mapcs-32}|@b{-mapcs-26}|@b{-mapcs-float}|
|
273 |
|
|
@b{-mapcs-reentrant}]
|
274 |
|
|
[@b{-mthumb-interwork}] [@b{-k}]
|
275 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
276 |
|
|
@ifset CRIS
|
277 |
|
|
|
278 |
|
|
@emph{Target CRIS options:}
|
279 |
|
|
[@b{--underscore} | @b{--no-underscore}]
|
280 |
|
|
[@b{--pic}] [@b{-N}]
|
281 |
|
|
[@b{--emulation=criself} | @b{--emulation=crisaout}]
|
282 |
|
|
[@b{--march=v0_v10} | @b{--march=v10} | @b{--march=v32} | @b{--march=common_v10_v32}]
|
283 |
|
|
@c Deprecated -- deliberately not documented.
|
284 |
|
|
@c [@b{-h}] [@b{-H}]
|
285 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
286 |
|
|
@ifset D10V
|
287 |
|
|
|
288 |
|
|
@emph{Target D10V options:}
|
289 |
|
|
[@b{-O}]
|
290 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
291 |
|
|
@ifset D30V
|
292 |
|
|
|
293 |
|
|
@emph{Target D30V options:}
|
294 |
|
|
[@b{-O}|@b{-n}|@b{-N}]
|
295 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
296 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
297 |
|
|
|
298 |
|
|
@emph{Target H8/300 options:}
|
299 |
|
|
[-h-tick-hex]
|
300 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
301 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
302 |
|
|
@c HPPA has no machine-dependent assembler options (yet).
|
303 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
304 |
|
|
@ifset I80386
|
305 |
|
|
|
306 |
|
|
@emph{Target i386 options:}
|
307 |
|
|
[@b{--32}|@b{--64}] [@b{-n}]
|
308 |
|
|
[@b{-march}=@var{CPU}[+@var{EXTENSION}@dots{}]] [@b{-mtune}=@var{CPU}]
|
309 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
310 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
311 |
|
|
|
312 |
|
|
@emph{Target i960 options:}
|
313 |
|
|
@c see md_parse_option in tc-i960.c
|
314 |
|
|
[@b{-ACA}|@b{-ACA_A}|@b{-ACB}|@b{-ACC}|@b{-AKA}|@b{-AKB}|
|
315 |
|
|
@b{-AKC}|@b{-AMC}]
|
316 |
|
|
[@b{-b}] [@b{-no-relax}]
|
317 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
318 |
|
|
@ifset IA64
|
319 |
|
|
|
320 |
|
|
@emph{Target IA-64 options:}
|
321 |
|
|
[@b{-mconstant-gp}|@b{-mauto-pic}]
|
322 |
|
|
[@b{-milp32}|@b{-milp64}|@b{-mlp64}|@b{-mp64}]
|
323 |
|
|
[@b{-mle}|@b{mbe}]
|
324 |
|
|
[@b{-mtune=itanium1}|@b{-mtune=itanium2}]
|
325 |
|
|
[@b{-munwind-check=warning}|@b{-munwind-check=error}]
|
326 |
|
|
[@b{-mhint.b=ok}|@b{-mhint.b=warning}|@b{-mhint.b=error}]
|
327 |
|
|
[@b{-x}|@b{-xexplicit}] [@b{-xauto}] [@b{-xdebug}]
|
328 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
329 |
|
|
@ifset IP2K
|
330 |
|
|
|
331 |
|
|
@emph{Target IP2K options:}
|
332 |
|
|
[@b{-mip2022}|@b{-mip2022ext}]
|
333 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
334 |
|
|
@ifset M32C
|
335 |
|
|
|
336 |
|
|
@emph{Target M32C options:}
|
337 |
|
|
[@b{-m32c}|@b{-m16c}] [-relax] [-h-tick-hex]
|
338 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
339 |
|
|
@ifset M32R
|
340 |
|
|
|
341 |
|
|
@emph{Target M32R options:}
|
342 |
|
|
[@b{--m32rx}|@b{--[no-]warn-explicit-parallel-conflicts}|
|
343 |
|
|
@b{--W[n]p}]
|
344 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
345 |
|
|
@ifset M680X0
|
346 |
|
|
|
347 |
|
|
@emph{Target M680X0 options:}
|
348 |
|
|
[@b{-l}] [@b{-m68000}|@b{-m68010}|@b{-m68020}|@dots{}]
|
349 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
350 |
|
|
@ifset M68HC11
|
351 |
|
|
|
352 |
|
|
@emph{Target M68HC11 options:}
|
353 |
|
|
[@b{-m68hc11}|@b{-m68hc12}|@b{-m68hcs12}]
|
354 |
|
|
[@b{-mshort}|@b{-mlong}]
|
355 |
|
|
[@b{-mshort-double}|@b{-mlong-double}]
|
356 |
|
|
[@b{--force-long-branches}] [@b{--short-branches}]
|
357 |
|
|
[@b{--strict-direct-mode}] [@b{--print-insn-syntax}]
|
358 |
|
|
[@b{--print-opcodes}] [@b{--generate-example}]
|
359 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
360 |
|
|
@ifset MCORE
|
361 |
|
|
|
362 |
|
|
@emph{Target MCORE options:}
|
363 |
|
|
[@b{-jsri2bsr}] [@b{-sifilter}] [@b{-relax}]
|
364 |
|
|
[@b{-mcpu=[210|340]}]
|
365 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
366 |
|
|
@ifset MICROBLAZE
|
367 |
|
|
@emph{Target MICROBLAZE options:}
|
368 |
|
|
@c MicroBlaze has no machine-dependent assembler options.
|
369 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
370 |
|
|
@ifset MIPS
|
371 |
|
|
|
372 |
|
|
@emph{Target MIPS options:}
|
373 |
|
|
[@b{-nocpp}] [@b{-EL}] [@b{-EB}] [@b{-O}[@var{optimization level}]]
|
374 |
|
|
[@b{-g}[@var{debug level}]] [@b{-G} @var{num}] [@b{-KPIC}] [@b{-call_shared}]
|
375 |
|
|
[@b{-non_shared}] [@b{-xgot} [@b{-mvxworks-pic}]
|
376 |
|
|
[@b{-mabi}=@var{ABI}] [@b{-32}] [@b{-n32}] [@b{-64}] [@b{-mfp32}] [@b{-mgp32}]
|
377 |
|
|
[@b{-march}=@var{CPU}] [@b{-mtune}=@var{CPU}] [@b{-mips1}] [@b{-mips2}]
|
378 |
|
|
[@b{-mips3}] [@b{-mips4}] [@b{-mips5}] [@b{-mips32}] [@b{-mips32r2}]
|
379 |
|
|
[@b{-mips64}] [@b{-mips64r2}]
|
380 |
|
|
[@b{-construct-floats}] [@b{-no-construct-floats}]
|
381 |
|
|
[@b{-trap}] [@b{-no-break}] [@b{-break}] [@b{-no-trap}]
|
382 |
|
|
[@b{-mfix7000}] [@b{-mno-fix7000}]
|
383 |
|
|
[@b{-mips16}] [@b{-no-mips16}]
|
384 |
|
|
[@b{-msmartmips}] [@b{-mno-smartmips}]
|
385 |
|
|
[@b{-mips3d}] [@b{-no-mips3d}]
|
386 |
|
|
[@b{-mdmx}] [@b{-no-mdmx}]
|
387 |
|
|
[@b{-mdsp}] [@b{-mno-dsp}]
|
388 |
|
|
[@b{-mdspr2}] [@b{-mno-dspr2}]
|
389 |
|
|
[@b{-mmt}] [@b{-mno-mt}]
|
390 |
|
|
[@b{-mdebug}] [@b{-no-mdebug}]
|
391 |
|
|
[@b{-mpdr}] [@b{-mno-pdr}]
|
392 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
393 |
|
|
@ifset MMIX
|
394 |
|
|
|
395 |
|
|
@emph{Target MMIX options:}
|
396 |
|
|
[@b{--fixed-special-register-names}] [@b{--globalize-symbols}]
|
397 |
|
|
[@b{--gnu-syntax}] [@b{--relax}] [@b{--no-predefined-symbols}]
|
398 |
|
|
[@b{--no-expand}] [@b{--no-merge-gregs}] [@b{-x}]
|
399 |
|
|
[@b{--linker-allocated-gregs}]
|
400 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
401 |
|
|
@ifset PDP11
|
402 |
|
|
|
403 |
|
|
@emph{Target PDP11 options:}
|
404 |
|
|
[@b{-mpic}|@b{-mno-pic}] [@b{-mall}] [@b{-mno-extensions}]
|
405 |
|
|
[@b{-m}@var{extension}|@b{-mno-}@var{extension}]
|
406 |
|
|
[@b{-m}@var{cpu}] [@b{-m}@var{machine}]
|
407 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
408 |
|
|
@ifset PJ
|
409 |
|
|
|
410 |
|
|
@emph{Target picoJava options:}
|
411 |
|
|
[@b{-mb}|@b{-me}]
|
412 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
413 |
|
|
@ifset PPC
|
414 |
|
|
|
415 |
|
|
@emph{Target PowerPC options:}
|
416 |
|
|
[@b{-mpwrx}|@b{-mpwr2}|@b{-mpwr}|@b{-m601}|@b{-mppc}|@b{-mppc32}|@b{-m603}|@b{-m604}|
|
417 |
|
|
@b{-m403}|@b{-m405}|@b{-mppc64}|@b{-m620}|@b{-mppc64bridge}|@b{-mbooke}]
|
418 |
|
|
[@b{-mcom}|@b{-many}|@b{-maltivec}|@b{-mvsx}] [@b{-memb}]
|
419 |
|
|
[@b{-mregnames}|@b{-mno-regnames}]
|
420 |
|
|
[@b{-mrelocatable}|@b{-mrelocatable-lib}]
|
421 |
|
|
[@b{-mlittle}|@b{-mlittle-endian}|@b{-mbig}|@b{-mbig-endian}]
|
422 |
|
|
[@b{-msolaris}|@b{-mno-solaris}]
|
423 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
424 |
|
|
@ifset S390
|
425 |
|
|
|
426 |
|
|
@emph{Target s390 options:}
|
427 |
|
|
[@b{-m31}|@b{-m64}] [@b{-mesa}|@b{-mzarch}] [@b{-march}=@var{CPU}]
|
428 |
|
|
[@b{-mregnames}|@b{-mno-regnames}]
|
429 |
|
|
[@b{-mwarn-areg-zero}]
|
430 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
431 |
|
|
@ifset SCORE
|
432 |
|
|
|
433 |
|
|
@emph{Target SCORE options:}
|
434 |
|
|
[@b{-EB}][@b{-EL}][@b{-FIXDD}][@b{-NWARN}]
|
435 |
|
|
[@b{-SCORE5}][@b{-SCORE5U}][@b{-SCORE7}][@b{-SCORE3}]
|
436 |
|
|
[@b{-march=score7}][@b{-march=score3}]
|
437 |
|
|
[@b{-USE_R1}][@b{-KPIC}][@b{-O0}][@b{-G} @var{num}][@b{-V}]
|
438 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
439 |
|
|
@ifset SPARC
|
440 |
|
|
|
441 |
|
|
@emph{Target SPARC options:}
|
442 |
|
|
@c The order here is important. See c-sparc.texi.
|
443 |
|
|
[@b{-Av6}|@b{-Av7}|@b{-Av8}|@b{-Asparclet}|@b{-Asparclite}
|
444 |
|
|
@b{-Av8plus}|@b{-Av8plusa}|@b{-Av9}|@b{-Av9a}]
|
445 |
|
|
[@b{-xarch=v8plus}|@b{-xarch=v8plusa}] [@b{-bump}]
|
446 |
|
|
[@b{-32}|@b{-64}]
|
447 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
448 |
|
|
@ifset TIC54X
|
449 |
|
|
|
450 |
|
|
@emph{Target TIC54X options:}
|
451 |
|
|
[@b{-mcpu=54[123589]}|@b{-mcpu=54[56]lp}] [@b{-mfar-mode}|@b{-mf}]
|
452 |
|
|
[@b{-merrors-to-file} @var{<filename>}|@b{-me} @var{<filename>}]
|
453 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
454 |
|
|
|
455 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
456 |
|
|
|
457 |
|
|
@emph{Target Z80 options:}
|
458 |
|
|
[@b{-z80}] [@b{-r800}]
|
459 |
|
|
[@b{ -ignore-undocumented-instructions}] [@b{-Wnud}]
|
460 |
|
|
[@b{ -ignore-unportable-instructions}] [@b{-Wnup}]
|
461 |
|
|
[@b{ -warn-undocumented-instructions}] [@b{-Wud}]
|
462 |
|
|
[@b{ -warn-unportable-instructions}] [@b{-Wup}]
|
463 |
|
|
[@b{ -forbid-undocumented-instructions}] [@b{-Fud}]
|
464 |
|
|
[@b{ -forbid-unportable-instructions}] [@b{-Fup}]
|
465 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
466 |
|
|
|
467 |
|
|
@ifset Z8000
|
468 |
|
|
@c Z8000 has no machine-dependent assembler options
|
469 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
470 |
|
|
@ifset XTENSA
|
471 |
|
|
|
472 |
|
|
@emph{Target Xtensa options:}
|
473 |
|
|
[@b{--[no-]text-section-literals}] [@b{--[no-]absolute-literals}]
|
474 |
|
|
[@b{--[no-]target-align}] [@b{--[no-]longcalls}]
|
475 |
|
|
[@b{--[no-]transform}]
|
476 |
|
|
[@b{--rename-section} @var{oldname}=@var{newname}]
|
477 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
478 |
|
|
@c man end
|
479 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
480 |
|
|
|
481 |
|
|
@c man begin OPTIONS
|
482 |
|
|
|
483 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
484 |
|
|
@include at-file.texi
|
485 |
|
|
|
486 |
|
|
@item -a[cdghlmns]
|
487 |
|
|
Turn on listings, in any of a variety of ways:
|
488 |
|
|
|
489 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
490 |
|
|
@item -ac
|
491 |
|
|
omit false conditionals
|
492 |
|
|
|
493 |
|
|
@item -ad
|
494 |
|
|
omit debugging directives
|
495 |
|
|
|
496 |
|
|
@item -ag
|
497 |
|
|
include general information, like @value{AS} version and options passed
|
498 |
|
|
|
499 |
|
|
@item -ah
|
500 |
|
|
include high-level source
|
501 |
|
|
|
502 |
|
|
@item -al
|
503 |
|
|
include assembly
|
504 |
|
|
|
505 |
|
|
@item -am
|
506 |
|
|
include macro expansions
|
507 |
|
|
|
508 |
|
|
@item -an
|
509 |
|
|
omit forms processing
|
510 |
|
|
|
511 |
|
|
@item -as
|
512 |
|
|
include symbols
|
513 |
|
|
|
514 |
|
|
@item =file
|
515 |
|
|
set the name of the listing file
|
516 |
|
|
@end table
|
517 |
|
|
|
518 |
|
|
You may combine these options; for example, use @samp{-aln} for assembly
|
519 |
|
|
listing without forms processing. The @samp{=file} option, if used, must be
|
520 |
|
|
the last one. By itself, @samp{-a} defaults to @samp{-ahls}.
|
521 |
|
|
|
522 |
|
|
@item --alternate
|
523 |
|
|
Begin in alternate macro mode.
|
524 |
|
|
@ifclear man
|
525 |
|
|
@xref{Altmacro,,@code{.altmacro}}.
|
526 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
527 |
|
|
|
528 |
|
|
@item -D
|
529 |
|
|
Ignored. This option is accepted for script compatibility with calls to
|
530 |
|
|
other assemblers.
|
531 |
|
|
|
532 |
|
|
@item --debug-prefix-map @var{old}=@var{new}
|
533 |
|
|
When assembling files in directory @file{@var{old}}, record debugging
|
534 |
|
|
information describing them as in @file{@var{new}} instead.
|
535 |
|
|
|
536 |
|
|
@item --defsym @var{sym}=@var{value}
|
537 |
|
|
Define the symbol @var{sym} to be @var{value} before assembling the input file.
|
538 |
|
|
@var{value} must be an integer constant. As in C, a leading @samp{0x}
|
539 |
|
|
indicates a hexadecimal value, and a leading @samp{0} indicates an octal
|
540 |
|
|
value. The value of the symbol can be overridden inside a source file via the
|
541 |
|
|
use of a @code{.set} pseudo-op.
|
542 |
|
|
|
543 |
|
|
@item -f
|
544 |
|
|
``fast''---skip whitespace and comment preprocessing (assume source is
|
545 |
|
|
compiler output).
|
546 |
|
|
|
547 |
|
|
@item -g
|
548 |
|
|
@itemx --gen-debug
|
549 |
|
|
Generate debugging information for each assembler source line using whichever
|
550 |
|
|
debug format is preferred by the target. This currently means either STABS,
|
551 |
|
|
ECOFF or DWARF2.
|
552 |
|
|
|
553 |
|
|
@item --gstabs
|
554 |
|
|
Generate stabs debugging information for each assembler line. This
|
555 |
|
|
may help debugging assembler code, if the debugger can handle it.
|
556 |
|
|
|
557 |
|
|
@item --gstabs+
|
558 |
|
|
Generate stabs debugging information for each assembler line, with GNU
|
559 |
|
|
extensions that probably only gdb can handle, and that could make other
|
560 |
|
|
debuggers crash or refuse to read your program. This
|
561 |
|
|
may help debugging assembler code. Currently the only GNU extension is
|
562 |
|
|
the location of the current working directory at assembling time.
|
563 |
|
|
|
564 |
|
|
@item --gdwarf-2
|
565 |
|
|
Generate DWARF2 debugging information for each assembler line. This
|
566 |
|
|
may help debugging assembler code, if the debugger can handle it. Note---this
|
567 |
|
|
option is only supported by some targets, not all of them.
|
568 |
|
|
|
569 |
|
|
@item --help
|
570 |
|
|
Print a summary of the command line options and exit.
|
571 |
|
|
|
572 |
|
|
@item --target-help
|
573 |
|
|
Print a summary of all target specific options and exit.
|
574 |
|
|
|
575 |
|
|
@item -I @var{dir}
|
576 |
|
|
Add directory @var{dir} to the search list for @code{.include} directives.
|
577 |
|
|
|
578 |
|
|
@item -J
|
579 |
|
|
Don't warn about signed overflow.
|
580 |
|
|
|
581 |
|
|
@item -K
|
582 |
|
|
@ifclear DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
583 |
|
|
This option is accepted but has no effect on the @value{TARGET} family.
|
584 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
585 |
|
|
@ifset DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
586 |
|
|
Issue warnings when difference tables altered for long displacements.
|
587 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
588 |
|
|
|
589 |
|
|
@item -L
|
590 |
|
|
@itemx --keep-locals
|
591 |
|
|
Keep (in the symbol table) local symbols. These symbols start with
|
592 |
|
|
system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
|
593 |
|
|
or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.
|
594 |
|
|
@ifclear man
|
595 |
|
|
@xref{Symbol Names}.
|
596 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
597 |
|
|
|
598 |
|
|
@item --listing-lhs-width=@var{number}
|
599 |
|
|
Set the maximum width, in words, of the output data column for an assembler
|
600 |
|
|
listing to @var{number}.
|
601 |
|
|
|
602 |
|
|
@item --listing-lhs-width2=@var{number}
|
603 |
|
|
Set the maximum width, in words, of the output data column for continuation
|
604 |
|
|
lines in an assembler listing to @var{number}.
|
605 |
|
|
|
606 |
|
|
@item --listing-rhs-width=@var{number}
|
607 |
|
|
Set the maximum width of an input source line, as displayed in a listing, to
|
608 |
|
|
@var{number} bytes.
|
609 |
|
|
|
610 |
|
|
@item --listing-cont-lines=@var{number}
|
611 |
|
|
Set the maximum number of lines printed in a listing for a single line of input
|
612 |
|
|
to @var{number} + 1.
|
613 |
|
|
|
614 |
|
|
@item -o @var{objfile}
|
615 |
|
|
Name the object-file output from @command{@value{AS}} @var{objfile}.
|
616 |
|
|
|
617 |
|
|
@item -R
|
618 |
|
|
Fold the data section into the text section.
|
619 |
|
|
|
620 |
|
|
@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
|
621 |
|
|
Set the default size of GAS's hash tables to a prime number close to
|
622 |
|
|
@var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of time it takes the
|
623 |
|
|
assembler to perform its tasks, at the expense of increasing the assembler's
|
624 |
|
|
memory requirements. Similarly reducing this value can reduce the memory
|
625 |
|
|
requirements at the expense of speed.
|
626 |
|
|
|
627 |
|
|
@item --reduce-memory-overheads
|
628 |
|
|
This option reduces GAS's memory requirements, at the expense of making the
|
629 |
|
|
assembly processes slower. Currently this switch is a synonym for
|
630 |
|
|
@samp{--hash-size=4051}, but in the future it may have other effects as well.
|
631 |
|
|
|
632 |
|
|
@item --statistics
|
633 |
|
|
Print the maximum space (in bytes) and total time (in seconds) used by
|
634 |
|
|
assembly.
|
635 |
|
|
|
636 |
|
|
@item --strip-local-absolute
|
637 |
|
|
Remove local absolute symbols from the outgoing symbol table.
|
638 |
|
|
|
639 |
|
|
@item -v
|
640 |
|
|
@itemx -version
|
641 |
|
|
Print the @command{as} version.
|
642 |
|
|
|
643 |
|
|
@item --version
|
644 |
|
|
Print the @command{as} version and exit.
|
645 |
|
|
|
646 |
|
|
@item -W
|
647 |
|
|
@itemx --no-warn
|
648 |
|
|
Suppress warning messages.
|
649 |
|
|
|
650 |
|
|
@item --fatal-warnings
|
651 |
|
|
Treat warnings as errors.
|
652 |
|
|
|
653 |
|
|
@item --warn
|
654 |
|
|
Don't suppress warning messages or treat them as errors.
|
655 |
|
|
|
656 |
|
|
@item -w
|
657 |
|
|
Ignored.
|
658 |
|
|
|
659 |
|
|
@item -x
|
660 |
|
|
Ignored.
|
661 |
|
|
|
662 |
|
|
@item -Z
|
663 |
|
|
Generate an object file even after errors.
|
664 |
|
|
|
665 |
|
|
@item -- | @var{files} @dots{}
|
666 |
|
|
Standard input, or source files to assemble.
|
667 |
|
|
|
668 |
|
|
@end table
|
669 |
|
|
|
670 |
|
|
@ifset ARC
|
671 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
672 |
|
|
an ARC processor.
|
673 |
|
|
|
674 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
675 |
|
|
@item -marc[5|6|7|8]
|
676 |
|
|
This option selects the core processor variant.
|
677 |
|
|
@item -EB | -EL
|
678 |
|
|
Select either big-endian (-EB) or little-endian (-EL) output.
|
679 |
|
|
@end table
|
680 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
681 |
|
|
|
682 |
|
|
@ifset ARM
|
683 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the ARM
|
684 |
|
|
processor family.
|
685 |
|
|
|
686 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
687 |
|
|
@item -mcpu=@var{processor}[+@var{extension}@dots{}]
|
688 |
|
|
Specify which ARM processor variant is the target.
|
689 |
|
|
@item -march=@var{architecture}[+@var{extension}@dots{}]
|
690 |
|
|
Specify which ARM architecture variant is used by the target.
|
691 |
|
|
@item -mfpu=@var{floating-point-format}
|
692 |
|
|
Select which Floating Point architecture is the target.
|
693 |
|
|
@item -mfloat-abi=@var{abi}
|
694 |
|
|
Select which floating point ABI is in use.
|
695 |
|
|
@item -mthumb
|
696 |
|
|
Enable Thumb only instruction decoding.
|
697 |
|
|
@item -mapcs-32 | -mapcs-26 | -mapcs-float | -mapcs-reentrant
|
698 |
|
|
Select which procedure calling convention is in use.
|
699 |
|
|
@item -EB | -EL
|
700 |
|
|
Select either big-endian (-EB) or little-endian (-EL) output.
|
701 |
|
|
@item -mthumb-interwork
|
702 |
|
|
Specify that the code has been generated with interworking between Thumb and
|
703 |
|
|
ARM code in mind.
|
704 |
|
|
@item -k
|
705 |
|
|
Specify that PIC code has been generated.
|
706 |
|
|
@end table
|
707 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
708 |
|
|
|
709 |
|
|
@ifset CRIS
|
710 |
|
|
See the info pages for documentation of the CRIS-specific options.
|
711 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
712 |
|
|
|
713 |
|
|
@ifset D10V
|
714 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
715 |
|
|
a D10V processor.
|
716 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
717 |
|
|
@cindex D10V optimization
|
718 |
|
|
@cindex optimization, D10V
|
719 |
|
|
@item -O
|
720 |
|
|
Optimize output by parallelizing instructions.
|
721 |
|
|
@end table
|
722 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
723 |
|
|
|
724 |
|
|
@ifset D30V
|
725 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for a D30V
|
726 |
|
|
processor.
|
727 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
728 |
|
|
@cindex D30V optimization
|
729 |
|
|
@cindex optimization, D30V
|
730 |
|
|
@item -O
|
731 |
|
|
Optimize output by parallelizing instructions.
|
732 |
|
|
|
733 |
|
|
@cindex D30V nops
|
734 |
|
|
@item -n
|
735 |
|
|
Warn when nops are generated.
|
736 |
|
|
|
737 |
|
|
@cindex D30V nops after 32-bit multiply
|
738 |
|
|
@item -N
|
739 |
|
|
Warn when a nop after a 32-bit multiply instruction is generated.
|
740 |
|
|
@end table
|
741 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
742 |
|
|
|
743 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
744 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the
|
745 |
|
|
Intel 80960 processor.
|
746 |
|
|
|
747 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
748 |
|
|
@item -ACA | -ACA_A | -ACB | -ACC | -AKA | -AKB | -AKC | -AMC
|
749 |
|
|
Specify which variant of the 960 architecture is the target.
|
750 |
|
|
|
751 |
|
|
@item -b
|
752 |
|
|
Add code to collect statistics about branches taken.
|
753 |
|
|
|
754 |
|
|
@item -no-relax
|
755 |
|
|
Do not alter compare-and-branch instructions for long displacements;
|
756 |
|
|
error if necessary.
|
757 |
|
|
|
758 |
|
|
@end table
|
759 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
760 |
|
|
|
761 |
|
|
@ifset IP2K
|
762 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the
|
763 |
|
|
Ubicom IP2K series.
|
764 |
|
|
|
765 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
766 |
|
|
|
767 |
|
|
@item -mip2022ext
|
768 |
|
|
Specifies that the extended IP2022 instructions are allowed.
|
769 |
|
|
|
770 |
|
|
@item -mip2022
|
771 |
|
|
Restores the default behaviour, which restricts the permitted instructions to
|
772 |
|
|
just the basic IP2022 ones.
|
773 |
|
|
|
774 |
|
|
@end table
|
775 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
776 |
|
|
|
777 |
|
|
@ifset M32C
|
778 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the
|
779 |
|
|
Renesas M32C and M16C processors.
|
780 |
|
|
|
781 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
782 |
|
|
|
783 |
|
|
@item -m32c
|
784 |
|
|
Assemble M32C instructions.
|
785 |
|
|
|
786 |
|
|
@item -m16c
|
787 |
|
|
Assemble M16C instructions (the default).
|
788 |
|
|
|
789 |
|
|
@item -relax
|
790 |
|
|
Enable support for link-time relaxations.
|
791 |
|
|
|
792 |
|
|
@item -h-tick-hex
|
793 |
|
|
Support H'00 style hex constants in addition to 0x00 style.
|
794 |
|
|
|
795 |
|
|
@end table
|
796 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
797 |
|
|
|
798 |
|
|
@ifset M32R
|
799 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the
|
800 |
|
|
Renesas M32R (formerly Mitsubishi M32R) series.
|
801 |
|
|
|
802 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
803 |
|
|
|
804 |
|
|
@item --m32rx
|
805 |
|
|
Specify which processor in the M32R family is the target. The default
|
806 |
|
|
is normally the M32R, but this option changes it to the M32RX.
|
807 |
|
|
|
808 |
|
|
@item --warn-explicit-parallel-conflicts or --Wp
|
809 |
|
|
Produce warning messages when questionable parallel constructs are
|
810 |
|
|
encountered.
|
811 |
|
|
|
812 |
|
|
@item --no-warn-explicit-parallel-conflicts or --Wnp
|
813 |
|
|
Do not produce warning messages when questionable parallel constructs are
|
814 |
|
|
encountered.
|
815 |
|
|
|
816 |
|
|
@end table
|
817 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
818 |
|
|
|
819 |
|
|
@ifset M680X0
|
820 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the
|
821 |
|
|
Motorola 68000 series.
|
822 |
|
|
|
823 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
824 |
|
|
|
825 |
|
|
@item -l
|
826 |
|
|
Shorten references to undefined symbols, to one word instead of two.
|
827 |
|
|
|
828 |
|
|
@item -m68000 | -m68008 | -m68010 | -m68020 | -m68030
|
829 |
|
|
@itemx | -m68040 | -m68060 | -m68302 | -m68331 | -m68332
|
830 |
|
|
@itemx | -m68333 | -m68340 | -mcpu32 | -m5200
|
831 |
|
|
Specify what processor in the 68000 family is the target. The default
|
832 |
|
|
is normally the 68020, but this can be changed at configuration time.
|
833 |
|
|
|
834 |
|
|
@item -m68881 | -m68882 | -mno-68881 | -mno-68882
|
835 |
|
|
The target machine does (or does not) have a floating-point coprocessor.
|
836 |
|
|
The default is to assume a coprocessor for 68020, 68030, and cpu32. Although
|
837 |
|
|
the basic 68000 is not compatible with the 68881, a combination of the
|
838 |
|
|
two can be specified, since it's possible to do emulation of the
|
839 |
|
|
coprocessor instructions with the main processor.
|
840 |
|
|
|
841 |
|
|
@item -m68851 | -mno-68851
|
842 |
|
|
The target machine does (or does not) have a memory-management
|
843 |
|
|
unit coprocessor. The default is to assume an MMU for 68020 and up.
|
844 |
|
|
|
845 |
|
|
@end table
|
846 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
847 |
|
|
|
848 |
|
|
@ifset PDP11
|
849 |
|
|
|
850 |
|
|
For details about the PDP-11 machine dependent features options,
|
851 |
|
|
see @ref{PDP-11-Options}.
|
852 |
|
|
|
853 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
854 |
|
|
@item -mpic | -mno-pic
|
855 |
|
|
Generate position-independent (or position-dependent) code. The
|
856 |
|
|
default is @option{-mpic}.
|
857 |
|
|
|
858 |
|
|
@item -mall
|
859 |
|
|
@itemx -mall-extensions
|
860 |
|
|
Enable all instruction set extensions. This is the default.
|
861 |
|
|
|
862 |
|
|
@item -mno-extensions
|
863 |
|
|
Disable all instruction set extensions.
|
864 |
|
|
|
865 |
|
|
@item -m@var{extension} | -mno-@var{extension}
|
866 |
|
|
Enable (or disable) a particular instruction set extension.
|
867 |
|
|
|
868 |
|
|
@item -m@var{cpu}
|
869 |
|
|
Enable the instruction set extensions supported by a particular CPU, and
|
870 |
|
|
disable all other extensions.
|
871 |
|
|
|
872 |
|
|
@item -m@var{machine}
|
873 |
|
|
Enable the instruction set extensions supported by a particular machine
|
874 |
|
|
model, and disable all other extensions.
|
875 |
|
|
@end table
|
876 |
|
|
|
877 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
878 |
|
|
|
879 |
|
|
@ifset PJ
|
880 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
881 |
|
|
a picoJava processor.
|
882 |
|
|
|
883 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
884 |
|
|
|
885 |
|
|
@cindex PJ endianness
|
886 |
|
|
@cindex endianness, PJ
|
887 |
|
|
@cindex big endian output, PJ
|
888 |
|
|
@item -mb
|
889 |
|
|
Generate ``big endian'' format output.
|
890 |
|
|
|
891 |
|
|
@cindex little endian output, PJ
|
892 |
|
|
@item -ml
|
893 |
|
|
Generate ``little endian'' format output.
|
894 |
|
|
|
895 |
|
|
@end table
|
896 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
897 |
|
|
|
898 |
|
|
@ifset M68HC11
|
899 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the
|
900 |
|
|
Motorola 68HC11 or 68HC12 series.
|
901 |
|
|
|
902 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
903 |
|
|
|
904 |
|
|
@item -m68hc11 | -m68hc12 | -m68hcs12
|
905 |
|
|
Specify what processor is the target. The default is
|
906 |
|
|
defined by the configuration option when building the assembler.
|
907 |
|
|
|
908 |
|
|
@item -mshort
|
909 |
|
|
Specify to use the 16-bit integer ABI.
|
910 |
|
|
|
911 |
|
|
@item -mlong
|
912 |
|
|
Specify to use the 32-bit integer ABI.
|
913 |
|
|
|
914 |
|
|
@item -mshort-double
|
915 |
|
|
Specify to use the 32-bit double ABI.
|
916 |
|
|
|
917 |
|
|
@item -mlong-double
|
918 |
|
|
Specify to use the 64-bit double ABI.
|
919 |
|
|
|
920 |
|
|
@item --force-long-branches
|
921 |
|
|
Relative branches are turned into absolute ones. This concerns
|
922 |
|
|
conditional branches, unconditional branches and branches to a
|
923 |
|
|
sub routine.
|
924 |
|
|
|
925 |
|
|
@item -S | --short-branches
|
926 |
|
|
Do not turn relative branches into absolute ones
|
927 |
|
|
when the offset is out of range.
|
928 |
|
|
|
929 |
|
|
@item --strict-direct-mode
|
930 |
|
|
Do not turn the direct addressing mode into extended addressing mode
|
931 |
|
|
when the instruction does not support direct addressing mode.
|
932 |
|
|
|
933 |
|
|
@item --print-insn-syntax
|
934 |
|
|
Print the syntax of instruction in case of error.
|
935 |
|
|
|
936 |
|
|
@item --print-opcodes
|
937 |
|
|
print the list of instructions with syntax and then exit.
|
938 |
|
|
|
939 |
|
|
@item --generate-example
|
940 |
|
|
print an example of instruction for each possible instruction and then exit.
|
941 |
|
|
This option is only useful for testing @command{@value{AS}}.
|
942 |
|
|
|
943 |
|
|
@end table
|
944 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
945 |
|
|
|
946 |
|
|
@ifset SPARC
|
947 |
|
|
The following options are available when @command{@value{AS}} is configured
|
948 |
|
|
for the SPARC architecture:
|
949 |
|
|
|
950 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
951 |
|
|
@item -Av6 | -Av7 | -Av8 | -Asparclet | -Asparclite
|
952 |
|
|
@itemx -Av8plus | -Av8plusa | -Av9 | -Av9a
|
953 |
|
|
Explicitly select a variant of the SPARC architecture.
|
954 |
|
|
|
955 |
|
|
@samp{-Av8plus} and @samp{-Av8plusa} select a 32 bit environment.
|
956 |
|
|
@samp{-Av9} and @samp{-Av9a} select a 64 bit environment.
|
957 |
|
|
|
958 |
|
|
@samp{-Av8plusa} and @samp{-Av9a} enable the SPARC V9 instruction set with
|
959 |
|
|
UltraSPARC extensions.
|
960 |
|
|
|
961 |
|
|
@item -xarch=v8plus | -xarch=v8plusa
|
962 |
|
|
For compatibility with the Solaris v9 assembler. These options are
|
963 |
|
|
equivalent to -Av8plus and -Av8plusa, respectively.
|
964 |
|
|
|
965 |
|
|
@item -bump
|
966 |
|
|
Warn when the assembler switches to another architecture.
|
967 |
|
|
@end table
|
968 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
969 |
|
|
|
970 |
|
|
@ifset TIC54X
|
971 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the 'c54x
|
972 |
|
|
architecture.
|
973 |
|
|
|
974 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
975 |
|
|
@item -mfar-mode
|
976 |
|
|
Enable extended addressing mode. All addresses and relocations will assume
|
977 |
|
|
extended addressing (usually 23 bits).
|
978 |
|
|
@item -mcpu=@var{CPU_VERSION}
|
979 |
|
|
Sets the CPU version being compiled for.
|
980 |
|
|
@item -merrors-to-file @var{FILENAME}
|
981 |
|
|
Redirect error output to a file, for broken systems which don't support such
|
982 |
|
|
behaviour in the shell.
|
983 |
|
|
@end table
|
984 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
985 |
|
|
|
986 |
|
|
@ifset MIPS
|
987 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
988 |
|
|
a @sc{mips} processor.
|
989 |
|
|
|
990 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
991 |
|
|
@item -G @var{num}
|
992 |
|
|
This option sets the largest size of an object that can be referenced
|
993 |
|
|
implicitly with the @code{gp} register. It is only accepted for targets that
|
994 |
|
|
use ECOFF format, such as a DECstation running Ultrix. The default value is 8.
|
995 |
|
|
|
996 |
|
|
@cindex MIPS endianness
|
997 |
|
|
@cindex endianness, MIPS
|
998 |
|
|
@cindex big endian output, MIPS
|
999 |
|
|
@item -EB
|
1000 |
|
|
Generate ``big endian'' format output.
|
1001 |
|
|
|
1002 |
|
|
@cindex little endian output, MIPS
|
1003 |
|
|
@item -EL
|
1004 |
|
|
Generate ``little endian'' format output.
|
1005 |
|
|
|
1006 |
|
|
@cindex MIPS ISA
|
1007 |
|
|
@item -mips1
|
1008 |
|
|
@itemx -mips2
|
1009 |
|
|
@itemx -mips3
|
1010 |
|
|
@itemx -mips4
|
1011 |
|
|
@itemx -mips5
|
1012 |
|
|
@itemx -mips32
|
1013 |
|
|
@itemx -mips32r2
|
1014 |
|
|
@itemx -mips64
|
1015 |
|
|
@itemx -mips64r2
|
1016 |
|
|
Generate code for a particular @sc{mips} Instruction Set Architecture level.
|
1017 |
|
|
@samp{-mips1} is an alias for @samp{-march=r3000}, @samp{-mips2} is an
|
1018 |
|
|
alias for @samp{-march=r6000}, @samp{-mips3} is an alias for
|
1019 |
|
|
@samp{-march=r4000} and @samp{-mips4} is an alias for @samp{-march=r8000}.
|
1020 |
|
|
@samp{-mips5}, @samp{-mips32}, @samp{-mips32r2}, @samp{-mips64}, and
|
1021 |
|
|
@samp{-mips64r2}
|
1022 |
|
|
correspond to generic
|
1023 |
|
|
@samp{MIPS V}, @samp{MIPS32}, @samp{MIPS32 Release 2}, @samp{MIPS64},
|
1024 |
|
|
and @samp{MIPS64 Release 2}
|
1025 |
|
|
ISA processors, respectively.
|
1026 |
|
|
|
1027 |
|
|
@item -march=@var{CPU}
|
1028 |
|
|
Generate code for a particular @sc{mips} cpu.
|
1029 |
|
|
|
1030 |
|
|
@item -mtune=@var{cpu}
|
1031 |
|
|
Schedule and tune for a particular @sc{mips} cpu.
|
1032 |
|
|
|
1033 |
|
|
@item -mfix7000
|
1034 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-fix7000
|
1035 |
|
|
Cause nops to be inserted if the read of the destination register
|
1036 |
|
|
of an mfhi or mflo instruction occurs in the following two instructions.
|
1037 |
|
|
|
1038 |
|
|
@item -mdebug
|
1039 |
|
|
@itemx -no-mdebug
|
1040 |
|
|
Cause stabs-style debugging output to go into an ECOFF-style .mdebug
|
1041 |
|
|
section instead of the standard ELF .stabs sections.
|
1042 |
|
|
|
1043 |
|
|
@item -mpdr
|
1044 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-pdr
|
1045 |
|
|
Control generation of @code{.pdr} sections.
|
1046 |
|
|
|
1047 |
|
|
@item -mgp32
|
1048 |
|
|
@itemx -mfp32
|
1049 |
|
|
The register sizes are normally inferred from the ISA and ABI, but these
|
1050 |
|
|
flags force a certain group of registers to be treated as 32 bits wide at
|
1051 |
|
|
all times. @samp{-mgp32} controls the size of general-purpose registers
|
1052 |
|
|
and @samp{-mfp32} controls the size of floating-point registers.
|
1053 |
|
|
|
1054 |
|
|
@item -mips16
|
1055 |
|
|
@itemx -no-mips16
|
1056 |
|
|
Generate code for the MIPS 16 processor. This is equivalent to putting
|
1057 |
|
|
@code{.set mips16} at the start of the assembly file. @samp{-no-mips16}
|
1058 |
|
|
turns off this option.
|
1059 |
|
|
|
1060 |
|
|
@item -msmartmips
|
1061 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-smartmips
|
1062 |
|
|
Enables the SmartMIPS extension to the MIPS32 instruction set. This is
|
1063 |
|
|
equivalent to putting @code{.set smartmips} at the start of the assembly file.
|
1064 |
|
|
@samp{-mno-smartmips} turns off this option.
|
1065 |
|
|
|
1066 |
|
|
@item -mips3d
|
1067 |
|
|
@itemx -no-mips3d
|
1068 |
|
|
Generate code for the MIPS-3D Application Specific Extension.
|
1069 |
|
|
This tells the assembler to accept MIPS-3D instructions.
|
1070 |
|
|
@samp{-no-mips3d} turns off this option.
|
1071 |
|
|
|
1072 |
|
|
@item -mdmx
|
1073 |
|
|
@itemx -no-mdmx
|
1074 |
|
|
Generate code for the MDMX Application Specific Extension.
|
1075 |
|
|
This tells the assembler to accept MDMX instructions.
|
1076 |
|
|
@samp{-no-mdmx} turns off this option.
|
1077 |
|
|
|
1078 |
|
|
@item -mdsp
|
1079 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-dsp
|
1080 |
|
|
Generate code for the DSP Release 1 Application Specific Extension.
|
1081 |
|
|
This tells the assembler to accept DSP Release 1 instructions.
|
1082 |
|
|
@samp{-mno-dsp} turns off this option.
|
1083 |
|
|
|
1084 |
|
|
@item -mdspr2
|
1085 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-dspr2
|
1086 |
|
|
Generate code for the DSP Release 2 Application Specific Extension.
|
1087 |
|
|
This option implies -mdsp.
|
1088 |
|
|
This tells the assembler to accept DSP Release 2 instructions.
|
1089 |
|
|
@samp{-mno-dspr2} turns off this option.
|
1090 |
|
|
|
1091 |
|
|
@item -mmt
|
1092 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-mt
|
1093 |
|
|
Generate code for the MT Application Specific Extension.
|
1094 |
|
|
This tells the assembler to accept MT instructions.
|
1095 |
|
|
@samp{-mno-mt} turns off this option.
|
1096 |
|
|
|
1097 |
|
|
@item --construct-floats
|
1098 |
|
|
@itemx --no-construct-floats
|
1099 |
|
|
The @samp{--no-construct-floats} option disables the construction of
|
1100 |
|
|
double width floating point constants by loading the two halves of the
|
1101 |
|
|
value into the two single width floating point registers that make up
|
1102 |
|
|
the double width register. By default @samp{--construct-floats} is
|
1103 |
|
|
selected, allowing construction of these floating point constants.
|
1104 |
|
|
|
1105 |
|
|
@cindex emulation
|
1106 |
|
|
@item --emulation=@var{name}
|
1107 |
|
|
This option causes @command{@value{AS}} to emulate @command{@value{AS}} configured
|
1108 |
|
|
for some other target, in all respects, including output format (choosing
|
1109 |
|
|
between ELF and ECOFF only), handling of pseudo-opcodes which may generate
|
1110 |
|
|
debugging information or store symbol table information, and default
|
1111 |
|
|
endianness. The available configuration names are: @samp{mipsecoff},
|
1112 |
|
|
@samp{mipself}, @samp{mipslecoff}, @samp{mipsbecoff}, @samp{mipslelf},
|
1113 |
|
|
@samp{mipsbelf}. The first two do not alter the default endianness from that
|
1114 |
|
|
of the primary target for which the assembler was configured; the others change
|
1115 |
|
|
the default to little- or big-endian as indicated by the @samp{b} or @samp{l}
|
1116 |
|
|
in the name. Using @samp{-EB} or @samp{-EL} will override the endianness
|
1117 |
|
|
selection in any case.
|
1118 |
|
|
|
1119 |
|
|
This option is currently supported only when the primary target
|
1120 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is configured for is a @sc{mips} ELF or ECOFF target.
|
1121 |
|
|
Furthermore, the primary target or others specified with
|
1122 |
|
|
@samp{--enable-targets=@dots{}} at configuration time must include support for
|
1123 |
|
|
the other format, if both are to be available. For example, the Irix 5
|
1124 |
|
|
configuration includes support for both.
|
1125 |
|
|
|
1126 |
|
|
Eventually, this option will support more configurations, with more
|
1127 |
|
|
fine-grained control over the assembler's behavior, and will be supported for
|
1128 |
|
|
more processors.
|
1129 |
|
|
|
1130 |
|
|
@item -nocpp
|
1131 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} ignores this option. It is accepted for compatibility with
|
1132 |
|
|
the native tools.
|
1133 |
|
|
|
1134 |
|
|
@item --trap
|
1135 |
|
|
@itemx --no-trap
|
1136 |
|
|
@itemx --break
|
1137 |
|
|
@itemx --no-break
|
1138 |
|
|
Control how to deal with multiplication overflow and division by zero.
|
1139 |
|
|
@samp{--trap} or @samp{--no-break} (which are synonyms) take a trap exception
|
1140 |
|
|
(and only work for Instruction Set Architecture level 2 and higher);
|
1141 |
|
|
@samp{--break} or @samp{--no-trap} (also synonyms, and the default) take a
|
1142 |
|
|
break exception.
|
1143 |
|
|
|
1144 |
|
|
@item -n
|
1145 |
|
|
When this option is used, @command{@value{AS}} will issue a warning every
|
1146 |
|
|
time it generates a nop instruction from a macro.
|
1147 |
|
|
@end table
|
1148 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1149 |
|
|
|
1150 |
|
|
@ifset MCORE
|
1151 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
1152 |
|
|
an MCore processor.
|
1153 |
|
|
|
1154 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
1155 |
|
|
@item -jsri2bsr
|
1156 |
|
|
@itemx -nojsri2bsr
|
1157 |
|
|
Enable or disable the JSRI to BSR transformation. By default this is enabled.
|
1158 |
|
|
The command line option @samp{-nojsri2bsr} can be used to disable it.
|
1159 |
|
|
|
1160 |
|
|
@item -sifilter
|
1161 |
|
|
@itemx -nosifilter
|
1162 |
|
|
Enable or disable the silicon filter behaviour. By default this is disabled.
|
1163 |
|
|
The default can be overridden by the @samp{-sifilter} command line option.
|
1164 |
|
|
|
1165 |
|
|
@item -relax
|
1166 |
|
|
Alter jump instructions for long displacements.
|
1167 |
|
|
|
1168 |
|
|
@item -mcpu=[210|340]
|
1169 |
|
|
Select the cpu type on the target hardware. This controls which instructions
|
1170 |
|
|
can be assembled.
|
1171 |
|
|
|
1172 |
|
|
@item -EB
|
1173 |
|
|
Assemble for a big endian target.
|
1174 |
|
|
|
1175 |
|
|
@item -EL
|
1176 |
|
|
Assemble for a little endian target.
|
1177 |
|
|
|
1178 |
|
|
@end table
|
1179 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1180 |
|
|
|
1181 |
|
|
@ifset MMIX
|
1182 |
|
|
See the info pages for documentation of the MMIX-specific options.
|
1183 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1184 |
|
|
|
1185 |
|
|
@ifset S390
|
1186 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for the s390
|
1187 |
|
|
processor family.
|
1188 |
|
|
|
1189 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
1190 |
|
|
@item -m31
|
1191 |
|
|
@itemx -m64
|
1192 |
|
|
Select the word size, either 31/32 bits or 64 bits.
|
1193 |
|
|
@item -mesa
|
1194 |
|
|
@item -mzarch
|
1195 |
|
|
Select the architecture mode, either the Enterprise System
|
1196 |
|
|
Architecture (esa) or the z/Architecture mode (zarch).
|
1197 |
|
|
@item -march=@var{processor}
|
1198 |
|
|
Specify which s390 processor variant is the target, @samp{g6}, @samp{g6},
|
1199 |
|
|
@samp{z900}, @samp{z990}, @samp{z9-109}, @samp{z9-ec}, or @samp{z10}.
|
1200 |
|
|
@item -mregnames
|
1201 |
|
|
@itemx -mno-regnames
|
1202 |
|
|
Allow or disallow symbolic names for registers.
|
1203 |
|
|
@item -mwarn-areg-zero
|
1204 |
|
|
Warn whenever the operand for a base or index register has been specified
|
1205 |
|
|
but evaluates to zero.
|
1206 |
|
|
@end table
|
1207 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1208 |
|
|
|
1209 |
|
|
@ifset XTENSA
|
1210 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
1211 |
|
|
an Xtensa processor.
|
1212 |
|
|
|
1213 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
1214 |
|
|
@item --text-section-literals | --no-text-section-literals
|
1215 |
|
|
With @option{--text-@-section-@-literals}, literal pools are interspersed
|
1216 |
|
|
in the text section. The default is
|
1217 |
|
|
@option{--no-@-text-@-section-@-literals}, which places literals in a
|
1218 |
|
|
separate section in the output file. These options only affect literals
|
1219 |
|
|
referenced via PC-relative @code{L32R} instructions; literals for
|
1220 |
|
|
absolute mode @code{L32R} instructions are handled separately.
|
1221 |
|
|
|
1222 |
|
|
@item --absolute-literals | --no-absolute-literals
|
1223 |
|
|
Indicate to the assembler whether @code{L32R} instructions use absolute
|
1224 |
|
|
or PC-relative addressing. The default is to assume absolute addressing
|
1225 |
|
|
if the Xtensa processor includes the absolute @code{L32R} addressing
|
1226 |
|
|
option. Otherwise, only the PC-relative @code{L32R} mode can be used.
|
1227 |
|
|
|
1228 |
|
|
@item --target-align | --no-target-align
|
1229 |
|
|
Enable or disable automatic alignment to reduce branch penalties at the
|
1230 |
|
|
expense of some code density. The default is @option{--target-@-align}.
|
1231 |
|
|
|
1232 |
|
|
@item --longcalls | --no-longcalls
|
1233 |
|
|
Enable or disable transformation of call instructions to allow calls
|
1234 |
|
|
across a greater range of addresses. The default is
|
1235 |
|
|
@option{--no-@-longcalls}.
|
1236 |
|
|
|
1237 |
|
|
@item --transform | --no-transform
|
1238 |
|
|
Enable or disable all assembler transformations of Xtensa instructions.
|
1239 |
|
|
The default is @option{--transform};
|
1240 |
|
|
@option{--no-transform} should be used only in the rare cases when the
|
1241 |
|
|
instructions must be exactly as specified in the assembly source.
|
1242 |
|
|
|
1243 |
|
|
@item --rename-section @var{oldname}=@var{newname}
|
1244 |
|
|
When generating output sections, rename the @var{oldname} section to
|
1245 |
|
|
@var{newname}.
|
1246 |
|
|
@end table
|
1247 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1248 |
|
|
|
1249 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
1250 |
|
|
The following options are available when @value{AS} is configured for
|
1251 |
|
|
a Z80 family processor.
|
1252 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
1253 |
|
|
@item -z80
|
1254 |
|
|
Assemble for Z80 processor.
|
1255 |
|
|
@item -r800
|
1256 |
|
|
Assemble for R800 processor.
|
1257 |
|
|
@item -ignore-undocumented-instructions
|
1258 |
|
|
@itemx -Wnud
|
1259 |
|
|
Assemble undocumented Z80 instructions that also work on R800 without warning.
|
1260 |
|
|
@item -ignore-unportable-instructions
|
1261 |
|
|
@itemx -Wnup
|
1262 |
|
|
Assemble all undocumented Z80 instructions without warning.
|
1263 |
|
|
@item -warn-undocumented-instructions
|
1264 |
|
|
@itemx -Wud
|
1265 |
|
|
Issue a warning for undocumented Z80 instructions that also work on R800.
|
1266 |
|
|
@item -warn-unportable-instructions
|
1267 |
|
|
@itemx -Wup
|
1268 |
|
|
Issue a warning for undocumented Z80 instructions that do not work on R800.
|
1269 |
|
|
@item -forbid-undocumented-instructions
|
1270 |
|
|
@itemx -Fud
|
1271 |
|
|
Treat all undocumented instructions as errors.
|
1272 |
|
|
@item -forbid-unportable-instructions
|
1273 |
|
|
@itemx -Fup
|
1274 |
|
|
Treat undocumented Z80 instructions that do not work on R800 as errors.
|
1275 |
|
|
@end table
|
1276 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1277 |
|
|
|
1278 |
|
|
@c man end
|
1279 |
|
|
|
1280 |
|
|
@menu
|
1281 |
|
|
* Manual:: Structure of this Manual
|
1282 |
|
|
* GNU Assembler:: The GNU Assembler
|
1283 |
|
|
* Object Formats:: Object File Formats
|
1284 |
|
|
* Command Line:: Command Line
|
1285 |
|
|
* Input Files:: Input Files
|
1286 |
|
|
* Object:: Output (Object) File
|
1287 |
|
|
* Errors:: Error and Warning Messages
|
1288 |
|
|
@end menu
|
1289 |
|
|
|
1290 |
|
|
@node Manual
|
1291 |
|
|
@section Structure of this Manual
|
1292 |
|
|
|
1293 |
|
|
@cindex manual, structure and purpose
|
1294 |
|
|
This manual is intended to describe what you need to know to use
|
1295 |
|
|
@sc{gnu} @command{@value{AS}}. We cover the syntax expected in source files, including
|
1296 |
|
|
notation for symbols, constants, and expressions; the directives that
|
1297 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} understands; and of course how to invoke @command{@value{AS}}.
|
1298 |
|
|
|
1299 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
1300 |
|
|
We also cover special features in the @value{TARGET}
|
1301 |
|
|
configuration of @command{@value{AS}}, including assembler directives.
|
1302 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1303 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
1304 |
|
|
This manual also describes some of the machine-dependent features of
|
1305 |
|
|
various flavors of the assembler.
|
1306 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1307 |
|
|
|
1308 |
|
|
@cindex machine instructions (not covered)
|
1309 |
|
|
On the other hand, this manual is @emph{not} intended as an introduction
|
1310 |
|
|
to programming in assembly language---let alone programming in general!
|
1311 |
|
|
In a similar vein, we make no attempt to introduce the machine
|
1312 |
|
|
architecture; we do @emph{not} describe the instruction set, standard
|
1313 |
|
|
mnemonics, registers or addressing modes that are standard to a
|
1314 |
|
|
particular architecture.
|
1315 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
1316 |
|
|
You may want to consult the manufacturer's
|
1317 |
|
|
machine architecture manual for this information.
|
1318 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1319 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
1320 |
|
|
@ifset H8/300
|
1321 |
|
|
For information on the H8/300 machine instruction set, see @cite{H8/300
|
1322 |
|
|
Series Programming Manual}. For the H8/300H, see @cite{H8/300H Series
|
1323 |
|
|
Programming Manual} (Renesas).
|
1324 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1325 |
|
|
@ifset SH
|
1326 |
|
|
For information on the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) / SuperH SH machine instruction set,
|
1327 |
|
|
see @cite{SH-Microcomputer User's Manual} (Renesas) or
|
1328 |
|
|
@cite{SH-4 32-bit CPU Core Architecture} (SuperH) and
|
1329 |
|
|
@cite{SuperH (SH) 64-Bit RISC Series} (SuperH).
|
1330 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1331 |
|
|
@ifset Z8000
|
1332 |
|
|
For information on the Z8000 machine instruction set, see @cite{Z8000 CPU Technical Manual}
|
1333 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1334 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1335 |
|
|
|
1336 |
|
|
@c I think this is premature---doc@cygnus.com, 17jan1991
|
1337 |
|
|
@ignore
|
1338 |
|
|
Throughout this manual, we assume that you are running @dfn{GNU},
|
1339 |
|
|
the portable operating system from the @dfn{Free Software
|
1340 |
|
|
Foundation, Inc.}. This restricts our attention to certain kinds of
|
1341 |
|
|
computer (in particular, the kinds of computers that @sc{gnu} can run on);
|
1342 |
|
|
once this assumption is granted examples and definitions need less
|
1343 |
|
|
qualification.
|
1344 |
|
|
|
1345 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is part of a team of programs that turn a high-level
|
1346 |
|
|
human-readable series of instructions into a low-level
|
1347 |
|
|
computer-readable series of instructions. Different versions of
|
1348 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} are used for different kinds of computer.
|
1349 |
|
|
@end ignore
|
1350 |
|
|
|
1351 |
|
|
@c There used to be a section "Terminology" here, which defined
|
1352 |
|
|
@c "contents", "byte", "word", and "long". Defining "word" to any
|
1353 |
|
|
@c particular size is confusing when the .word directive may generate 16
|
1354 |
|
|
@c bits on one machine and 32 bits on another; in general, for the user
|
1355 |
|
|
@c version of this manual, none of these terms seem essential to define.
|
1356 |
|
|
@c They were used very little even in the former draft of the manual;
|
1357 |
|
|
@c this draft makes an effort to avoid them (except in names of
|
1358 |
|
|
@c directives).
|
1359 |
|
|
|
1360 |
|
|
@node GNU Assembler
|
1361 |
|
|
@section The GNU Assembler
|
1362 |
|
|
|
1363 |
|
|
@c man begin DESCRIPTION
|
1364 |
|
|
|
1365 |
|
|
@sc{gnu} @command{as} is really a family of assemblers.
|
1366 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
1367 |
|
|
This manual describes @command{@value{AS}}, a member of that family which is
|
1368 |
|
|
configured for the @value{TARGET} architectures.
|
1369 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1370 |
|
|
If you use (or have used) the @sc{gnu} assembler on one architecture, you
|
1371 |
|
|
should find a fairly similar environment when you use it on another
|
1372 |
|
|
architecture. Each version has much in common with the others,
|
1373 |
|
|
including object file formats, most assembler directives (often called
|
1374 |
|
|
@dfn{pseudo-ops}) and assembler syntax.@refill
|
1375 |
|
|
|
1376 |
|
|
@cindex purpose of @sc{gnu} assembler
|
1377 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is primarily intended to assemble the output of the
|
1378 |
|
|
@sc{gnu} C compiler @code{@value{GCC}} for use by the linker
|
1379 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}}. Nevertheless, we've tried to make @command{@value{AS}}
|
1380 |
|
|
assemble correctly everything that other assemblers for the same
|
1381 |
|
|
machine would assemble.
|
1382 |
|
|
@ifset VAX
|
1383 |
|
|
Any exceptions are documented explicitly (@pxref{Machine Dependencies}).
|
1384 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1385 |
|
|
@ifset M680X0
|
1386 |
|
|
@c This remark should appear in generic version of manual; assumption
|
1387 |
|
|
@c here is that generic version sets M680x0.
|
1388 |
|
|
This doesn't mean @command{@value{AS}} always uses the same syntax as another
|
1389 |
|
|
assembler for the same architecture; for example, we know of several
|
1390 |
|
|
incompatible versions of 680x0 assembly language syntax.
|
1391 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1392 |
|
|
|
1393 |
|
|
@c man end
|
1394 |
|
|
|
1395 |
|
|
Unlike older assemblers, @command{@value{AS}} is designed to assemble a source
|
1396 |
|
|
program in one pass of the source file. This has a subtle impact on the
|
1397 |
|
|
@kbd{.org} directive (@pxref{Org,,@code{.org}}).
|
1398 |
|
|
|
1399 |
|
|
@node Object Formats
|
1400 |
|
|
@section Object File Formats
|
1401 |
|
|
|
1402 |
|
|
@cindex object file format
|
1403 |
|
|
The @sc{gnu} assembler can be configured to produce several alternative
|
1404 |
|
|
object file formats. For the most part, this does not affect how you
|
1405 |
|
|
write assembly language programs; but directives for debugging symbols
|
1406 |
|
|
are typically different in different file formats. @xref{Symbol
|
1407 |
|
|
Attributes,,Symbol Attributes}.
|
1408 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
1409 |
|
|
@ifclear MULTI-OBJ
|
1410 |
|
|
For the @value{TARGET} target, @command{@value{AS}} is configured to produce
|
1411 |
|
|
@value{OBJ-NAME} format object files.
|
1412 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1413 |
|
|
@c The following should exhaust all configs that set MULTI-OBJ, ideally
|
1414 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
1415 |
|
|
On the @value{TARGET}, @command{@value{AS}} can be configured to produce either
|
1416 |
|
|
@code{b.out} or COFF format object files.
|
1417 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1418 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
1419 |
|
|
On the @value{TARGET}, @command{@value{AS}} can be configured to produce either
|
1420 |
|
|
SOM or ELF format object files.
|
1421 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1422 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1423 |
|
|
|
1424 |
|
|
@node Command Line
|
1425 |
|
|
@section Command Line
|
1426 |
|
|
|
1427 |
|
|
@cindex command line conventions
|
1428 |
|
|
|
1429 |
|
|
After the program name @command{@value{AS}}, the command line may contain
|
1430 |
|
|
options and file names. Options may appear in any order, and may be
|
1431 |
|
|
before, after, or between file names. The order of file names is
|
1432 |
|
|
significant.
|
1433 |
|
|
|
1434 |
|
|
@cindex standard input, as input file
|
1435 |
|
|
@kindex --
|
1436 |
|
|
@file{--} (two hyphens) by itself names the standard input file
|
1437 |
|
|
explicitly, as one of the files for @command{@value{AS}} to assemble.
|
1438 |
|
|
|
1439 |
|
|
@cindex options, command line
|
1440 |
|
|
Except for @samp{--} any command line argument that begins with a
|
1441 |
|
|
hyphen (@samp{-}) is an option. Each option changes the behavior of
|
1442 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}}. No option changes the way another option works. An
|
1443 |
|
|
option is a @samp{-} followed by one or more letters; the case of
|
1444 |
|
|
the letter is important. All options are optional.
|
1445 |
|
|
|
1446 |
|
|
Some options expect exactly one file name to follow them. The file
|
1447 |
|
|
name may either immediately follow the option's letter (compatible
|
1448 |
|
|
with older assemblers) or it may be the next command argument (@sc{gnu}
|
1449 |
|
|
standard). These two command lines are equivalent:
|
1450 |
|
|
|
1451 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1452 |
|
|
@value{AS} -o my-object-file.o mumble.s
|
1453 |
|
|
@value{AS} -omy-object-file.o mumble.s
|
1454 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1455 |
|
|
|
1456 |
|
|
@node Input Files
|
1457 |
|
|
@section Input Files
|
1458 |
|
|
|
1459 |
|
|
@cindex input
|
1460 |
|
|
@cindex source program
|
1461 |
|
|
@cindex files, input
|
1462 |
|
|
We use the phrase @dfn{source program}, abbreviated @dfn{source}, to
|
1463 |
|
|
describe the program input to one run of @command{@value{AS}}. The program may
|
1464 |
|
|
be in one or more files; how the source is partitioned into files
|
1465 |
|
|
doesn't change the meaning of the source.
|
1466 |
|
|
|
1467 |
|
|
@c I added "con" prefix to "catenation" just to prove I can overcome my
|
1468 |
|
|
@c APL training... doc@cygnus.com
|
1469 |
|
|
The source program is a concatenation of the text in all the files, in the
|
1470 |
|
|
order specified.
|
1471 |
|
|
|
1472 |
|
|
@c man begin DESCRIPTION
|
1473 |
|
|
Each time you run @command{@value{AS}} it assembles exactly one source
|
1474 |
|
|
program. The source program is made up of one or more files.
|
1475 |
|
|
(The standard input is also a file.)
|
1476 |
|
|
|
1477 |
|
|
You give @command{@value{AS}} a command line that has zero or more input file
|
1478 |
|
|
names. The input files are read (from left file name to right). A
|
1479 |
|
|
command line argument (in any position) that has no special meaning
|
1480 |
|
|
is taken to be an input file name.
|
1481 |
|
|
|
1482 |
|
|
If you give @command{@value{AS}} no file names it attempts to read one input file
|
1483 |
|
|
from the @command{@value{AS}} standard input, which is normally your terminal. You
|
1484 |
|
|
may have to type @key{ctl-D} to tell @command{@value{AS}} there is no more program
|
1485 |
|
|
to assemble.
|
1486 |
|
|
|
1487 |
|
|
Use @samp{--} if you need to explicitly name the standard input file
|
1488 |
|
|
in your command line.
|
1489 |
|
|
|
1490 |
|
|
If the source is empty, @command{@value{AS}} produces a small, empty object
|
1491 |
|
|
file.
|
1492 |
|
|
|
1493 |
|
|
@c man end
|
1494 |
|
|
|
1495 |
|
|
@subheading Filenames and Line-numbers
|
1496 |
|
|
|
1497 |
|
|
@cindex input file linenumbers
|
1498 |
|
|
@cindex line numbers, in input files
|
1499 |
|
|
There are two ways of locating a line in the input file (or files) and
|
1500 |
|
|
either may be used in reporting error messages. One way refers to a line
|
1501 |
|
|
number in a physical file; the other refers to a line number in a
|
1502 |
|
|
``logical'' file. @xref{Errors, ,Error and Warning Messages}.
|
1503 |
|
|
|
1504 |
|
|
@dfn{Physical files} are those files named in the command line given
|
1505 |
|
|
to @command{@value{AS}}.
|
1506 |
|
|
|
1507 |
|
|
@dfn{Logical files} are simply names declared explicitly by assembler
|
1508 |
|
|
directives; they bear no relation to physical files. Logical file names help
|
1509 |
|
|
error messages reflect the original source file, when @command{@value{AS}} source
|
1510 |
|
|
is itself synthesized from other files. @command{@value{AS}} understands the
|
1511 |
|
|
@samp{#} directives emitted by the @code{@value{GCC}} preprocessor. See also
|
1512 |
|
|
@ref{File,,@code{.file}}.
|
1513 |
|
|
|
1514 |
|
|
@node Object
|
1515 |
|
|
@section Output (Object) File
|
1516 |
|
|
|
1517 |
|
|
@cindex object file
|
1518 |
|
|
@cindex output file
|
1519 |
|
|
@kindex a.out
|
1520 |
|
|
@kindex .o
|
1521 |
|
|
Every time you run @command{@value{AS}} it produces an output file, which is
|
1522 |
|
|
your assembly language program translated into numbers. This file
|
1523 |
|
|
is the object file. Its default name is
|
1524 |
|
|
@ifclear BOUT
|
1525 |
|
|
@code{a.out}.
|
1526 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1527 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
1528 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
1529 |
|
|
@code{a.out}, or
|
1530 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1531 |
|
|
@code{b.out} when @command{@value{AS}} is configured for the Intel 80960.
|
1532 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1533 |
|
|
You can give it another name by using the @option{-o} option. Conventionally,
|
1534 |
|
|
object file names end with @file{.o}. The default name is used for historical
|
1535 |
|
|
reasons: older assemblers were capable of assembling self-contained programs
|
1536 |
|
|
directly into a runnable program. (For some formats, this isn't currently
|
1537 |
|
|
possible, but it can be done for the @code{a.out} format.)
|
1538 |
|
|
|
1539 |
|
|
@cindex linker
|
1540 |
|
|
@kindex ld
|
1541 |
|
|
The object file is meant for input to the linker @code{@value{LD}}. It contains
|
1542 |
|
|
assembled program code, information to help @code{@value{LD}} integrate
|
1543 |
|
|
the assembled program into a runnable file, and (optionally) symbolic
|
1544 |
|
|
information for the debugger.
|
1545 |
|
|
|
1546 |
|
|
@c link above to some info file(s) like the description of a.out.
|
1547 |
|
|
@c don't forget to describe @sc{gnu} info as well as Unix lossage.
|
1548 |
|
|
|
1549 |
|
|
@node Errors
|
1550 |
|
|
@section Error and Warning Messages
|
1551 |
|
|
|
1552 |
|
|
@c man begin DESCRIPTION
|
1553 |
|
|
|
1554 |
|
|
@cindex error messages
|
1555 |
|
|
@cindex warning messages
|
1556 |
|
|
@cindex messages from assembler
|
1557 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} may write warnings and error messages to the standard error
|
1558 |
|
|
file (usually your terminal). This should not happen when a compiler
|
1559 |
|
|
runs @command{@value{AS}} automatically. Warnings report an assumption made so
|
1560 |
|
|
that @command{@value{AS}} could keep assembling a flawed program; errors report a
|
1561 |
|
|
grave problem that stops the assembly.
|
1562 |
|
|
|
1563 |
|
|
@c man end
|
1564 |
|
|
|
1565 |
|
|
@cindex format of warning messages
|
1566 |
|
|
Warning messages have the format
|
1567 |
|
|
|
1568 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1569 |
|
|
file_name:@b{NNN}:Warning Message Text
|
1570 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1571 |
|
|
|
1572 |
|
|
@noindent
|
1573 |
|
|
@cindex line numbers, in warnings/errors
|
1574 |
|
|
(where @b{NNN} is a line number). If a logical file name has been given
|
1575 |
|
|
(@pxref{File,,@code{.file}}) it is used for the filename, otherwise the name of
|
1576 |
|
|
the current input file is used. If a logical line number was given
|
1577 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
1578 |
|
|
(@pxref{Line,,@code{.line}})
|
1579 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1580 |
|
|
then it is used to calculate the number printed,
|
1581 |
|
|
otherwise the actual line in the current source file is printed. The
|
1582 |
|
|
message text is intended to be self explanatory (in the grand Unix
|
1583 |
|
|
tradition).
|
1584 |
|
|
|
1585 |
|
|
@cindex format of error messages
|
1586 |
|
|
Error messages have the format
|
1587 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1588 |
|
|
file_name:@b{NNN}:FATAL:Error Message Text
|
1589 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1590 |
|
|
The file name and line number are derived as for warning
|
1591 |
|
|
messages. The actual message text may be rather less explanatory
|
1592 |
|
|
because many of them aren't supposed to happen.
|
1593 |
|
|
|
1594 |
|
|
@node Invoking
|
1595 |
|
|
@chapter Command-Line Options
|
1596 |
|
|
|
1597 |
|
|
@cindex options, all versions of assembler
|
1598 |
|
|
This chapter describes command-line options available in @emph{all}
|
1599 |
|
|
versions of the @sc{gnu} assembler; see @ref{Machine Dependencies},
|
1600 |
|
|
for options specific
|
1601 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
1602 |
|
|
to the @value{TARGET} target.
|
1603 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1604 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
1605 |
|
|
to particular machine architectures.
|
1606 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1607 |
|
|
|
1608 |
|
|
@c man begin DESCRIPTION
|
1609 |
|
|
|
1610 |
|
|
If you are invoking @command{@value{AS}} via the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
|
1611 |
|
|
you can use the @samp{-Wa} option to pass arguments through to the assembler.
|
1612 |
|
|
The assembler arguments must be separated from each other (and the @samp{-Wa})
|
1613 |
|
|
by commas. For example:
|
1614 |
|
|
|
1615 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1616 |
|
|
gcc -c -g -O -Wa,-alh,-L file.c
|
1617 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1618 |
|
|
|
1619 |
|
|
@noindent
|
1620 |
|
|
This passes two options to the assembler: @samp{-alh} (emit a listing to
|
1621 |
|
|
standard output with high-level and assembly source) and @samp{-L} (retain
|
1622 |
|
|
local symbols in the symbol table).
|
1623 |
|
|
|
1624 |
|
|
Usually you do not need to use this @samp{-Wa} mechanism, since many compiler
|
1625 |
|
|
command-line options are automatically passed to the assembler by the compiler.
|
1626 |
|
|
(You can call the @sc{gnu} compiler driver with the @samp{-v} option to see
|
1627 |
|
|
precisely what options it passes to each compilation pass, including the
|
1628 |
|
|
assembler.)
|
1629 |
|
|
|
1630 |
|
|
@c man end
|
1631 |
|
|
|
1632 |
|
|
@menu
|
1633 |
|
|
* a:: -a[cdghlns] enable listings
|
1634 |
|
|
* alternate:: --alternate enable alternate macro syntax
|
1635 |
|
|
* D:: -D for compatibility
|
1636 |
|
|
* f:: -f to work faster
|
1637 |
|
|
* I:: -I for .include search path
|
1638 |
|
|
@ifclear DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
1639 |
|
|
* K:: -K for compatibility
|
1640 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1641 |
|
|
@ifset DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
1642 |
|
|
* K:: -K for difference tables
|
1643 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1644 |
|
|
|
1645 |
|
|
* L:: -L to retain local symbols
|
1646 |
|
|
* listing:: --listing-XXX to configure listing output
|
1647 |
|
|
* M:: -M or --mri to assemble in MRI compatibility mode
|
1648 |
|
|
* MD:: --MD for dependency tracking
|
1649 |
|
|
* o:: -o to name the object file
|
1650 |
|
|
* R:: -R to join data and text sections
|
1651 |
|
|
* statistics:: --statistics to see statistics about assembly
|
1652 |
|
|
* traditional-format:: --traditional-format for compatible output
|
1653 |
|
|
* v:: -v to announce version
|
1654 |
|
|
* W:: -W, --no-warn, --warn, --fatal-warnings to control warnings
|
1655 |
|
|
* Z:: -Z to make object file even after errors
|
1656 |
|
|
@end menu
|
1657 |
|
|
|
1658 |
|
|
@node a
|
1659 |
|
|
@section Enable Listings: @option{-a[cdghlns]}
|
1660 |
|
|
|
1661 |
|
|
@kindex -a
|
1662 |
|
|
@kindex -ac
|
1663 |
|
|
@kindex -ad
|
1664 |
|
|
@kindex -ag
|
1665 |
|
|
@kindex -ah
|
1666 |
|
|
@kindex -al
|
1667 |
|
|
@kindex -an
|
1668 |
|
|
@kindex -as
|
1669 |
|
|
@cindex listings, enabling
|
1670 |
|
|
@cindex assembly listings, enabling
|
1671 |
|
|
|
1672 |
|
|
These options enable listing output from the assembler. By itself,
|
1673 |
|
|
@samp{-a} requests high-level, assembly, and symbols listing.
|
1674 |
|
|
You can use other letters to select specific options for the list:
|
1675 |
|
|
@samp{-ah} requests a high-level language listing,
|
1676 |
|
|
@samp{-al} requests an output-program assembly listing, and
|
1677 |
|
|
@samp{-as} requests a symbol table listing.
|
1678 |
|
|
High-level listings require that a compiler debugging option like
|
1679 |
|
|
@samp{-g} be used, and that assembly listings (@samp{-al}) be requested
|
1680 |
|
|
also.
|
1681 |
|
|
|
1682 |
|
|
Use the @samp{-ag} option to print a first section with general assembly
|
1683 |
|
|
information, like @value{AS} version, switches passed, or time stamp.
|
1684 |
|
|
|
1685 |
|
|
Use the @samp{-ac} option to omit false conditionals from a listing. Any lines
|
1686 |
|
|
which are not assembled because of a false @code{.if} (or @code{.ifdef}, or any
|
1687 |
|
|
other conditional), or a true @code{.if} followed by an @code{.else}, will be
|
1688 |
|
|
omitted from the listing.
|
1689 |
|
|
|
1690 |
|
|
Use the @samp{-ad} option to omit debugging directives from the
|
1691 |
|
|
listing.
|
1692 |
|
|
|
1693 |
|
|
Once you have specified one of these options, you can further control
|
1694 |
|
|
listing output and its appearance using the directives @code{.list},
|
1695 |
|
|
@code{.nolist}, @code{.psize}, @code{.eject}, @code{.title}, and
|
1696 |
|
|
@code{.sbttl}.
|
1697 |
|
|
The @samp{-an} option turns off all forms processing.
|
1698 |
|
|
If you do not request listing output with one of the @samp{-a} options, the
|
1699 |
|
|
listing-control directives have no effect.
|
1700 |
|
|
|
1701 |
|
|
The letters after @samp{-a} may be combined into one option,
|
1702 |
|
|
@emph{e.g.}, @samp{-aln}.
|
1703 |
|
|
|
1704 |
|
|
Note if the assembler source is coming from the standard input (e.g.,
|
1705 |
|
|
because it
|
1706 |
|
|
is being created by @code{@value{GCC}} and the @samp{-pipe} command line switch
|
1707 |
|
|
is being used) then the listing will not contain any comments or preprocessor
|
1708 |
|
|
directives. This is because the listing code buffers input source lines from
|
1709 |
|
|
stdin only after they have been preprocessed by the assembler. This reduces
|
1710 |
|
|
memory usage and makes the code more efficient.
|
1711 |
|
|
|
1712 |
|
|
@node alternate
|
1713 |
|
|
@section @option{--alternate}
|
1714 |
|
|
|
1715 |
|
|
@kindex --alternate
|
1716 |
|
|
Begin in alternate macro mode, see @ref{Altmacro,,@code{.altmacro}}.
|
1717 |
|
|
|
1718 |
|
|
@node D
|
1719 |
|
|
@section @option{-D}
|
1720 |
|
|
|
1721 |
|
|
@kindex -D
|
1722 |
|
|
This option has no effect whatsoever, but it is accepted to make it more
|
1723 |
|
|
likely that scripts written for other assemblers also work with
|
1724 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}}.
|
1725 |
|
|
|
1726 |
|
|
@node f
|
1727 |
|
|
@section Work Faster: @option{-f}
|
1728 |
|
|
|
1729 |
|
|
@kindex -f
|
1730 |
|
|
@cindex trusted compiler
|
1731 |
|
|
@cindex faster processing (@option{-f})
|
1732 |
|
|
@samp{-f} should only be used when assembling programs written by a
|
1733 |
|
|
(trusted) compiler. @samp{-f} stops the assembler from doing whitespace
|
1734 |
|
|
and comment preprocessing on
|
1735 |
|
|
the input file(s) before assembling them. @xref{Preprocessing,
|
1736 |
|
|
,Preprocessing}.
|
1737 |
|
|
|
1738 |
|
|
@quotation
|
1739 |
|
|
@emph{Warning:} if you use @samp{-f} when the files actually need to be
|
1740 |
|
|
preprocessed (if they contain comments, for example), @command{@value{AS}} does
|
1741 |
|
|
not work correctly.
|
1742 |
|
|
@end quotation
|
1743 |
|
|
|
1744 |
|
|
@node I
|
1745 |
|
|
@section @code{.include} Search Path: @option{-I} @var{path}
|
1746 |
|
|
|
1747 |
|
|
@kindex -I @var{path}
|
1748 |
|
|
@cindex paths for @code{.include}
|
1749 |
|
|
@cindex search path for @code{.include}
|
1750 |
|
|
@cindex @code{include} directive search path
|
1751 |
|
|
Use this option to add a @var{path} to the list of directories
|
1752 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} searches for files specified in @code{.include}
|
1753 |
|
|
directives (@pxref{Include,,@code{.include}}). You may use @option{-I} as
|
1754 |
|
|
many times as necessary to include a variety of paths. The current
|
1755 |
|
|
working directory is always searched first; after that, @command{@value{AS}}
|
1756 |
|
|
searches any @samp{-I} directories in the same order as they were
|
1757 |
|
|
specified (left to right) on the command line.
|
1758 |
|
|
|
1759 |
|
|
@node K
|
1760 |
|
|
@section Difference Tables: @option{-K}
|
1761 |
|
|
|
1762 |
|
|
@kindex -K
|
1763 |
|
|
@ifclear DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
1764 |
|
|
On the @value{TARGET} family, this option is allowed, but has no effect. It is
|
1765 |
|
|
permitted for compatibility with the @sc{gnu} assembler on other platforms,
|
1766 |
|
|
where it can be used to warn when the assembler alters the machine code
|
1767 |
|
|
generated for @samp{.word} directives in difference tables. The @value{TARGET}
|
1768 |
|
|
family does not have the addressing limitations that sometimes lead to this
|
1769 |
|
|
alteration on other platforms.
|
1770 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
1771 |
|
|
|
1772 |
|
|
@ifset DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
1773 |
|
|
@cindex difference tables, warning
|
1774 |
|
|
@cindex warning for altered difference tables
|
1775 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} sometimes alters the code emitted for directives of the
|
1776 |
|
|
form @samp{.word @var{sym1}-@var{sym2}}. @xref{Word,,@code{.word}}.
|
1777 |
|
|
You can use the @samp{-K} option if you want a warning issued when this
|
1778 |
|
|
is done.
|
1779 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1780 |
|
|
|
1781 |
|
|
@node L
|
1782 |
|
|
@section Include Local Symbols: @option{-L}
|
1783 |
|
|
|
1784 |
|
|
@kindex -L
|
1785 |
|
|
@cindex local symbols, retaining in output
|
1786 |
|
|
Symbols beginning with system-specific local label prefixes, typically
|
1787 |
|
|
@samp{.L} for ELF systems or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems, are
|
1788 |
|
|
called @dfn{local symbols}. @xref{Symbol Names}. Normally you do not see
|
1789 |
|
|
such symbols when debugging, because they are intended for the use of
|
1790 |
|
|
programs (like compilers) that compose assembler programs, not for your
|
1791 |
|
|
notice. Normally both @command{@value{AS}} and @code{@value{LD}} discard
|
1792 |
|
|
such symbols, so you do not normally debug with them.
|
1793 |
|
|
|
1794 |
|
|
This option tells @command{@value{AS}} to retain those local symbols
|
1795 |
|
|
in the object file. Usually if you do this you also tell the linker
|
1796 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}} to preserve those symbols.
|
1797 |
|
|
|
1798 |
|
|
@node listing
|
1799 |
|
|
@section Configuring listing output: @option{--listing}
|
1800 |
|
|
|
1801 |
|
|
The listing feature of the assembler can be enabled via the command line switch
|
1802 |
|
|
@samp{-a} (@pxref{a}). This feature combines the input source file(s) with a
|
1803 |
|
|
hex dump of the corresponding locations in the output object file, and displays
|
1804 |
|
|
them as a listing file. The format of this listing can be controlled by
|
1805 |
|
|
directives inside the assembler source (i.e., @code{.list} (@pxref{List}),
|
1806 |
|
|
@code{.title} (@pxref{Title}), @code{.sbttl} (@pxref{Sbttl}),
|
1807 |
|
|
@code{.psize} (@pxref{Psize}), and
|
1808 |
|
|
@code{.eject} (@pxref{Eject}) and also by the following switches:
|
1809 |
|
|
|
1810 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
1811 |
|
|
@item --listing-lhs-width=@samp{number}
|
1812 |
|
|
@kindex --listing-lhs-width
|
1813 |
|
|
@cindex Width of first line disassembly output
|
1814 |
|
|
Sets the maximum width, in words, of the first line of the hex byte dump. This
|
1815 |
|
|
dump appears on the left hand side of the listing output.
|
1816 |
|
|
|
1817 |
|
|
@item --listing-lhs-width2=@samp{number}
|
1818 |
|
|
@kindex --listing-lhs-width2
|
1819 |
|
|
@cindex Width of continuation lines of disassembly output
|
1820 |
|
|
Sets the maximum width, in words, of any further lines of the hex byte dump for
|
1821 |
|
|
a given input source line. If this value is not specified, it defaults to being
|
1822 |
|
|
the same as the value specified for @samp{--listing-lhs-width}. If neither
|
1823 |
|
|
switch is used the default is to one.
|
1824 |
|
|
|
1825 |
|
|
@item --listing-rhs-width=@samp{number}
|
1826 |
|
|
@kindex --listing-rhs-width
|
1827 |
|
|
@cindex Width of source line output
|
1828 |
|
|
Sets the maximum width, in characters, of the source line that is displayed
|
1829 |
|
|
alongside the hex dump. The default value for this parameter is 100. The
|
1830 |
|
|
source line is displayed on the right hand side of the listing output.
|
1831 |
|
|
|
1832 |
|
|
@item --listing-cont-lines=@samp{number}
|
1833 |
|
|
@kindex --listing-cont-lines
|
1834 |
|
|
@cindex Maximum number of continuation lines
|
1835 |
|
|
Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex dump that will be
|
1836 |
|
|
displayed for a given single line of source input. The default value is 4.
|
1837 |
|
|
@end table
|
1838 |
|
|
|
1839 |
|
|
@node M
|
1840 |
|
|
@section Assemble in MRI Compatibility Mode: @option{-M}
|
1841 |
|
|
|
1842 |
|
|
@kindex -M
|
1843 |
|
|
@cindex MRI compatibility mode
|
1844 |
|
|
The @option{-M} or @option{--mri} option selects MRI compatibility mode. This
|
1845 |
|
|
changes the syntax and pseudo-op handling of @command{@value{AS}} to make it
|
1846 |
|
|
compatible with the @code{ASM68K} or the @code{ASM960} (depending upon the
|
1847 |
|
|
configured target) assembler from Microtec Research. The exact nature of the
|
1848 |
|
|
MRI syntax will not be documented here; see the MRI manuals for more
|
1849 |
|
|
information. Note in particular that the handling of macros and macro
|
1850 |
|
|
arguments is somewhat different. The purpose of this option is to permit
|
1851 |
|
|
assembling existing MRI assembler code using @command{@value{AS}}.
|
1852 |
|
|
|
1853 |
|
|
The MRI compatibility is not complete. Certain operations of the MRI assembler
|
1854 |
|
|
depend upon its object file format, and can not be supported using other object
|
1855 |
|
|
file formats. Supporting these would require enhancing each object file format
|
1856 |
|
|
individually. These are:
|
1857 |
|
|
|
1858 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
1859 |
|
|
@item global symbols in common section
|
1860 |
|
|
|
1861 |
|
|
The m68k MRI assembler supports common sections which are merged by the linker.
|
1862 |
|
|
Other object file formats do not support this. @command{@value{AS}} handles
|
1863 |
|
|
common sections by treating them as a single common symbol. It permits local
|
1864 |
|
|
symbols to be defined within a common section, but it can not support global
|
1865 |
|
|
symbols, since it has no way to describe them.
|
1866 |
|
|
|
1867 |
|
|
@item complex relocations
|
1868 |
|
|
|
1869 |
|
|
The MRI assemblers support relocations against a negated section address, and
|
1870 |
|
|
relocations which combine the start addresses of two or more sections. These
|
1871 |
|
|
are not support by other object file formats.
|
1872 |
|
|
|
1873 |
|
|
@item @code{END} pseudo-op specifying start address
|
1874 |
|
|
|
1875 |
|
|
The MRI @code{END} pseudo-op permits the specification of a start address.
|
1876 |
|
|
This is not supported by other object file formats. The start address may
|
1877 |
|
|
instead be specified using the @option{-e} option to the linker, or in a linker
|
1878 |
|
|
script.
|
1879 |
|
|
|
1880 |
|
|
@item @code{IDNT}, @code{.ident} and @code{NAME} pseudo-ops
|
1881 |
|
|
|
1882 |
|
|
The MRI @code{IDNT}, @code{.ident} and @code{NAME} pseudo-ops assign a module
|
1883 |
|
|
name to the output file. This is not supported by other object file formats.
|
1884 |
|
|
|
1885 |
|
|
@item @code{ORG} pseudo-op
|
1886 |
|
|
|
1887 |
|
|
The m68k MRI @code{ORG} pseudo-op begins an absolute section at a given
|
1888 |
|
|
address. This differs from the usual @command{@value{AS}} @code{.org} pseudo-op,
|
1889 |
|
|
which changes the location within the current section. Absolute sections are
|
1890 |
|
|
not supported by other object file formats. The address of a section may be
|
1891 |
|
|
assigned within a linker script.
|
1892 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
1893 |
|
|
|
1894 |
|
|
There are some other features of the MRI assembler which are not supported by
|
1895 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}}, typically either because they are difficult or because they
|
1896 |
|
|
seem of little consequence. Some of these may be supported in future releases.
|
1897 |
|
|
|
1898 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
1899 |
|
|
|
1900 |
|
|
@item EBCDIC strings
|
1901 |
|
|
|
1902 |
|
|
EBCDIC strings are not supported.
|
1903 |
|
|
|
1904 |
|
|
@item packed binary coded decimal
|
1905 |
|
|
|
1906 |
|
|
Packed binary coded decimal is not supported. This means that the @code{DC.P}
|
1907 |
|
|
and @code{DCB.P} pseudo-ops are not supported.
|
1908 |
|
|
|
1909 |
|
|
@item @code{FEQU} pseudo-op
|
1910 |
|
|
|
1911 |
|
|
The m68k @code{FEQU} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1912 |
|
|
|
1913 |
|
|
@item @code{NOOBJ} pseudo-op
|
1914 |
|
|
|
1915 |
|
|
The m68k @code{NOOBJ} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1916 |
|
|
|
1917 |
|
|
@item @code{OPT} branch control options
|
1918 |
|
|
|
1919 |
|
|
The m68k @code{OPT} branch control options---@code{B}, @code{BRS}, @code{BRB},
|
1920 |
|
|
@code{BRL}, and @code{BRW}---are ignored. @command{@value{AS}} automatically
|
1921 |
|
|
relaxes all branches, whether forward or backward, to an appropriate size, so
|
1922 |
|
|
these options serve no purpose.
|
1923 |
|
|
|
1924 |
|
|
@item @code{OPT} list control options
|
1925 |
|
|
|
1926 |
|
|
The following m68k @code{OPT} list control options are ignored: @code{C},
|
1927 |
|
|
@code{CEX}, @code{CL}, @code{CRE}, @code{E}, @code{G}, @code{I}, @code{M},
|
1928 |
|
|
@code{MEX}, @code{MC}, @code{MD}, @code{X}.
|
1929 |
|
|
|
1930 |
|
|
@item other @code{OPT} options
|
1931 |
|
|
|
1932 |
|
|
The following m68k @code{OPT} options are ignored: @code{NEST}, @code{O},
|
1933 |
|
|
@code{OLD}, @code{OP}, @code{P}, @code{PCO}, @code{PCR}, @code{PCS}, @code{R}.
|
1934 |
|
|
|
1935 |
|
|
@item @code{OPT} @code{D} option is default
|
1936 |
|
|
|
1937 |
|
|
The m68k @code{OPT} @code{D} option is the default, unlike the MRI assembler.
|
1938 |
|
|
@code{OPT NOD} may be used to turn it off.
|
1939 |
|
|
|
1940 |
|
|
@item @code{XREF} pseudo-op.
|
1941 |
|
|
|
1942 |
|
|
The m68k @code{XREF} pseudo-op is ignored.
|
1943 |
|
|
|
1944 |
|
|
@item @code{.debug} pseudo-op
|
1945 |
|
|
|
1946 |
|
|
The i960 @code{.debug} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1947 |
|
|
|
1948 |
|
|
@item @code{.extended} pseudo-op
|
1949 |
|
|
|
1950 |
|
|
The i960 @code{.extended} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1951 |
|
|
|
1952 |
|
|
@item @code{.list} pseudo-op.
|
1953 |
|
|
|
1954 |
|
|
The various options of the i960 @code{.list} pseudo-op are not supported.
|
1955 |
|
|
|
1956 |
|
|
@item @code{.optimize} pseudo-op
|
1957 |
|
|
|
1958 |
|
|
The i960 @code{.optimize} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1959 |
|
|
|
1960 |
|
|
@item @code{.output} pseudo-op
|
1961 |
|
|
|
1962 |
|
|
The i960 @code{.output} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1963 |
|
|
|
1964 |
|
|
@item @code{.setreal} pseudo-op
|
1965 |
|
|
|
1966 |
|
|
The i960 @code{.setreal} pseudo-op is not supported.
|
1967 |
|
|
|
1968 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
1969 |
|
|
|
1970 |
|
|
@node MD
|
1971 |
|
|
@section Dependency Tracking: @option{--MD}
|
1972 |
|
|
|
1973 |
|
|
@kindex --MD
|
1974 |
|
|
@cindex dependency tracking
|
1975 |
|
|
@cindex make rules
|
1976 |
|
|
|
1977 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} can generate a dependency file for the file it creates. This
|
1978 |
|
|
file consists of a single rule suitable for @code{make} describing the
|
1979 |
|
|
dependencies of the main source file.
|
1980 |
|
|
|
1981 |
|
|
The rule is written to the file named in its argument.
|
1982 |
|
|
|
1983 |
|
|
This feature is used in the automatic updating of makefiles.
|
1984 |
|
|
|
1985 |
|
|
@node o
|
1986 |
|
|
@section Name the Object File: @option{-o}
|
1987 |
|
|
|
1988 |
|
|
@kindex -o
|
1989 |
|
|
@cindex naming object file
|
1990 |
|
|
@cindex object file name
|
1991 |
|
|
There is always one object file output when you run @command{@value{AS}}. By
|
1992 |
|
|
default it has the name
|
1993 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
1994 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
1995 |
|
|
@file{a.out} (or @file{b.out}, for Intel 960 targets only).
|
1996 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
1997 |
|
|
@ifclear I960
|
1998 |
|
|
@file{a.out}.
|
1999 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2000 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2001 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2002 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
2003 |
|
|
@file{b.out}.
|
2004 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2005 |
|
|
@ifclear I960
|
2006 |
|
|
@file{a.out}.
|
2007 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2008 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2009 |
|
|
You use this option (which takes exactly one filename) to give the
|
2010 |
|
|
object file a different name.
|
2011 |
|
|
|
2012 |
|
|
Whatever the object file is called, @command{@value{AS}} overwrites any
|
2013 |
|
|
existing file of the same name.
|
2014 |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
@node R
|
2016 |
|
|
@section Join Data and Text Sections: @option{-R}
|
2017 |
|
|
|
2018 |
|
|
@kindex -R
|
2019 |
|
|
@cindex data and text sections, joining
|
2020 |
|
|
@cindex text and data sections, joining
|
2021 |
|
|
@cindex joining text and data sections
|
2022 |
|
|
@cindex merging text and data sections
|
2023 |
|
|
@option{-R} tells @command{@value{AS}} to write the object file as if all
|
2024 |
|
|
data-section data lives in the text section. This is only done at
|
2025 |
|
|
the very last moment: your binary data are the same, but data
|
2026 |
|
|
section parts are relocated differently. The data section part of
|
2027 |
|
|
your object file is zero bytes long because all its bytes are
|
2028 |
|
|
appended to the text section. (@xref{Sections,,Sections and Relocation}.)
|
2029 |
|
|
|
2030 |
|
|
When you specify @option{-R} it would be possible to generate shorter
|
2031 |
|
|
address displacements (because we do not have to cross between text and
|
2032 |
|
|
data section). We refrain from doing this simply for compatibility with
|
2033 |
|
|
older versions of @command{@value{AS}}. In future, @option{-R} may work this way.
|
2034 |
|
|
|
2035 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
2036 |
|
|
When @command{@value{AS}} is configured for COFF or ELF output,
|
2037 |
|
|
this option is only useful if you use sections named @samp{.text} and
|
2038 |
|
|
@samp{.data}.
|
2039 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2040 |
|
|
|
2041 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2042 |
|
|
@option{-R} is not supported for any of the HPPA targets. Using
|
2043 |
|
|
@option{-R} generates a warning from @command{@value{AS}}.
|
2044 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2045 |
|
|
|
2046 |
|
|
@node statistics
|
2047 |
|
|
@section Display Assembly Statistics: @option{--statistics}
|
2048 |
|
|
|
2049 |
|
|
@kindex --statistics
|
2050 |
|
|
@cindex statistics, about assembly
|
2051 |
|
|
@cindex time, total for assembly
|
2052 |
|
|
@cindex space used, maximum for assembly
|
2053 |
|
|
Use @samp{--statistics} to display two statistics about the resources used by
|
2054 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}}: the maximum amount of space allocated during the assembly
|
2055 |
|
|
(in bytes), and the total execution time taken for the assembly (in @sc{cpu}
|
2056 |
|
|
seconds).
|
2057 |
|
|
|
2058 |
|
|
@node traditional-format
|
2059 |
|
|
@section Compatible Output: @option{--traditional-format}
|
2060 |
|
|
|
2061 |
|
|
@kindex --traditional-format
|
2062 |
|
|
For some targets, the output of @command{@value{AS}} is different in some ways
|
2063 |
|
|
from the output of some existing assembler. This switch requests
|
2064 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} to use the traditional format instead.
|
2065 |
|
|
|
2066 |
|
|
For example, it disables the exception frame optimizations which
|
2067 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} normally does by default on @code{@value{GCC}} output.
|
2068 |
|
|
|
2069 |
|
|
@node v
|
2070 |
|
|
@section Announce Version: @option{-v}
|
2071 |
|
|
|
2072 |
|
|
@kindex -v
|
2073 |
|
|
@kindex -version
|
2074 |
|
|
@cindex assembler version
|
2075 |
|
|
@cindex version of assembler
|
2076 |
|
|
You can find out what version of as is running by including the
|
2077 |
|
|
option @samp{-v} (which you can also spell as @samp{-version}) on the
|
2078 |
|
|
command line.
|
2079 |
|
|
|
2080 |
|
|
@node W
|
2081 |
|
|
@section Control Warnings: @option{-W}, @option{--warn}, @option{--no-warn}, @option{--fatal-warnings}
|
2082 |
|
|
|
2083 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} should never give a warning or error message when
|
2084 |
|
|
assembling compiler output. But programs written by people often
|
2085 |
|
|
cause @command{@value{AS}} to give a warning that a particular assumption was
|
2086 |
|
|
made. All such warnings are directed to the standard error file.
|
2087 |
|
|
|
2088 |
|
|
@kindex -W
|
2089 |
|
|
@kindex --no-warn
|
2090 |
|
|
@cindex suppressing warnings
|
2091 |
|
|
@cindex warnings, suppressing
|
2092 |
|
|
If you use the @option{-W} and @option{--no-warn} options, no warnings are issued.
|
2093 |
|
|
This only affects the warning messages: it does not change any particular of
|
2094 |
|
|
how @command{@value{AS}} assembles your file. Errors, which stop the assembly,
|
2095 |
|
|
are still reported.
|
2096 |
|
|
|
2097 |
|
|
@kindex --fatal-warnings
|
2098 |
|
|
@cindex errors, caused by warnings
|
2099 |
|
|
@cindex warnings, causing error
|
2100 |
|
|
If you use the @option{--fatal-warnings} option, @command{@value{AS}} considers
|
2101 |
|
|
files that generate warnings to be in error.
|
2102 |
|
|
|
2103 |
|
|
@kindex --warn
|
2104 |
|
|
@cindex warnings, switching on
|
2105 |
|
|
You can switch these options off again by specifying @option{--warn}, which
|
2106 |
|
|
causes warnings to be output as usual.
|
2107 |
|
|
|
2108 |
|
|
@node Z
|
2109 |
|
|
@section Generate Object File in Spite of Errors: @option{-Z}
|
2110 |
|
|
@cindex object file, after errors
|
2111 |
|
|
@cindex errors, continuing after
|
2112 |
|
|
After an error message, @command{@value{AS}} normally produces no output. If for
|
2113 |
|
|
some reason you are interested in object file output even after
|
2114 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} gives an error message on your program, use the @samp{-Z}
|
2115 |
|
|
option. If there are any errors, @command{@value{AS}} continues anyways, and
|
2116 |
|
|
writes an object file after a final warning message of the form @samp{@var{n}
|
2117 |
|
|
errors, @var{m} warnings, generating bad object file.}
|
2118 |
|
|
|
2119 |
|
|
@node Syntax
|
2120 |
|
|
@chapter Syntax
|
2121 |
|
|
|
2122 |
|
|
@cindex machine-independent syntax
|
2123 |
|
|
@cindex syntax, machine-independent
|
2124 |
|
|
This chapter describes the machine-independent syntax allowed in a
|
2125 |
|
|
source file. @command{@value{AS}} syntax is similar to what many other
|
2126 |
|
|
assemblers use; it is inspired by the BSD 4.2
|
2127 |
|
|
@ifclear VAX
|
2128 |
|
|
assembler.
|
2129 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2130 |
|
|
@ifset VAX
|
2131 |
|
|
assembler, except that @command{@value{AS}} does not assemble Vax bit-fields.
|
2132 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2133 |
|
|
|
2134 |
|
|
@menu
|
2135 |
|
|
* Preprocessing:: Preprocessing
|
2136 |
|
|
* Whitespace:: Whitespace
|
2137 |
|
|
* Comments:: Comments
|
2138 |
|
|
* Symbol Intro:: Symbols
|
2139 |
|
|
* Statements:: Statements
|
2140 |
|
|
* Constants:: Constants
|
2141 |
|
|
@end menu
|
2142 |
|
|
|
2143 |
|
|
@node Preprocessing
|
2144 |
|
|
@section Preprocessing
|
2145 |
|
|
|
2146 |
|
|
@cindex preprocessing
|
2147 |
|
|
The @command{@value{AS}} internal preprocessor:
|
2148 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
2149 |
|
|
@cindex whitespace, removed by preprocessor
|
2150 |
|
|
@item
|
2151 |
|
|
adjusts and removes extra whitespace. It leaves one space or tab before
|
2152 |
|
|
the keywords on a line, and turns any other whitespace on the line into
|
2153 |
|
|
a single space.
|
2154 |
|
|
|
2155 |
|
|
@cindex comments, removed by preprocessor
|
2156 |
|
|
@item
|
2157 |
|
|
removes all comments, replacing them with a single space, or an
|
2158 |
|
|
appropriate number of newlines.
|
2159 |
|
|
|
2160 |
|
|
@cindex constants, converted by preprocessor
|
2161 |
|
|
@item
|
2162 |
|
|
converts character constants into the appropriate numeric values.
|
2163 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
2164 |
|
|
|
2165 |
|
|
It does not do macro processing, include file handling, or
|
2166 |
|
|
anything else you may get from your C compiler's preprocessor. You can
|
2167 |
|
|
do include file processing with the @code{.include} directive
|
2168 |
|
|
(@pxref{Include,,@code{.include}}). You can use the @sc{gnu} C compiler driver
|
2169 |
|
|
to get other ``CPP'' style preprocessing by giving the input file a
|
2170 |
|
|
@samp{.S} suffix. @xref{Overall Options, ,Options Controlling the Kind of
|
2171 |
|
|
Output, gcc.info, Using GNU CC}.
|
2172 |
|
|
|
2173 |
|
|
Excess whitespace, comments, and character constants
|
2174 |
|
|
cannot be used in the portions of the input text that are not
|
2175 |
|
|
preprocessed.
|
2176 |
|
|
|
2177 |
|
|
@cindex turning preprocessing on and off
|
2178 |
|
|
@cindex preprocessing, turning on and off
|
2179 |
|
|
@kindex #NO_APP
|
2180 |
|
|
@kindex #APP
|
2181 |
|
|
If the first line of an input file is @code{#NO_APP} or if you use the
|
2182 |
|
|
@samp{-f} option, whitespace and comments are not removed from the input file.
|
2183 |
|
|
Within an input file, you can ask for whitespace and comment removal in
|
2184 |
|
|
specific portions of the by putting a line that says @code{#APP} before the
|
2185 |
|
|
text that may contain whitespace or comments, and putting a line that says
|
2186 |
|
|
@code{#NO_APP} after this text. This feature is mainly intend to support
|
2187 |
|
|
@code{asm} statements in compilers whose output is otherwise free of comments
|
2188 |
|
|
and whitespace.
|
2189 |
|
|
|
2190 |
|
|
@node Whitespace
|
2191 |
|
|
@section Whitespace
|
2192 |
|
|
|
2193 |
|
|
@cindex whitespace
|
2194 |
|
|
@dfn{Whitespace} is one or more blanks or tabs, in any order.
|
2195 |
|
|
Whitespace is used to separate symbols, and to make programs neater for
|
2196 |
|
|
people to read. Unless within character constants
|
2197 |
|
|
(@pxref{Characters,,Character Constants}), any whitespace means the same
|
2198 |
|
|
as exactly one space.
|
2199 |
|
|
|
2200 |
|
|
@node Comments
|
2201 |
|
|
@section Comments
|
2202 |
|
|
|
2203 |
|
|
@cindex comments
|
2204 |
|
|
There are two ways of rendering comments to @command{@value{AS}}. In both
|
2205 |
|
|
cases the comment is equivalent to one space.
|
2206 |
|
|
|
2207 |
|
|
Anything from @samp{/*} through the next @samp{*/} is a comment.
|
2208 |
|
|
This means you may not nest these comments.
|
2209 |
|
|
|
2210 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2211 |
|
|
/*
|
2212 |
|
|
The only way to include a newline ('\n') in a comment
|
2213 |
|
|
is to use this sort of comment.
|
2214 |
|
|
*/
|
2215 |
|
|
|
2216 |
|
|
/* This sort of comment does not nest. */
|
2217 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2218 |
|
|
|
2219 |
|
|
@cindex line comment character
|
2220 |
|
|
Anything from the @dfn{line comment} character to the next newline
|
2221 |
|
|
is considered a comment and is ignored. The line comment character is
|
2222 |
|
|
@ifset ARC
|
2223 |
|
|
@samp{;} on the ARC;
|
2224 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2225 |
|
|
@ifset ARM
|
2226 |
|
|
@samp{@@} on the ARM;
|
2227 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2228 |
|
|
@ifset H8/300
|
2229 |
|
|
@samp{;} for the H8/300 family;
|
2230 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2231 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2232 |
|
|
@samp{;} for the HPPA;
|
2233 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2234 |
|
|
@ifset I80386
|
2235 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the i386 and x86-64;
|
2236 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2237 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
2238 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the i960;
|
2239 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2240 |
|
|
@ifset PDP11
|
2241 |
|
|
@samp{;} for the PDP-11;
|
2242 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2243 |
|
|
@ifset PJ
|
2244 |
|
|
@samp{;} for picoJava;
|
2245 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2246 |
|
|
@ifset PPC
|
2247 |
|
|
@samp{#} for Motorola PowerPC;
|
2248 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2249 |
|
|
@ifset S390
|
2250 |
|
|
@samp{#} for IBM S/390;
|
2251 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2252 |
|
|
@ifset SCORE
|
2253 |
|
|
@samp{#} for the Sunplus SCORE;
|
2254 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2255 |
|
|
@ifset SH
|
2256 |
|
|
@samp{!} for the Renesas / SuperH SH;
|
2257 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2258 |
|
|
@ifset SPARC
|
2259 |
|
|
@samp{!} on the SPARC;
|
2260 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2261 |
|
|
@ifset IP2K
|
2262 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the ip2k;
|
2263 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2264 |
|
|
@ifset M32C
|
2265 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the m32c;
|
2266 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2267 |
|
|
@ifset M32R
|
2268 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the m32r;
|
2269 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2270 |
|
|
@ifset M680X0
|
2271 |
|
|
@samp{|} on the 680x0;
|
2272 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2273 |
|
|
@ifset M68HC11
|
2274 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the 68HC11 and 68HC12;
|
2275 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2276 |
|
|
@ifset VAX
|
2277 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the Vax;
|
2278 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2279 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
2280 |
|
|
@samp{;} for the Z80;
|
2281 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2282 |
|
|
@ifset Z8000
|
2283 |
|
|
@samp{!} for the Z8000;
|
2284 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2285 |
|
|
@ifset V850
|
2286 |
|
|
@samp{#} on the V850;
|
2287 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2288 |
|
|
@ifset XTENSA
|
2289 |
|
|
@samp{#} for Xtensa systems;
|
2290 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2291 |
|
|
see @ref{Machine Dependencies}. @refill
|
2292 |
|
|
@c FIXME What about i860?
|
2293 |
|
|
|
2294 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2295 |
|
|
On some machines there are two different line comment characters. One
|
2296 |
|
|
character only begins a comment if it is the first non-whitespace character on
|
2297 |
|
|
a line, while the other always begins a comment.
|
2298 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2299 |
|
|
|
2300 |
|
|
@ifset V850
|
2301 |
|
|
The V850 assembler also supports a double dash as starting a comment that
|
2302 |
|
|
extends to the end of the line.
|
2303 |
|
|
|
2304 |
|
|
@samp{--};
|
2305 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2306 |
|
|
|
2307 |
|
|
@kindex #
|
2308 |
|
|
@cindex lines starting with @code{#}
|
2309 |
|
|
@cindex logical line numbers
|
2310 |
|
|
To be compatible with past assemblers, lines that begin with @samp{#} have a
|
2311 |
|
|
special interpretation. Following the @samp{#} should be an absolute
|
2312 |
|
|
expression (@pxref{Expressions}): the logical line number of the @emph{next}
|
2313 |
|
|
line. Then a string (@pxref{Strings, ,Strings}) is allowed: if present it is a
|
2314 |
|
|
new logical file name. The rest of the line, if any, should be whitespace.
|
2315 |
|
|
|
2316 |
|
|
If the first non-whitespace characters on the line are not numeric,
|
2317 |
|
|
the line is ignored. (Just like a comment.)
|
2318 |
|
|
|
2319 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2320 |
|
|
# This is an ordinary comment.
|
2321 |
|
|
# 42-6 "new_file_name" # New logical file name
|
2322 |
|
|
# This is logical line # 36.
|
2323 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2324 |
|
|
This feature is deprecated, and may disappear from future versions
|
2325 |
|
|
of @command{@value{AS}}.
|
2326 |
|
|
|
2327 |
|
|
@node Symbol Intro
|
2328 |
|
|
@section Symbols
|
2329 |
|
|
|
2330 |
|
|
@cindex characters used in symbols
|
2331 |
|
|
@ifclear SPECIAL-SYMS
|
2332 |
|
|
A @dfn{symbol} is one or more characters chosen from the set of all
|
2333 |
|
|
letters (both upper and lower case), digits and the three characters
|
2334 |
|
|
@samp{_.$}.
|
2335 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2336 |
|
|
@ifset SPECIAL-SYMS
|
2337 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2338 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
2339 |
|
|
A @dfn{symbol} is one or more characters chosen from the set of all
|
2340 |
|
|
letters (both upper and lower case), digits and the three characters
|
2341 |
|
|
@samp{._$}. (Save that, on the H8/300 only, you may not use @samp{$} in
|
2342 |
|
|
symbol names.)
|
2343 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2344 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2345 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2346 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2347 |
|
|
On most machines, you can also use @code{$} in symbol names; exceptions
|
2348 |
|
|
are noted in @ref{Machine Dependencies}.
|
2349 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2350 |
|
|
No symbol may begin with a digit. Case is significant.
|
2351 |
|
|
There is no length limit: all characters are significant. Symbols are
|
2352 |
|
|
delimited by characters not in that set, or by the beginning of a file
|
2353 |
|
|
(since the source program must end with a newline, the end of a file is
|
2354 |
|
|
not a possible symbol delimiter). @xref{Symbols}.
|
2355 |
|
|
@cindex length of symbols
|
2356 |
|
|
|
2357 |
|
|
@node Statements
|
2358 |
|
|
@section Statements
|
2359 |
|
|
|
2360 |
|
|
@cindex statements, structure of
|
2361 |
|
|
@cindex line separator character
|
2362 |
|
|
@cindex statement separator character
|
2363 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2364 |
|
|
@ifclear abnormal-separator
|
2365 |
|
|
A @dfn{statement} ends at a newline character (@samp{\n}) or at a
|
2366 |
|
|
semicolon (@samp{;}). The newline or semicolon is considered part of
|
2367 |
|
|
the preceding statement. Newlines and semicolons within character
|
2368 |
|
|
constants are an exception: they do not end statements.
|
2369 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2370 |
|
|
@ifset abnormal-separator
|
2371 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2372 |
|
|
A @dfn{statement} ends at a newline character (@samp{\n}) or an exclamation
|
2373 |
|
|
point (@samp{!}). The newline or exclamation point is considered part of the
|
2374 |
|
|
preceding statement. Newlines and exclamation points within character
|
2375 |
|
|
constants are an exception: they do not end statements.
|
2376 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2377 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
2378 |
|
|
A @dfn{statement} ends at a newline character (@samp{\n}); or (for the
|
2379 |
|
|
H8/300) a dollar sign (@samp{$}); or (for the Renesas-SH) a semicolon
|
2380 |
|
|
(@samp{;}). The newline or separator character is considered part of
|
2381 |
|
|
the preceding statement. Newlines and separators within character
|
2382 |
|
|
constants are an exception: they do not end statements.
|
2383 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2384 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2385 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2386 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2387 |
|
|
A @dfn{statement} ends at a newline character (@samp{\n}) or line
|
2388 |
|
|
separator character. (The line separator is usually @samp{;}, unless this
|
2389 |
|
|
conflicts with the comment character; see @ref{Machine Dependencies}.) The
|
2390 |
|
|
newline or separator character is considered part of the preceding
|
2391 |
|
|
statement. Newlines and separators within character constants are an
|
2392 |
|
|
exception: they do not end statements.
|
2393 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2394 |
|
|
|
2395 |
|
|
@cindex newline, required at file end
|
2396 |
|
|
@cindex EOF, newline must precede
|
2397 |
|
|
It is an error to end any statement with end-of-file: the last
|
2398 |
|
|
character of any input file should be a newline.@refill
|
2399 |
|
|
|
2400 |
|
|
An empty statement is allowed, and may include whitespace. It is ignored.
|
2401 |
|
|
|
2402 |
|
|
@cindex instructions and directives
|
2403 |
|
|
@cindex directives and instructions
|
2404 |
|
|
@c "key symbol" is not used elsewhere in the document; seems pedantic to
|
2405 |
|
|
@c @defn{} it in that case, as was done previously... doc@cygnus.com,
|
2406 |
|
|
@c 13feb91.
|
2407 |
|
|
A statement begins with zero or more labels, optionally followed by a
|
2408 |
|
|
key symbol which determines what kind of statement it is. The key
|
2409 |
|
|
symbol determines the syntax of the rest of the statement. If the
|
2410 |
|
|
symbol begins with a dot @samp{.} then the statement is an assembler
|
2411 |
|
|
directive: typically valid for any computer. If the symbol begins with
|
2412 |
|
|
a letter the statement is an assembly language @dfn{instruction}: it
|
2413 |
|
|
assembles into a machine language instruction.
|
2414 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2415 |
|
|
Different versions of @command{@value{AS}} for different computers
|
2416 |
|
|
recognize different instructions. In fact, the same symbol may
|
2417 |
|
|
represent a different instruction in a different computer's assembly
|
2418 |
|
|
language.@refill
|
2419 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2420 |
|
|
|
2421 |
|
|
@cindex @code{:} (label)
|
2422 |
|
|
@cindex label (@code{:})
|
2423 |
|
|
A label is a symbol immediately followed by a colon (@code{:}).
|
2424 |
|
|
Whitespace before a label or after a colon is permitted, but you may not
|
2425 |
|
|
have whitespace between a label's symbol and its colon. @xref{Labels}.
|
2426 |
|
|
|
2427 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2428 |
|
|
For HPPA targets, labels need not be immediately followed by a colon, but
|
2429 |
|
|
the definition of a label must begin in column zero. This also implies that
|
2430 |
|
|
only one label may be defined on each line.
|
2431 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2432 |
|
|
|
2433 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2434 |
|
|
label: .directive followed by something
|
2435 |
|
|
another_label: # This is an empty statement.
|
2436 |
|
|
instruction operand_1, operand_2, @dots{}
|
2437 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2438 |
|
|
|
2439 |
|
|
@node Constants
|
2440 |
|
|
@section Constants
|
2441 |
|
|
|
2442 |
|
|
@cindex constants
|
2443 |
|
|
A constant is a number, written so that its value is known by
|
2444 |
|
|
inspection, without knowing any context. Like this:
|
2445 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2446 |
|
|
@group
|
2447 |
|
|
.byte 74, 0112, 092, 0x4A, 0X4a, 'J, '\J # All the same value.
|
2448 |
|
|
.ascii "Ring the bell\7" # A string constant.
|
2449 |
|
|
.octa 0x123456789abcdef0123456789ABCDEF0 # A bignum.
|
2450 |
|
|
.float 0f-314159265358979323846264338327\
|
2451 |
|
|
95028841971.693993751E-40 # - pi, a flonum.
|
2452 |
|
|
@end group
|
2453 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2454 |
|
|
|
2455 |
|
|
@menu
|
2456 |
|
|
* Characters:: Character Constants
|
2457 |
|
|
* Numbers:: Number Constants
|
2458 |
|
|
@end menu
|
2459 |
|
|
|
2460 |
|
|
@node Characters
|
2461 |
|
|
@subsection Character Constants
|
2462 |
|
|
|
2463 |
|
|
@cindex character constants
|
2464 |
|
|
@cindex constants, character
|
2465 |
|
|
There are two kinds of character constants. A @dfn{character} stands
|
2466 |
|
|
for one character in one byte and its value may be used in
|
2467 |
|
|
numeric expressions. String constants (properly called string
|
2468 |
|
|
@emph{literals}) are potentially many bytes and their values may not be
|
2469 |
|
|
used in arithmetic expressions.
|
2470 |
|
|
|
2471 |
|
|
@menu
|
2472 |
|
|
* Strings:: Strings
|
2473 |
|
|
* Chars:: Characters
|
2474 |
|
|
@end menu
|
2475 |
|
|
|
2476 |
|
|
@node Strings
|
2477 |
|
|
@subsubsection Strings
|
2478 |
|
|
|
2479 |
|
|
@cindex string constants
|
2480 |
|
|
@cindex constants, string
|
2481 |
|
|
A @dfn{string} is written between double-quotes. It may contain
|
2482 |
|
|
double-quotes or null characters. The way to get special characters
|
2483 |
|
|
into a string is to @dfn{escape} these characters: precede them with
|
2484 |
|
|
a backslash @samp{\} character. For example @samp{\\} represents
|
2485 |
|
|
one backslash: the first @code{\} is an escape which tells
|
2486 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} to interpret the second character literally as a backslash
|
2487 |
|
|
(which prevents @command{@value{AS}} from recognizing the second @code{\} as an
|
2488 |
|
|
escape character). The complete list of escapes follows.
|
2489 |
|
|
|
2490 |
|
|
@cindex escape codes, character
|
2491 |
|
|
@cindex character escape codes
|
2492 |
|
|
@table @kbd
|
2493 |
|
|
@c @item \a
|
2494 |
|
|
@c Mnemonic for ACKnowledge; for ASCII this is octal code 007.
|
2495 |
|
|
@c
|
2496 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\b} (backspace character)
|
2497 |
|
|
@cindex backspace (@code{\b})
|
2498 |
|
|
@item \b
|
2499 |
|
|
Mnemonic for backspace; for ASCII this is octal code 010.
|
2500 |
|
|
|
2501 |
|
|
@c @item \e
|
2502 |
|
|
@c Mnemonic for EOText; for ASCII this is octal code 004.
|
2503 |
|
|
@c
|
2504 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\f} (formfeed character)
|
2505 |
|
|
@cindex formfeed (@code{\f})
|
2506 |
|
|
@item \f
|
2507 |
|
|
Mnemonic for FormFeed; for ASCII this is octal code 014.
|
2508 |
|
|
|
2509 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\n} (newline character)
|
2510 |
|
|
@cindex newline (@code{\n})
|
2511 |
|
|
@item \n
|
2512 |
|
|
Mnemonic for newline; for ASCII this is octal code 012.
|
2513 |
|
|
|
2514 |
|
|
@c @item \p
|
2515 |
|
|
@c Mnemonic for prefix; for ASCII this is octal code 033, usually known as @code{escape}.
|
2516 |
|
|
@c
|
2517 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\r} (carriage return character)
|
2518 |
|
|
@cindex carriage return (@code{\r})
|
2519 |
|
|
@item \r
|
2520 |
|
|
Mnemonic for carriage-Return; for ASCII this is octal code 015.
|
2521 |
|
|
|
2522 |
|
|
@c @item \s
|
2523 |
|
|
@c Mnemonic for space; for ASCII this is octal code 040. Included for compliance with
|
2524 |
|
|
@c other assemblers.
|
2525 |
|
|
@c
|
2526 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\t} (tab)
|
2527 |
|
|
@cindex tab (@code{\t})
|
2528 |
|
|
@item \t
|
2529 |
|
|
Mnemonic for horizontal Tab; for ASCII this is octal code 011.
|
2530 |
|
|
|
2531 |
|
|
@c @item \v
|
2532 |
|
|
@c Mnemonic for Vertical tab; for ASCII this is octal code 013.
|
2533 |
|
|
@c @item \x @var{digit} @var{digit} @var{digit}
|
2534 |
|
|
@c A hexadecimal character code. The numeric code is 3 hexadecimal digits.
|
2535 |
|
|
@c
|
2536 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\@var{ddd}} (octal character code)
|
2537 |
|
|
@cindex octal character code (@code{\@var{ddd}})
|
2538 |
|
|
@item \ @var{digit} @var{digit} @var{digit}
|
2539 |
|
|
An octal character code. The numeric code is 3 octal digits.
|
2540 |
|
|
For compatibility with other Unix systems, 8 and 9 are accepted as digits:
|
2541 |
|
|
for example, @code{\008} has the value 010, and @code{\009} the value 011.
|
2542 |
|
|
|
2543 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\@var{xd...}} (hex character code)
|
2544 |
|
|
@cindex hex character code (@code{\@var{xd...}})
|
2545 |
|
|
@item \@code{x} @var{hex-digits...}
|
2546 |
|
|
A hex character code. All trailing hex digits are combined. Either upper or
|
2547 |
|
|
lower case @code{x} works.
|
2548 |
|
|
|
2549 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\\} (@samp{\} character)
|
2550 |
|
|
@cindex backslash (@code{\\})
|
2551 |
|
|
@item \\
|
2552 |
|
|
Represents one @samp{\} character.
|
2553 |
|
|
|
2554 |
|
|
@c @item \'
|
2555 |
|
|
@c Represents one @samp{'} (accent acute) character.
|
2556 |
|
|
@c This is needed in single character literals
|
2557 |
|
|
@c (@xref{Characters,,Character Constants}.) to represent
|
2558 |
|
|
@c a @samp{'}.
|
2559 |
|
|
@c
|
2560 |
|
|
@cindex @code{\"} (doublequote character)
|
2561 |
|
|
@cindex doublequote (@code{\"})
|
2562 |
|
|
@item \"
|
2563 |
|
|
Represents one @samp{"} character. Needed in strings to represent
|
2564 |
|
|
this character, because an unescaped @samp{"} would end the string.
|
2565 |
|
|
|
2566 |
|
|
@item \ @var{anything-else}
|
2567 |
|
|
Any other character when escaped by @kbd{\} gives a warning, but
|
2568 |
|
|
assembles as if the @samp{\} was not present. The idea is that if
|
2569 |
|
|
you used an escape sequence you clearly didn't want the literal
|
2570 |
|
|
interpretation of the following character. However @command{@value{AS}} has no
|
2571 |
|
|
other interpretation, so @command{@value{AS}} knows it is giving you the wrong
|
2572 |
|
|
code and warns you of the fact.
|
2573 |
|
|
@end table
|
2574 |
|
|
|
2575 |
|
|
Which characters are escapable, and what those escapes represent,
|
2576 |
|
|
varies widely among assemblers. The current set is what we think
|
2577 |
|
|
the BSD 4.2 assembler recognizes, and is a subset of what most C
|
2578 |
|
|
compilers recognize. If you are in doubt, do not use an escape
|
2579 |
|
|
sequence.
|
2580 |
|
|
|
2581 |
|
|
@node Chars
|
2582 |
|
|
@subsubsection Characters
|
2583 |
|
|
|
2584 |
|
|
@cindex single character constant
|
2585 |
|
|
@cindex character, single
|
2586 |
|
|
@cindex constant, single character
|
2587 |
|
|
A single character may be written as a single quote immediately
|
2588 |
|
|
followed by that character. The same escapes apply to characters as
|
2589 |
|
|
to strings. So if you want to write the character backslash, you
|
2590 |
|
|
must write @kbd{'\\} where the first @code{\} escapes the second
|
2591 |
|
|
@code{\}. As you can see, the quote is an acute accent, not a
|
2592 |
|
|
grave accent. A newline
|
2593 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2594 |
|
|
@ifclear abnormal-separator
|
2595 |
|
|
(or semicolon @samp{;})
|
2596 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2597 |
|
|
@ifset abnormal-separator
|
2598 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
2599 |
|
|
(or dollar sign @samp{$}, for the H8/300; or semicolon @samp{;} for the
|
2600 |
|
|
Renesas SH)
|
2601 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2602 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2603 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2604 |
|
|
immediately following an acute accent is taken as a literal character
|
2605 |
|
|
and does not count as the end of a statement. The value of a character
|
2606 |
|
|
constant in a numeric expression is the machine's byte-wide code for
|
2607 |
|
|
that character. @command{@value{AS}} assumes your character code is ASCII:
|
2608 |
|
|
@kbd{'A} means 65, @kbd{'B} means 66, and so on. @refill
|
2609 |
|
|
|
2610 |
|
|
@node Numbers
|
2611 |
|
|
@subsection Number Constants
|
2612 |
|
|
|
2613 |
|
|
@cindex constants, number
|
2614 |
|
|
@cindex number constants
|
2615 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} distinguishes three kinds of numbers according to how they
|
2616 |
|
|
are stored in the target machine. @emph{Integers} are numbers that
|
2617 |
|
|
would fit into an @code{int} in the C language. @emph{Bignums} are
|
2618 |
|
|
integers, but they are stored in more than 32 bits. @emph{Flonums}
|
2619 |
|
|
are floating point numbers, described below.
|
2620 |
|
|
|
2621 |
|
|
@menu
|
2622 |
|
|
* Integers:: Integers
|
2623 |
|
|
* Bignums:: Bignums
|
2624 |
|
|
* Flonums:: Flonums
|
2625 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2626 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
2627 |
|
|
* Bit Fields:: Bit Fields
|
2628 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2629 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2630 |
|
|
@end menu
|
2631 |
|
|
|
2632 |
|
|
@node Integers
|
2633 |
|
|
@subsubsection Integers
|
2634 |
|
|
@cindex integers
|
2635 |
|
|
@cindex constants, integer
|
2636 |
|
|
|
2637 |
|
|
@cindex binary integers
|
2638 |
|
|
@cindex integers, binary
|
2639 |
|
|
A binary integer is @samp{0b} or @samp{0B} followed by zero or more of
|
2640 |
|
|
the binary digits @samp{01}.
|
2641 |
|
|
|
2642 |
|
|
@cindex octal integers
|
2643 |
|
|
@cindex integers, octal
|
2644 |
|
|
An octal integer is @samp{0} followed by zero or more of the octal
|
2645 |
|
|
digits (@samp{01234567}).
|
2646 |
|
|
|
2647 |
|
|
@cindex decimal integers
|
2648 |
|
|
@cindex integers, decimal
|
2649 |
|
|
A decimal integer starts with a non-zero digit followed by zero or
|
2650 |
|
|
more digits (@samp{0123456789}).
|
2651 |
|
|
|
2652 |
|
|
@cindex hexadecimal integers
|
2653 |
|
|
@cindex integers, hexadecimal
|
2654 |
|
|
A hexadecimal integer is @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} followed by one or
|
2655 |
|
|
more hexadecimal digits chosen from @samp{0123456789abcdefABCDEF}.
|
2656 |
|
|
|
2657 |
|
|
Integers have the usual values. To denote a negative integer, use
|
2658 |
|
|
the prefix operator @samp{-} discussed under expressions
|
2659 |
|
|
(@pxref{Prefix Ops,,Prefix Operators}).
|
2660 |
|
|
|
2661 |
|
|
@node Bignums
|
2662 |
|
|
@subsubsection Bignums
|
2663 |
|
|
|
2664 |
|
|
@cindex bignums
|
2665 |
|
|
@cindex constants, bignum
|
2666 |
|
|
A @dfn{bignum} has the same syntax and semantics as an integer
|
2667 |
|
|
except that the number (or its negative) takes more than 32 bits to
|
2668 |
|
|
represent in binary. The distinction is made because in some places
|
2669 |
|
|
integers are permitted while bignums are not.
|
2670 |
|
|
|
2671 |
|
|
@node Flonums
|
2672 |
|
|
@subsubsection Flonums
|
2673 |
|
|
@cindex flonums
|
2674 |
|
|
@cindex floating point numbers
|
2675 |
|
|
@cindex constants, floating point
|
2676 |
|
|
|
2677 |
|
|
@cindex precision, floating point
|
2678 |
|
|
A @dfn{flonum} represents a floating point number. The translation is
|
2679 |
|
|
indirect: a decimal floating point number from the text is converted by
|
2680 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} to a generic binary floating point number of more than
|
2681 |
|
|
sufficient precision. This generic floating point number is converted
|
2682 |
|
|
to a particular computer's floating point format (or formats) by a
|
2683 |
|
|
portion of @command{@value{AS}} specialized to that computer.
|
2684 |
|
|
|
2685 |
|
|
A flonum is written by writing (in order)
|
2686 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
2687 |
|
|
@item
|
2688 |
|
|
The digit @samp{0}.
|
2689 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2690 |
|
|
(@samp{0} is optional on the HPPA.)
|
2691 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2692 |
|
|
|
2693 |
|
|
@item
|
2694 |
|
|
A letter, to tell @command{@value{AS}} the rest of the number is a flonum.
|
2695 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2696 |
|
|
@kbd{e} is recommended. Case is not important.
|
2697 |
|
|
@ignore
|
2698 |
|
|
@c FIXME: verify if flonum syntax really this vague for most cases
|
2699 |
|
|
(Any otherwise illegal letter works here, but that might be changed. Vax BSD
|
2700 |
|
|
4.2 assembler seems to allow any of @samp{defghDEFGH}.)
|
2701 |
|
|
@end ignore
|
2702 |
|
|
|
2703 |
|
|
On the H8/300, Renesas / SuperH SH,
|
2704 |
|
|
and AMD 29K architectures, the letter must be
|
2705 |
|
|
one of the letters @samp{DFPRSX} (in upper or lower case).
|
2706 |
|
|
|
2707 |
|
|
On the ARC, the letter must be one of the letters @samp{DFRS}
|
2708 |
|
|
(in upper or lower case).
|
2709 |
|
|
|
2710 |
|
|
On the Intel 960 architecture, the letter must be
|
2711 |
|
|
one of the letters @samp{DFT} (in upper or lower case).
|
2712 |
|
|
|
2713 |
|
|
On the HPPA architecture, the letter must be @samp{E} (upper case only).
|
2714 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2715 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2716 |
|
|
@ifset ARC
|
2717 |
|
|
One of the letters @samp{DFRS} (in upper or lower case).
|
2718 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2719 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
2720 |
|
|
One of the letters @samp{DFPRSX} (in upper or lower case).
|
2721 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2722 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2723 |
|
|
The letter @samp{E} (upper case only).
|
2724 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2725 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
2726 |
|
|
One of the letters @samp{DFT} (in upper or lower case).
|
2727 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2728 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2729 |
|
|
|
2730 |
|
|
@item
|
2731 |
|
|
An optional sign: either @samp{+} or @samp{-}.
|
2732 |
|
|
|
2733 |
|
|
@item
|
2734 |
|
|
An optional @dfn{integer part}: zero or more decimal digits.
|
2735 |
|
|
|
2736 |
|
|
@item
|
2737 |
|
|
An optional @dfn{fractional part}: @samp{.} followed by zero
|
2738 |
|
|
or more decimal digits.
|
2739 |
|
|
|
2740 |
|
|
@item
|
2741 |
|
|
An optional exponent, consisting of:
|
2742 |
|
|
|
2743 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
2744 |
|
|
@item
|
2745 |
|
|
An @samp{E} or @samp{e}.
|
2746 |
|
|
@c I can't find a config where "EXP_CHARS" is other than 'eE', but in
|
2747 |
|
|
@c principle this can perfectly well be different on different targets.
|
2748 |
|
|
@item
|
2749 |
|
|
Optional sign: either @samp{+} or @samp{-}.
|
2750 |
|
|
@item
|
2751 |
|
|
One or more decimal digits.
|
2752 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
2753 |
|
|
|
2754 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
2755 |
|
|
|
2756 |
|
|
At least one of the integer part or the fractional part must be
|
2757 |
|
|
present. The floating point number has the usual base-10 value.
|
2758 |
|
|
|
2759 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} does all processing using integers. Flonums are computed
|
2760 |
|
|
independently of any floating point hardware in the computer running
|
2761 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}}.
|
2762 |
|
|
|
2763 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
2764 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
2765 |
|
|
@c Bit fields are written as a general facility but are also controlled
|
2766 |
|
|
@c by a conditional-compilation flag---which is as of now (21mar91)
|
2767 |
|
|
@c turned on only by the i960 config of GAS.
|
2768 |
|
|
@node Bit Fields
|
2769 |
|
|
@subsubsection Bit Fields
|
2770 |
|
|
|
2771 |
|
|
@cindex bit fields
|
2772 |
|
|
@cindex constants, bit field
|
2773 |
|
|
You can also define numeric constants as @dfn{bit fields}.
|
2774 |
|
|
Specify two numbers separated by a colon---
|
2775 |
|
|
@example
|
2776 |
|
|
@var{mask}:@var{value}
|
2777 |
|
|
@end example
|
2778 |
|
|
@noindent
|
2779 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} applies a bitwise @sc{and} between @var{mask} and
|
2780 |
|
|
@var{value}.
|
2781 |
|
|
|
2782 |
|
|
The resulting number is then packed
|
2783 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2784 |
|
|
@c this conditional paren in case bit fields turned on elsewhere than 960
|
2785 |
|
|
(in host-dependent byte order)
|
2786 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2787 |
|
|
into a field whose width depends on which assembler directive has the
|
2788 |
|
|
bit-field as its argument. Overflow (a result from the bitwise and
|
2789 |
|
|
requiring more binary digits to represent) is not an error; instead,
|
2790 |
|
|
more constants are generated, of the specified width, beginning with the
|
2791 |
|
|
least significant digits.@refill
|
2792 |
|
|
|
2793 |
|
|
The directives @code{.byte}, @code{.hword}, @code{.int}, @code{.long},
|
2794 |
|
|
@code{.short}, and @code{.word} accept bit-field arguments.
|
2795 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2796 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
2797 |
|
|
|
2798 |
|
|
@node Sections
|
2799 |
|
|
@chapter Sections and Relocation
|
2800 |
|
|
@cindex sections
|
2801 |
|
|
@cindex relocation
|
2802 |
|
|
|
2803 |
|
|
@menu
|
2804 |
|
|
* Secs Background:: Background
|
2805 |
|
|
* Ld Sections:: Linker Sections
|
2806 |
|
|
* As Sections:: Assembler Internal Sections
|
2807 |
|
|
* Sub-Sections:: Sub-Sections
|
2808 |
|
|
* bss:: bss Section
|
2809 |
|
|
@end menu
|
2810 |
|
|
|
2811 |
|
|
@node Secs Background
|
2812 |
|
|
@section Background
|
2813 |
|
|
|
2814 |
|
|
Roughly, a section is a range of addresses, with no gaps; all data
|
2815 |
|
|
``in'' those addresses is treated the same for some particular purpose.
|
2816 |
|
|
For example there may be a ``read only'' section.
|
2817 |
|
|
|
2818 |
|
|
@cindex linker, and assembler
|
2819 |
|
|
@cindex assembler, and linker
|
2820 |
|
|
The linker @code{@value{LD}} reads many object files (partial programs) and
|
2821 |
|
|
combines their contents to form a runnable program. When @command{@value{AS}}
|
2822 |
|
|
emits an object file, the partial program is assumed to start at address 0.
|
2823 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}} assigns the final addresses for the partial program, so that
|
2824 |
|
|
different partial programs do not overlap. This is actually an
|
2825 |
|
|
oversimplification, but it suffices to explain how @command{@value{AS}} uses
|
2826 |
|
|
sections.
|
2827 |
|
|
|
2828 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}} moves blocks of bytes of your program to their run-time
|
2829 |
|
|
addresses. These blocks slide to their run-time addresses as rigid
|
2830 |
|
|
units; their length does not change and neither does the order of bytes
|
2831 |
|
|
within them. Such a rigid unit is called a @emph{section}. Assigning
|
2832 |
|
|
run-time addresses to sections is called @dfn{relocation}. It includes
|
2833 |
|
|
the task of adjusting mentions of object-file addresses so they refer to
|
2834 |
|
|
the proper run-time addresses.
|
2835 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
2836 |
|
|
For the H8/300, and for the Renesas / SuperH SH,
|
2837 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} pads sections if needed to
|
2838 |
|
|
ensure they end on a word (sixteen bit) boundary.
|
2839 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2840 |
|
|
|
2841 |
|
|
@cindex standard assembler sections
|
2842 |
|
|
An object file written by @command{@value{AS}} has at least three sections, any
|
2843 |
|
|
of which may be empty. These are named @dfn{text}, @dfn{data} and
|
2844 |
|
|
@dfn{bss} sections.
|
2845 |
|
|
|
2846 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
2847 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2848 |
|
|
When it generates COFF or ELF output,
|
2849 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2850 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} can also generate whatever other named sections you specify
|
2851 |
|
|
using the @samp{.section} directive (@pxref{Section,,@code{.section}}).
|
2852 |
|
|
If you do not use any directives that place output in the @samp{.text}
|
2853 |
|
|
or @samp{.data} sections, these sections still exist, but are empty.
|
2854 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2855 |
|
|
|
2856 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2857 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
2858 |
|
|
When @command{@value{AS}} generates SOM or ELF output for the HPPA,
|
2859 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2860 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} can also generate whatever other named sections you
|
2861 |
|
|
specify using the @samp{.space} and @samp{.subspace} directives. See
|
2862 |
|
|
@cite{HP9000 Series 800 Assembly Language Reference Manual}
|
2863 |
|
|
(HP 92432-90001) for details on the @samp{.space} and @samp{.subspace}
|
2864 |
|
|
assembler directives.
|
2865 |
|
|
|
2866 |
|
|
@ifset SOM
|
2867 |
|
|
Additionally, @command{@value{AS}} uses different names for the standard
|
2868 |
|
|
text, data, and bss sections when generating SOM output. Program text
|
2869 |
|
|
is placed into the @samp{$CODE$} section, data into @samp{$DATA$}, and
|
2870 |
|
|
BSS into @samp{$BSS$}.
|
2871 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2872 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2873 |
|
|
|
2874 |
|
|
Within the object file, the text section starts at address @code{0}, the
|
2875 |
|
|
data section follows, and the bss section follows the data section.
|
2876 |
|
|
|
2877 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
2878 |
|
|
When generating either SOM or ELF output files on the HPPA, the text
|
2879 |
|
|
section starts at address @code{0}, the data section at address
|
2880 |
|
|
@code{0x4000000}, and the bss section follows the data section.
|
2881 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2882 |
|
|
|
2883 |
|
|
To let @code{@value{LD}} know which data changes when the sections are
|
2884 |
|
|
relocated, and how to change that data, @command{@value{AS}} also writes to the
|
2885 |
|
|
object file details of the relocation needed. To perform relocation
|
2886 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}} must know, each time an address in the object
|
2887 |
|
|
file is mentioned:
|
2888 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
2889 |
|
|
@item
|
2890 |
|
|
Where in the object file is the beginning of this reference to
|
2891 |
|
|
an address?
|
2892 |
|
|
@item
|
2893 |
|
|
How long (in bytes) is this reference?
|
2894 |
|
|
@item
|
2895 |
|
|
Which section does the address refer to? What is the numeric value of
|
2896 |
|
|
@display
|
2897 |
|
|
(@var{address}) @minus{} (@var{start-address of section})?
|
2898 |
|
|
@end display
|
2899 |
|
|
@item
|
2900 |
|
|
Is the reference to an address ``Program-Counter relative''?
|
2901 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
2902 |
|
|
|
2903 |
|
|
@cindex addresses, format of
|
2904 |
|
|
@cindex section-relative addressing
|
2905 |
|
|
In fact, every address @command{@value{AS}} ever uses is expressed as
|
2906 |
|
|
@display
|
2907 |
|
|
(@var{section}) + (@var{offset into section})
|
2908 |
|
|
@end display
|
2909 |
|
|
@noindent
|
2910 |
|
|
Further, most expressions @command{@value{AS}} computes have this section-relative
|
2911 |
|
|
nature.
|
2912 |
|
|
@ifset SOM
|
2913 |
|
|
(For some object formats, such as SOM for the HPPA, some expressions are
|
2914 |
|
|
symbol-relative instead.)
|
2915 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2916 |
|
|
|
2917 |
|
|
In this manual we use the notation @{@var{secname} @var{N}@} to mean ``offset
|
2918 |
|
|
@var{N} into section @var{secname}.''
|
2919 |
|
|
|
2920 |
|
|
Apart from text, data and bss sections you need to know about the
|
2921 |
|
|
@dfn{absolute} section. When @code{@value{LD}} mixes partial programs,
|
2922 |
|
|
addresses in the absolute section remain unchanged. For example, address
|
2923 |
|
|
@code{@{absolute 0@}} is ``relocated'' to run-time address 0 by
|
2924 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}}. Although the linker never arranges two partial programs'
|
2925 |
|
|
data sections with overlapping addresses after linking, @emph{by definition}
|
2926 |
|
|
their absolute sections must overlap. Address @code{@{absolute@ 239@}} in one
|
2927 |
|
|
part of a program is always the same address when the program is running as
|
2928 |
|
|
address @code{@{absolute@ 239@}} in any other part of the program.
|
2929 |
|
|
|
2930 |
|
|
The idea of sections is extended to the @dfn{undefined} section. Any
|
2931 |
|
|
address whose section is unknown at assembly time is by definition
|
2932 |
|
|
rendered @{undefined @var{U}@}---where @var{U} is filled in later.
|
2933 |
|
|
Since numbers are always defined, the only way to generate an undefined
|
2934 |
|
|
address is to mention an undefined symbol. A reference to a named
|
2935 |
|
|
common block would be such a symbol: its value is unknown at assembly
|
2936 |
|
|
time so it has section @emph{undefined}.
|
2937 |
|
|
|
2938 |
|
|
By analogy the word @emph{section} is used to describe groups of sections in
|
2939 |
|
|
the linked program. @code{@value{LD}} puts all partial programs' text
|
2940 |
|
|
sections in contiguous addresses in the linked program. It is
|
2941 |
|
|
customary to refer to the @emph{text section} of a program, meaning all
|
2942 |
|
|
the addresses of all partial programs' text sections. Likewise for
|
2943 |
|
|
data and bss sections.
|
2944 |
|
|
|
2945 |
|
|
Some sections are manipulated by @code{@value{LD}}; others are invented for
|
2946 |
|
|
use of @command{@value{AS}} and have no meaning except during assembly.
|
2947 |
|
|
|
2948 |
|
|
@node Ld Sections
|
2949 |
|
|
@section Linker Sections
|
2950 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}} deals with just four kinds of sections, summarized below.
|
2951 |
|
|
|
2952 |
|
|
@table @strong
|
2953 |
|
|
|
2954 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
2955 |
|
|
@cindex named sections
|
2956 |
|
|
@cindex sections, named
|
2957 |
|
|
@item named sections
|
2958 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2959 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
2960 |
|
|
@cindex text section
|
2961 |
|
|
@cindex data section
|
2962 |
|
|
@itemx text section
|
2963 |
|
|
@itemx data section
|
2964 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
2965 |
|
|
These sections hold your program. @command{@value{AS}} and @code{@value{LD}} treat them as
|
2966 |
|
|
separate but equal sections. Anything you can say of one section is
|
2967 |
|
|
true of another.
|
2968 |
|
|
@c @ifset aout-bout
|
2969 |
|
|
When the program is running, however, it is
|
2970 |
|
|
customary for the text section to be unalterable. The
|
2971 |
|
|
text section is often shared among processes: it contains
|
2972 |
|
|
instructions, constants and the like. The data section of a running
|
2973 |
|
|
program is usually alterable: for example, C variables would be stored
|
2974 |
|
|
in the data section.
|
2975 |
|
|
@c @end ifset
|
2976 |
|
|
|
2977 |
|
|
@cindex bss section
|
2978 |
|
|
@item bss section
|
2979 |
|
|
This section contains zeroed bytes when your program begins running. It
|
2980 |
|
|
is used to hold uninitialized variables or common storage. The length of
|
2981 |
|
|
each partial program's bss section is important, but because it starts
|
2982 |
|
|
out containing zeroed bytes there is no need to store explicit zero
|
2983 |
|
|
bytes in the object file. The bss section was invented to eliminate
|
2984 |
|
|
those explicit zeros from object files.
|
2985 |
|
|
|
2986 |
|
|
@cindex absolute section
|
2987 |
|
|
@item absolute section
|
2988 |
|
|
Address 0 of this section is always ``relocated'' to runtime address 0.
|
2989 |
|
|
This is useful if you want to refer to an address that @code{@value{LD}} must
|
2990 |
|
|
not change when relocating. In this sense we speak of absolute
|
2991 |
|
|
addresses being ``unrelocatable'': they do not change during relocation.
|
2992 |
|
|
|
2993 |
|
|
@cindex undefined section
|
2994 |
|
|
@item undefined section
|
2995 |
|
|
This ``section'' is a catch-all for address references to objects not in
|
2996 |
|
|
the preceding sections.
|
2997 |
|
|
@c FIXME: ref to some other doc on obj-file formats could go here.
|
2998 |
|
|
@end table
|
2999 |
|
|
|
3000 |
|
|
@cindex relocation example
|
3001 |
|
|
An idealized example of three relocatable sections follows.
|
3002 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
3003 |
|
|
The example uses the traditional section names @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}.
|
3004 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3005 |
|
|
Memory addresses are on the horizontal axis.
|
3006 |
|
|
|
3007 |
|
|
@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
|
3008 |
|
|
@ifnottex
|
3009 |
|
|
@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
|
3010 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3011 |
|
|
+-----+----+--+
|
3012 |
|
|
partial program # 1: |ttttt|dddd|00|
|
3013 |
|
|
+-----+----+--+
|
3014 |
|
|
|
3015 |
|
|
text data bss
|
3016 |
|
|
seg. seg. seg.
|
3017 |
|
|
|
3018 |
|
|
+---+---+---+
|
3019 |
|
|
partial program # 2: |TTT|DDD|000|
|
3020 |
|
|
+---+---+---+
|
3021 |
|
|
|
3022 |
|
|
+--+---+-----+--+----+---+-----+~~
|
3023 |
|
|
linked program: | |TTT|ttttt| |dddd|DDD|00000|
|
3024 |
|
|
+--+---+-----+--+----+---+-----+~~
|
3025 |
|
|
|
3026 |
|
|
addresses: 0 @dots{}
|
3027 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3028 |
|
|
@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
|
3029 |
|
|
@end ifnottex
|
3030 |
|
|
@need 5000
|
3031 |
|
|
@tex
|
3032 |
|
|
\bigskip
|
3033 |
|
|
\line{\it Partial program \#1: \hfil}
|
3034 |
|
|
\line{\ibox{2.5cm}{\tt text}\ibox{2cm}{\tt data}\ibox{1cm}{\tt bss}\hfil}
|
3035 |
|
|
\line{\boxit{2.5cm}{\tt ttttt}\boxit{2cm}{\tt dddd}\boxit{1cm}{\tt 00}\hfil}
|
3036 |
|
|
|
3037 |
|
|
\line{\it Partial program \#2: \hfil}
|
3038 |
|
|
\line{\ibox{1cm}{\tt text}\ibox{1.5cm}{\tt data}\ibox{1cm}{\tt bss}\hfil}
|
3039 |
|
|
\line{\boxit{1cm}{\tt TTT}\boxit{1.5cm}{\tt DDDD}\boxit{1cm}{\tt 000}\hfil}
|
3040 |
|
|
|
3041 |
|
|
\line{\it linked program: \hfil}
|
3042 |
|
|
\line{\ibox{.5cm}{}\ibox{1cm}{\tt text}\ibox{2.5cm}{}\ibox{.75cm}{}\ibox{2cm}{\tt data}\ibox{1.5cm}{}\ibox{2cm}{\tt bss}\hfil}
|
3043 |
|
|
\line{\boxit{.5cm}{}\boxit{1cm}{\tt TTT}\boxit{2.5cm}{\tt
|
3044 |
|
|
ttttt}\boxit{.75cm}{}\boxit{2cm}{\tt dddd}\boxit{1.5cm}{\tt
|
3045 |
|
|
DDDD}\boxit{2cm}{\tt 00000}\ \dots\hfil}
|
3046 |
|
|
|
3047 |
|
|
\line{\it addresses: \hfil}
|
3048 |
|
|
\line{0\dots\hfil}
|
3049 |
|
|
|
3050 |
|
|
@end tex
|
3051 |
|
|
@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
|
3052 |
|
|
|
3053 |
|
|
@node As Sections
|
3054 |
|
|
@section Assembler Internal Sections
|
3055 |
|
|
|
3056 |
|
|
@cindex internal assembler sections
|
3057 |
|
|
@cindex sections in messages, internal
|
3058 |
|
|
These sections are meant only for the internal use of @command{@value{AS}}. They
|
3059 |
|
|
have no meaning at run-time. You do not really need to know about these
|
3060 |
|
|
sections for most purposes; but they can be mentioned in @command{@value{AS}}
|
3061 |
|
|
warning messages, so it might be helpful to have an idea of their
|
3062 |
|
|
meanings to @command{@value{AS}}. These sections are used to permit the
|
3063 |
|
|
value of every expression in your assembly language program to be a
|
3064 |
|
|
section-relative address.
|
3065 |
|
|
|
3066 |
|
|
@table @b
|
3067 |
|
|
@cindex assembler internal logic error
|
3068 |
|
|
@item ASSEMBLER-INTERNAL-LOGIC-ERROR!
|
3069 |
|
|
An internal assembler logic error has been found. This means there is a
|
3070 |
|
|
bug in the assembler.
|
3071 |
|
|
|
3072 |
|
|
@cindex expr (internal section)
|
3073 |
|
|
@item expr section
|
3074 |
|
|
The assembler stores complex expression internally as combinations of
|
3075 |
|
|
symbols. When it needs to represent an expression as a symbol, it puts
|
3076 |
|
|
it in the expr section.
|
3077 |
|
|
@c FIXME item debug
|
3078 |
|
|
@c FIXME item transfer[t] vector preload
|
3079 |
|
|
@c FIXME item transfer[t] vector postload
|
3080 |
|
|
@c FIXME item register
|
3081 |
|
|
@end table
|
3082 |
|
|
|
3083 |
|
|
@node Sub-Sections
|
3084 |
|
|
@section Sub-Sections
|
3085 |
|
|
|
3086 |
|
|
@cindex numbered subsections
|
3087 |
|
|
@cindex grouping data
|
3088 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
3089 |
|
|
Assembled bytes
|
3090 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
3091 |
|
|
conventionally
|
3092 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3093 |
|
|
fall into two sections: text and data.
|
3094 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3095 |
|
|
You may have separate groups of
|
3096 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3097 |
|
|
data in named sections
|
3098 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3099 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3100 |
|
|
@ifclear aout-bout
|
3101 |
|
|
data in named sections
|
3102 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3103 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
3104 |
|
|
text or data
|
3105 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3106 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3107 |
|
|
that you want to end up near to each other in the object file, even though they
|
3108 |
|
|
are not contiguous in the assembler source. @command{@value{AS}} allows you to
|
3109 |
|
|
use @dfn{subsections} for this purpose. Within each section, there can be
|
3110 |
|
|
numbered subsections with values from 0 to 8192. Objects assembled into the
|
3111 |
|
|
same subsection go into the object file together with other objects in the same
|
3112 |
|
|
subsection. For example, a compiler might want to store constants in the text
|
3113 |
|
|
section, but might not want to have them interspersed with the program being
|
3114 |
|
|
assembled. In this case, the compiler could issue a @samp{.text 0} before each
|
3115 |
|
|
section of code being output, and a @samp{.text 1} before each group of
|
3116 |
|
|
constants being output.
|
3117 |
|
|
|
3118 |
|
|
Subsections are optional. If you do not use subsections, everything
|
3119 |
|
|
goes in subsection number zero.
|
3120 |
|
|
|
3121 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3122 |
|
|
Each subsection is zero-padded up to a multiple of four bytes.
|
3123 |
|
|
(Subsections may be padded a different amount on different flavors
|
3124 |
|
|
of @command{@value{AS}}.)
|
3125 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3126 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3127 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
3128 |
|
|
On the H8/300 platform, each subsection is zero-padded to a word
|
3129 |
|
|
boundary (two bytes).
|
3130 |
|
|
The same is true on the Renesas SH.
|
3131 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3132 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
3133 |
|
|
@c FIXME section padding (alignment)?
|
3134 |
|
|
@c Rich Pixley says padding here depends on target obj code format; that
|
3135 |
|
|
@c doesn't seem particularly useful to say without further elaboration,
|
3136 |
|
|
@c so for now I say nothing about it. If this is a generic BFD issue,
|
3137 |
|
|
@c these paragraphs might need to vanish from this manual, and be
|
3138 |
|
|
@c discussed in BFD chapter of binutils (or some such).
|
3139 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3140 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3141 |
|
|
|
3142 |
|
|
Subsections appear in your object file in numeric order, lowest numbered
|
3143 |
|
|
to highest. (All this to be compatible with other people's assemblers.)
|
3144 |
|
|
The object file contains no representation of subsections; @code{@value{LD}} and
|
3145 |
|
|
other programs that manipulate object files see no trace of them.
|
3146 |
|
|
They just see all your text subsections as a text section, and all your
|
3147 |
|
|
data subsections as a data section.
|
3148 |
|
|
|
3149 |
|
|
To specify which subsection you want subsequent statements assembled
|
3150 |
|
|
into, use a numeric argument to specify it, in a @samp{.text
|
3151 |
|
|
@var{expression}} or a @samp{.data @var{expression}} statement.
|
3152 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3153 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3154 |
|
|
When generating COFF output, you
|
3155 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3156 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3157 |
|
|
You
|
3158 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3159 |
|
|
can also use an extra subsection
|
3160 |
|
|
argument with arbitrary named sections: @samp{.section @var{name},
|
3161 |
|
|
@var{expression}}.
|
3162 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3163 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3164 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3165 |
|
|
When generating ELF output, you
|
3166 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3167 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3168 |
|
|
You
|
3169 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3170 |
|
|
can also use the @code{.subsection} directive (@pxref{SubSection})
|
3171 |
|
|
to specify a subsection: @samp{.subsection @var{expression}}.
|
3172 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3173 |
|
|
@var{Expression} should be an absolute expression
|
3174 |
|
|
(@pxref{Expressions}). If you just say @samp{.text} then @samp{.text 0}
|
3175 |
|
|
is assumed. Likewise @samp{.data} means @samp{.data 0}. Assembly
|
3176 |
|
|
begins in @code{text 0}. For instance:
|
3177 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3178 |
|
|
.text 0 # The default subsection is text 0 anyway.
|
3179 |
|
|
.ascii "This lives in the first text subsection. *"
|
3180 |
|
|
.text 1
|
3181 |
|
|
.ascii "But this lives in the second text subsection."
|
3182 |
|
|
.data 0
|
3183 |
|
|
.ascii "This lives in the data section,"
|
3184 |
|
|
.ascii "in the first data subsection."
|
3185 |
|
|
.text 0
|
3186 |
|
|
.ascii "This lives in the first text section,"
|
3187 |
|
|
.ascii "immediately following the asterisk (*)."
|
3188 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3189 |
|
|
|
3190 |
|
|
Each section has a @dfn{location counter} incremented by one for every byte
|
3191 |
|
|
assembled into that section. Because subsections are merely a convenience
|
3192 |
|
|
restricted to @command{@value{AS}} there is no concept of a subsection location
|
3193 |
|
|
counter. There is no way to directly manipulate a location counter---but the
|
3194 |
|
|
@code{.align} directive changes it, and any label definition captures its
|
3195 |
|
|
current value. The location counter of the section where statements are being
|
3196 |
|
|
assembled is said to be the @dfn{active} location counter.
|
3197 |
|
|
|
3198 |
|
|
@node bss
|
3199 |
|
|
@section bss Section
|
3200 |
|
|
|
3201 |
|
|
@cindex bss section
|
3202 |
|
|
@cindex common variable storage
|
3203 |
|
|
The bss section is used for local common variable storage.
|
3204 |
|
|
You may allocate address space in the bss section, but you may
|
3205 |
|
|
not dictate data to load into it before your program executes. When
|
3206 |
|
|
your program starts running, all the contents of the bss
|
3207 |
|
|
section are zeroed bytes.
|
3208 |
|
|
|
3209 |
|
|
The @code{.lcomm} pseudo-op defines a symbol in the bss section; see
|
3210 |
|
|
@ref{Lcomm,,@code{.lcomm}}.
|
3211 |
|
|
|
3212 |
|
|
The @code{.comm} pseudo-op may be used to declare a common symbol, which is
|
3213 |
|
|
another form of uninitialized symbol; see @ref{Comm,,@code{.comm}}.
|
3214 |
|
|
|
3215 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3216 |
|
|
When assembling for a target which supports multiple sections, such as ELF or
|
3217 |
|
|
COFF, you may switch into the @code{.bss} section and define symbols as usual;
|
3218 |
|
|
see @ref{Section,,@code{.section}}. You may only assemble zero values into the
|
3219 |
|
|
section. Typically the section will only contain symbol definitions and
|
3220 |
|
|
@code{.skip} directives (@pxref{Skip,,@code{.skip}}).
|
3221 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3222 |
|
|
|
3223 |
|
|
@node Symbols
|
3224 |
|
|
@chapter Symbols
|
3225 |
|
|
|
3226 |
|
|
@cindex symbols
|
3227 |
|
|
Symbols are a central concept: the programmer uses symbols to name
|
3228 |
|
|
things, the linker uses symbols to link, and the debugger uses symbols
|
3229 |
|
|
to debug.
|
3230 |
|
|
|
3231 |
|
|
@quotation
|
3232 |
|
|
@cindex debuggers, and symbol order
|
3233 |
|
|
@emph{Warning:} @command{@value{AS}} does not place symbols in the object file in
|
3234 |
|
|
the same order they were declared. This may break some debuggers.
|
3235 |
|
|
@end quotation
|
3236 |
|
|
|
3237 |
|
|
@menu
|
3238 |
|
|
* Labels:: Labels
|
3239 |
|
|
* Setting Symbols:: Giving Symbols Other Values
|
3240 |
|
|
* Symbol Names:: Symbol Names
|
3241 |
|
|
* Dot:: The Special Dot Symbol
|
3242 |
|
|
* Symbol Attributes:: Symbol Attributes
|
3243 |
|
|
@end menu
|
3244 |
|
|
|
3245 |
|
|
@node Labels
|
3246 |
|
|
@section Labels
|
3247 |
|
|
|
3248 |
|
|
@cindex labels
|
3249 |
|
|
A @dfn{label} is written as a symbol immediately followed by a colon
|
3250 |
|
|
@samp{:}. The symbol then represents the current value of the
|
3251 |
|
|
active location counter, and is, for example, a suitable instruction
|
3252 |
|
|
operand. You are warned if you use the same symbol to represent two
|
3253 |
|
|
different locations: the first definition overrides any other
|
3254 |
|
|
definitions.
|
3255 |
|
|
|
3256 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
3257 |
|
|
On the HPPA, the usual form for a label need not be immediately followed by a
|
3258 |
|
|
colon, but instead must start in column zero. Only one label may be defined on
|
3259 |
|
|
a single line. To work around this, the HPPA version of @command{@value{AS}} also
|
3260 |
|
|
provides a special directive @code{.label} for defining labels more flexibly.
|
3261 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3262 |
|
|
|
3263 |
|
|
@node Setting Symbols
|
3264 |
|
|
@section Giving Symbols Other Values
|
3265 |
|
|
|
3266 |
|
|
@cindex assigning values to symbols
|
3267 |
|
|
@cindex symbol values, assigning
|
3268 |
|
|
A symbol can be given an arbitrary value by writing a symbol, followed
|
3269 |
|
|
by an equals sign @samp{=}, followed by an expression
|
3270 |
|
|
(@pxref{Expressions}). This is equivalent to using the @code{.set}
|
3271 |
|
|
directive. @xref{Set,,@code{.set}}. In the same way, using a double
|
3272 |
|
|
equals sign @samp{=}@samp{=} here represents an equivalent of the
|
3273 |
|
|
@code{.eqv} directive. @xref{Eqv,,@code{.eqv}}.
|
3274 |
|
|
|
3275 |
|
|
@ifset Blackfin
|
3276 |
|
|
Blackfin does not support symbol assignment with @samp{=}.
|
3277 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3278 |
|
|
|
3279 |
|
|
@node Symbol Names
|
3280 |
|
|
@section Symbol Names
|
3281 |
|
|
|
3282 |
|
|
@cindex symbol names
|
3283 |
|
|
@cindex names, symbol
|
3284 |
|
|
@ifclear SPECIAL-SYMS
|
3285 |
|
|
Symbol names begin with a letter or with one of @samp{._}. On most
|
3286 |
|
|
machines, you can also use @code{$} in symbol names; exceptions are
|
3287 |
|
|
noted in @ref{Machine Dependencies}. That character may be followed by any
|
3288 |
|
|
string of digits, letters, dollar signs (unless otherwise noted for a
|
3289 |
|
|
particular target machine), and underscores.
|
3290 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3291 |
|
|
@ifset SPECIAL-SYMS
|
3292 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
3293 |
|
|
Symbol names begin with a letter or with one of @samp{._}. On the
|
3294 |
|
|
Renesas SH you can also use @code{$} in symbol names. That
|
3295 |
|
|
character may be followed by any string of digits, letters, dollar signs (save
|
3296 |
|
|
on the H8/300), and underscores.
|
3297 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3298 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3299 |
|
|
|
3300 |
|
|
Case of letters is significant: @code{foo} is a different symbol name
|
3301 |
|
|
than @code{Foo}.
|
3302 |
|
|
|
3303 |
|
|
Each symbol has exactly one name. Each name in an assembly language program
|
3304 |
|
|
refers to exactly one symbol. You may use that symbol name any number of times
|
3305 |
|
|
in a program.
|
3306 |
|
|
|
3307 |
|
|
@subheading Local Symbol Names
|
3308 |
|
|
|
3309 |
|
|
@cindex local symbol names
|
3310 |
|
|
@cindex symbol names, local
|
3311 |
|
|
A local symbol is any symbol beginning with certain local label prefixes.
|
3312 |
|
|
By default, the local label prefix is @samp{.L} for ELF systems or
|
3313 |
|
|
@samp{L} for traditional a.out systems, but each target may have its own
|
3314 |
|
|
set of local label prefixes.
|
3315 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
3316 |
|
|
On the HPPA local symbols begin with @samp{L$}.
|
3317 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3318 |
|
|
|
3319 |
|
|
Local symbols are defined and used within the assembler, but they are
|
3320 |
|
|
normally not saved in object files. Thus, they are not visible when debugging.
|
3321 |
|
|
You may use the @samp{-L} option (@pxref{L, ,Include Local Symbols:
|
3322 |
|
|
@option{-L}}) to retain the local symbols in the object files.
|
3323 |
|
|
|
3324 |
|
|
@subheading Local Labels
|
3325 |
|
|
|
3326 |
|
|
@cindex local labels
|
3327 |
|
|
@cindex temporary symbol names
|
3328 |
|
|
@cindex symbol names, temporary
|
3329 |
|
|
Local labels help compilers and programmers use names temporarily.
|
3330 |
|
|
They create symbols which are guaranteed to be unique over the entire scope of
|
3331 |
|
|
the input source code and which can be referred to by a simple notation.
|
3332 |
|
|
To define a local label, write a label of the form @samp{@b{N}:} (where @b{N}
|
3333 |
|
|
represents any positive integer). To refer to the most recent previous
|
3334 |
|
|
definition of that label write @samp{@b{N}b}, using the same number as when
|
3335 |
|
|
you defined the label. To refer to the next definition of a local label, write
|
3336 |
|
|
@samp{@b{N}f}---the @samp{b} stands for ``backwards'' and the @samp{f} stands
|
3337 |
|
|
for ``forwards''.
|
3338 |
|
|
|
3339 |
|
|
There is no restriction on how you can use these labels, and you can reuse them
|
3340 |
|
|
too. So that it is possible to repeatedly define the same local label (using
|
3341 |
|
|
the same number @samp{@b{N}}), although you can only refer to the most recently
|
3342 |
|
|
defined local label of that number (for a backwards reference) or the next
|
3343 |
|
|
definition of a specific local label for a forward reference. It is also worth
|
3344 |
|
|
noting that the first 10 local labels (@samp{@b{0:}}@dots{}@samp{@b{9:}}) are
|
3345 |
|
|
implemented in a slightly more efficient manner than the others.
|
3346 |
|
|
|
3347 |
|
|
Here is an example:
|
3348 |
|
|
|
3349 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3350 |
|
|
1: branch 1f
|
3351 |
|
|
2: branch 1b
|
3352 |
|
|
1: branch 2f
|
3353 |
|
|
2: branch 1b
|
3354 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3355 |
|
|
|
3356 |
|
|
Which is the equivalent of:
|
3357 |
|
|
|
3358 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3359 |
|
|
label_1: branch label_3
|
3360 |
|
|
label_2: branch label_1
|
3361 |
|
|
label_3: branch label_4
|
3362 |
|
|
label_4: branch label_3
|
3363 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3364 |
|
|
|
3365 |
|
|
Local label names are only a notational device. They are immediately
|
3366 |
|
|
transformed into more conventional symbol names before the assembler uses them.
|
3367 |
|
|
The symbol names are stored in the symbol table, appear in error messages, and
|
3368 |
|
|
are optionally emitted to the object file. The names are constructed using
|
3369 |
|
|
these parts:
|
3370 |
|
|
|
3371 |
|
|
@table @code
|
3372 |
|
|
@item @emph{local label prefix}
|
3373 |
|
|
All local symbols begin with the system-specific local label prefix.
|
3374 |
|
|
Normally both @command{@value{AS}} and @code{@value{LD}} forget symbols
|
3375 |
|
|
that start with the local label prefix. These labels are
|
3376 |
|
|
used for symbols you are never intended to see. If you use the
|
3377 |
|
|
@samp{-L} option then @command{@value{AS}} retains these symbols in the
|
3378 |
|
|
object file. If you also instruct @code{@value{LD}} to retain these symbols,
|
3379 |
|
|
you may use them in debugging.
|
3380 |
|
|
|
3381 |
|
|
@item @var{number}
|
3382 |
|
|
This is the number that was used in the local label definition. So if the
|
3383 |
|
|
label is written @samp{55:} then the number is @samp{55}.
|
3384 |
|
|
|
3385 |
|
|
@item @kbd{C-B}
|
3386 |
|
|
This unusual character is included so you do not accidentally invent a symbol
|
3387 |
|
|
of the same name. The character has ASCII value of @samp{\002} (control-B).
|
3388 |
|
|
|
3389 |
|
|
@item @emph{ordinal number}
|
3390 |
|
|
This is a serial number to keep the labels distinct. The first definition of
|
3391 |
|
|
@samp{0:} gets the number @samp{1}. The 15th definition of @samp{0:} gets the
|
3392 |
|
|
number @samp{15}, and so on. Likewise the first definition of @samp{1:} gets
|
3393 |
|
|
the number @samp{1} and its 15th definition gets @samp{15} as well.
|
3394 |
|
|
@end table
|
3395 |
|
|
|
3396 |
|
|
So for example, the first @code{1:} may be named @code{.L1@kbd{C-B}1}, and
|
3397 |
|
|
the 44th @code{3:} may be named @code{.L3@kbd{C-B}44}.
|
3398 |
|
|
|
3399 |
|
|
@subheading Dollar Local Labels
|
3400 |
|
|
@cindex dollar local symbols
|
3401 |
|
|
|
3402 |
|
|
@code{@value{AS}} also supports an even more local form of local labels called
|
3403 |
|
|
dollar labels. These labels go out of scope (i.e., they become undefined) as
|
3404 |
|
|
soon as a non-local label is defined. Thus they remain valid for only a small
|
3405 |
|
|
region of the input source code. Normal local labels, by contrast, remain in
|
3406 |
|
|
scope for the entire file, or until they are redefined by another occurrence of
|
3407 |
|
|
the same local label.
|
3408 |
|
|
|
3409 |
|
|
Dollar labels are defined in exactly the same way as ordinary local labels,
|
3410 |
|
|
except that they have a dollar sign suffix to their numeric value, e.g.,
|
3411 |
|
|
@samp{@b{55$:}}.
|
3412 |
|
|
|
3413 |
|
|
They can also be distinguished from ordinary local labels by their transformed
|
3414 |
|
|
names which use ASCII character @samp{\001} (control-A) as the magic character
|
3415 |
|
|
to distinguish them from ordinary labels. For example, the fifth definition of
|
3416 |
|
|
@samp{6$} may be named @samp{.L6@kbd{C-A}5}.
|
3417 |
|
|
|
3418 |
|
|
@node Dot
|
3419 |
|
|
@section The Special Dot Symbol
|
3420 |
|
|
|
3421 |
|
|
@cindex dot (symbol)
|
3422 |
|
|
@cindex @code{.} (symbol)
|
3423 |
|
|
@cindex current address
|
3424 |
|
|
@cindex location counter
|
3425 |
|
|
The special symbol @samp{.} refers to the current address that
|
3426 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is assembling into. Thus, the expression @samp{melvin:
|
3427 |
|
|
.long .} defines @code{melvin} to contain its own address.
|
3428 |
|
|
Assigning a value to @code{.} is treated the same as a @code{.org}
|
3429 |
|
|
directive.
|
3430 |
|
|
@ifclear no-space-dir
|
3431 |
|
|
Thus, the expression @samp{.=.+4} is the same as saying
|
3432 |
|
|
@samp{.space 4}.
|
3433 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3434 |
|
|
|
3435 |
|
|
@node Symbol Attributes
|
3436 |
|
|
@section Symbol Attributes
|
3437 |
|
|
|
3438 |
|
|
@cindex symbol attributes
|
3439 |
|
|
@cindex attributes, symbol
|
3440 |
|
|
Every symbol has, as well as its name, the attributes ``Value'' and
|
3441 |
|
|
``Type''. Depending on output format, symbols can also have auxiliary
|
3442 |
|
|
attributes.
|
3443 |
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
3444 |
|
|
The detailed definitions are in @file{a.out.h}.
|
3445 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3446 |
|
|
|
3447 |
|
|
If you use a symbol without defining it, @command{@value{AS}} assumes zero for
|
3448 |
|
|
all these attributes, and probably won't warn you. This makes the
|
3449 |
|
|
symbol an externally defined symbol, which is generally what you
|
3450 |
|
|
would want.
|
3451 |
|
|
|
3452 |
|
|
@menu
|
3453 |
|
|
* Symbol Value:: Value
|
3454 |
|
|
* Symbol Type:: Type
|
3455 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
3456 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3457 |
|
|
* a.out Symbols:: Symbol Attributes: @code{a.out}
|
3458 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3459 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3460 |
|
|
@ifclear BOUT
|
3461 |
|
|
* a.out Symbols:: Symbol Attributes: @code{a.out}
|
3462 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3463 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
3464 |
|
|
* a.out Symbols:: Symbol Attributes: @code{a.out}, @code{b.out}
|
3465 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3466 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3467 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3468 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3469 |
|
|
* COFF Symbols:: Symbol Attributes for COFF
|
3470 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3471 |
|
|
@ifset SOM
|
3472 |
|
|
* SOM Symbols:: Symbol Attributes for SOM
|
3473 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3474 |
|
|
@end menu
|
3475 |
|
|
|
3476 |
|
|
@node Symbol Value
|
3477 |
|
|
@subsection Value
|
3478 |
|
|
|
3479 |
|
|
@cindex value of a symbol
|
3480 |
|
|
@cindex symbol value
|
3481 |
|
|
The value of a symbol is (usually) 32 bits. For a symbol which labels a
|
3482 |
|
|
location in the text, data, bss or absolute sections the value is the
|
3483 |
|
|
number of addresses from the start of that section to the label.
|
3484 |
|
|
Naturally for text, data and bss sections the value of a symbol changes
|
3485 |
|
|
as @code{@value{LD}} changes section base addresses during linking. Absolute
|
3486 |
|
|
symbols' values do not change during linking: that is why they are
|
3487 |
|
|
called absolute.
|
3488 |
|
|
|
3489 |
|
|
The value of an undefined symbol is treated in a special way. If it is
|
3490 |
|
|
|
3491 |
|
|
@code{@value{LD}} tries to determine its value from other files linked into the
|
3492 |
|
|
same program. You make this kind of symbol simply by mentioning a symbol
|
3493 |
|
|
name without defining it. A non-zero value represents a @code{.comm}
|
3494 |
|
|
common declaration. The value is how much common storage to reserve, in
|
3495 |
|
|
bytes (addresses). The symbol refers to the first address of the
|
3496 |
|
|
allocated storage.
|
3497 |
|
|
|
3498 |
|
|
@node Symbol Type
|
3499 |
|
|
@subsection Type
|
3500 |
|
|
|
3501 |
|
|
@cindex type of a symbol
|
3502 |
|
|
@cindex symbol type
|
3503 |
|
|
The type attribute of a symbol contains relocation (section)
|
3504 |
|
|
information, any flag settings indicating that a symbol is external, and
|
3505 |
|
|
(optionally), other information for linkers and debuggers. The exact
|
3506 |
|
|
format depends on the object-code output format in use.
|
3507 |
|
|
|
3508 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
3509 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3510 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
3511 |
|
|
@c The following avoids a "widow" subsection title. @group would be
|
3512 |
|
|
@c better if it were available outside examples.
|
3513 |
|
|
@need 1000
|
3514 |
|
|
@node a.out Symbols
|
3515 |
|
|
@subsection Symbol Attributes: @code{a.out}, @code{b.out}
|
3516 |
|
|
|
3517 |
|
|
@cindex @code{b.out} symbol attributes
|
3518 |
|
|
@cindex symbol attributes, @code{b.out}
|
3519 |
|
|
These symbol attributes appear only when @command{@value{AS}} is configured for
|
3520 |
|
|
one of the Berkeley-descended object output formats---@code{a.out} or
|
3521 |
|
|
@code{b.out}.
|
3522 |
|
|
|
3523 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3524 |
|
|
@ifclear BOUT
|
3525 |
|
|
@node a.out Symbols
|
3526 |
|
|
@subsection Symbol Attributes: @code{a.out}
|
3527 |
|
|
|
3528 |
|
|
@cindex @code{a.out} symbol attributes
|
3529 |
|
|
@cindex symbol attributes, @code{a.out}
|
3530 |
|
|
|
3531 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3532 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3533 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3534 |
|
|
@node a.out Symbols
|
3535 |
|
|
@subsection Symbol Attributes: @code{a.out}
|
3536 |
|
|
|
3537 |
|
|
@cindex @code{a.out} symbol attributes
|
3538 |
|
|
@cindex symbol attributes, @code{a.out}
|
3539 |
|
|
|
3540 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3541 |
|
|
@menu
|
3542 |
|
|
* Symbol Desc:: Descriptor
|
3543 |
|
|
* Symbol Other:: Other
|
3544 |
|
|
@end menu
|
3545 |
|
|
|
3546 |
|
|
@node Symbol Desc
|
3547 |
|
|
@subsubsection Descriptor
|
3548 |
|
|
|
3549 |
|
|
@cindex descriptor, of @code{a.out} symbol
|
3550 |
|
|
This is an arbitrary 16-bit value. You may establish a symbol's
|
3551 |
|
|
descriptor value by using a @code{.desc} statement
|
3552 |
|
|
(@pxref{Desc,,@code{.desc}}). A descriptor value means nothing to
|
3553 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}}.
|
3554 |
|
|
|
3555 |
|
|
@node Symbol Other
|
3556 |
|
|
@subsubsection Other
|
3557 |
|
|
|
3558 |
|
|
@cindex other attribute, of @code{a.out} symbol
|
3559 |
|
|
This is an arbitrary 8-bit value. It means nothing to @command{@value{AS}}.
|
3560 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3561 |
|
|
|
3562 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3563 |
|
|
@node COFF Symbols
|
3564 |
|
|
@subsection Symbol Attributes for COFF
|
3565 |
|
|
|
3566 |
|
|
@cindex COFF symbol attributes
|
3567 |
|
|
@cindex symbol attributes, COFF
|
3568 |
|
|
|
3569 |
|
|
The COFF format supports a multitude of auxiliary symbol attributes;
|
3570 |
|
|
like the primary symbol attributes, they are set between @code{.def} and
|
3571 |
|
|
@code{.endef} directives.
|
3572 |
|
|
|
3573 |
|
|
@subsubsection Primary Attributes
|
3574 |
|
|
|
3575 |
|
|
@cindex primary attributes, COFF symbols
|
3576 |
|
|
The symbol name is set with @code{.def}; the value and type,
|
3577 |
|
|
respectively, with @code{.val} and @code{.type}.
|
3578 |
|
|
|
3579 |
|
|
@subsubsection Auxiliary Attributes
|
3580 |
|
|
|
3581 |
|
|
@cindex auxiliary attributes, COFF symbols
|
3582 |
|
|
The @command{@value{AS}} directives @code{.dim}, @code{.line}, @code{.scl},
|
3583 |
|
|
@code{.size}, @code{.tag}, and @code{.weak} can generate auxiliary symbol
|
3584 |
|
|
table information for COFF.
|
3585 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3586 |
|
|
|
3587 |
|
|
@ifset SOM
|
3588 |
|
|
@node SOM Symbols
|
3589 |
|
|
@subsection Symbol Attributes for SOM
|
3590 |
|
|
|
3591 |
|
|
@cindex SOM symbol attributes
|
3592 |
|
|
@cindex symbol attributes, SOM
|
3593 |
|
|
|
3594 |
|
|
The SOM format for the HPPA supports a multitude of symbol attributes set with
|
3595 |
|
|
the @code{.EXPORT} and @code{.IMPORT} directives.
|
3596 |
|
|
|
3597 |
|
|
The attributes are described in @cite{HP9000 Series 800 Assembly
|
3598 |
|
|
Language Reference Manual} (HP 92432-90001) under the @code{IMPORT} and
|
3599 |
|
|
@code{EXPORT} assembler directive documentation.
|
3600 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3601 |
|
|
|
3602 |
|
|
@node Expressions
|
3603 |
|
|
@chapter Expressions
|
3604 |
|
|
|
3605 |
|
|
@cindex expressions
|
3606 |
|
|
@cindex addresses
|
3607 |
|
|
@cindex numeric values
|
3608 |
|
|
An @dfn{expression} specifies an address or numeric value.
|
3609 |
|
|
Whitespace may precede and/or follow an expression.
|
3610 |
|
|
|
3611 |
|
|
The result of an expression must be an absolute number, or else an offset into
|
3612 |
|
|
a particular section. If an expression is not absolute, and there is not
|
3613 |
|
|
enough information when @command{@value{AS}} sees the expression to know its
|
3614 |
|
|
section, a second pass over the source program might be necessary to interpret
|
3615 |
|
|
the expression---but the second pass is currently not implemented.
|
3616 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} aborts with an error message in this situation.
|
3617 |
|
|
|
3618 |
|
|
@menu
|
3619 |
|
|
* Empty Exprs:: Empty Expressions
|
3620 |
|
|
* Integer Exprs:: Integer Expressions
|
3621 |
|
|
@end menu
|
3622 |
|
|
|
3623 |
|
|
@node Empty Exprs
|
3624 |
|
|
@section Empty Expressions
|
3625 |
|
|
|
3626 |
|
|
@cindex empty expressions
|
3627 |
|
|
@cindex expressions, empty
|
3628 |
|
|
An empty expression has no value: it is just whitespace or null.
|
3629 |
|
|
Wherever an absolute expression is required, you may omit the
|
3630 |
|
|
expression, and @command{@value{AS}} assumes a value of (absolute) 0. This
|
3631 |
|
|
is compatible with other assemblers.
|
3632 |
|
|
|
3633 |
|
|
@node Integer Exprs
|
3634 |
|
|
@section Integer Expressions
|
3635 |
|
|
|
3636 |
|
|
@cindex integer expressions
|
3637 |
|
|
@cindex expressions, integer
|
3638 |
|
|
An @dfn{integer expression} is one or more @emph{arguments} delimited
|
3639 |
|
|
by @emph{operators}.
|
3640 |
|
|
|
3641 |
|
|
@menu
|
3642 |
|
|
* Arguments:: Arguments
|
3643 |
|
|
* Operators:: Operators
|
3644 |
|
|
* Prefix Ops:: Prefix Operators
|
3645 |
|
|
* Infix Ops:: Infix Operators
|
3646 |
|
|
@end menu
|
3647 |
|
|
|
3648 |
|
|
@node Arguments
|
3649 |
|
|
@subsection Arguments
|
3650 |
|
|
|
3651 |
|
|
@cindex expression arguments
|
3652 |
|
|
@cindex arguments in expressions
|
3653 |
|
|
@cindex operands in expressions
|
3654 |
|
|
@cindex arithmetic operands
|
3655 |
|
|
@dfn{Arguments} are symbols, numbers or subexpressions. In other
|
3656 |
|
|
contexts arguments are sometimes called ``arithmetic operands''. In
|
3657 |
|
|
this manual, to avoid confusing them with the ``instruction operands'' of
|
3658 |
|
|
the machine language, we use the term ``argument'' to refer to parts of
|
3659 |
|
|
expressions only, reserving the word ``operand'' to refer only to machine
|
3660 |
|
|
instruction operands.
|
3661 |
|
|
|
3662 |
|
|
Symbols are evaluated to yield @{@var{section} @var{NNN}@} where
|
3663 |
|
|
@var{section} is one of text, data, bss, absolute,
|
3664 |
|
|
or undefined. @var{NNN} is a signed, 2's complement 32 bit
|
3665 |
|
|
integer.
|
3666 |
|
|
|
3667 |
|
|
Numbers are usually integers.
|
3668 |
|
|
|
3669 |
|
|
A number can be a flonum or bignum. In this case, you are warned
|
3670 |
|
|
that only the low order 32 bits are used, and @command{@value{AS}} pretends
|
3671 |
|
|
these 32 bits are an integer. You may write integer-manipulating
|
3672 |
|
|
instructions that act on exotic constants, compatible with other
|
3673 |
|
|
assemblers.
|
3674 |
|
|
|
3675 |
|
|
@cindex subexpressions
|
3676 |
|
|
Subexpressions are a left parenthesis @samp{(} followed by an integer
|
3677 |
|
|
expression, followed by a right parenthesis @samp{)}; or a prefix
|
3678 |
|
|
operator followed by an argument.
|
3679 |
|
|
|
3680 |
|
|
@node Operators
|
3681 |
|
|
@subsection Operators
|
3682 |
|
|
|
3683 |
|
|
@cindex operators, in expressions
|
3684 |
|
|
@cindex arithmetic functions
|
3685 |
|
|
@cindex functions, in expressions
|
3686 |
|
|
@dfn{Operators} are arithmetic functions, like @code{+} or @code{%}. Prefix
|
3687 |
|
|
operators are followed by an argument. Infix operators appear
|
3688 |
|
|
between their arguments. Operators may be preceded and/or followed by
|
3689 |
|
|
whitespace.
|
3690 |
|
|
|
3691 |
|
|
@node Prefix Ops
|
3692 |
|
|
@subsection Prefix Operator
|
3693 |
|
|
|
3694 |
|
|
@cindex prefix operators
|
3695 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} has the following @dfn{prefix operators}. They each take
|
3696 |
|
|
one argument, which must be absolute.
|
3697 |
|
|
|
3698 |
|
|
@c the tex/end tex stuff surrounding this small table is meant to make
|
3699 |
|
|
@c it align, on the printed page, with the similar table in the next
|
3700 |
|
|
@c section (which is inside an enumerate).
|
3701 |
|
|
@tex
|
3702 |
|
|
\global\advance\leftskip by \itemindent
|
3703 |
|
|
@end tex
|
3704 |
|
|
|
3705 |
|
|
@table @code
|
3706 |
|
|
@item -
|
3707 |
|
|
@dfn{Negation}. Two's complement negation.
|
3708 |
|
|
@item ~
|
3709 |
|
|
@dfn{Complementation}. Bitwise not.
|
3710 |
|
|
@end table
|
3711 |
|
|
|
3712 |
|
|
@tex
|
3713 |
|
|
\global\advance\leftskip by -\itemindent
|
3714 |
|
|
@end tex
|
3715 |
|
|
|
3716 |
|
|
@node Infix Ops
|
3717 |
|
|
@subsection Infix Operators
|
3718 |
|
|
|
3719 |
|
|
@cindex infix operators
|
3720 |
|
|
@cindex operators, permitted arguments
|
3721 |
|
|
@dfn{Infix operators} take two arguments, one on either side. Operators
|
3722 |
|
|
have precedence, but operations with equal precedence are performed left
|
3723 |
|
|
to right. Apart from @code{+} or @option{-}, both arguments must be
|
3724 |
|
|
absolute, and the result is absolute.
|
3725 |
|
|
|
3726 |
|
|
@enumerate
|
3727 |
|
|
@cindex operator precedence
|
3728 |
|
|
@cindex precedence of operators
|
3729 |
|
|
|
3730 |
|
|
@item
|
3731 |
|
|
Highest Precedence
|
3732 |
|
|
|
3733 |
|
|
@table @code
|
3734 |
|
|
@item *
|
3735 |
|
|
@dfn{Multiplication}.
|
3736 |
|
|
|
3737 |
|
|
@item /
|
3738 |
|
|
@dfn{Division}. Truncation is the same as the C operator @samp{/}
|
3739 |
|
|
|
3740 |
|
|
@item %
|
3741 |
|
|
@dfn{Remainder}.
|
3742 |
|
|
|
3743 |
|
|
@item <<
|
3744 |
|
|
@dfn{Shift Left}. Same as the C operator @samp{<<}.
|
3745 |
|
|
|
3746 |
|
|
@item >>
|
3747 |
|
|
@dfn{Shift Right}. Same as the C operator @samp{>>}.
|
3748 |
|
|
@end table
|
3749 |
|
|
|
3750 |
|
|
@item
|
3751 |
|
|
Intermediate precedence
|
3752 |
|
|
|
3753 |
|
|
@table @code
|
3754 |
|
|
@item |
|
3755 |
|
|
|
3756 |
|
|
@dfn{Bitwise Inclusive Or}.
|
3757 |
|
|
|
3758 |
|
|
@item &
|
3759 |
|
|
@dfn{Bitwise And}.
|
3760 |
|
|
|
3761 |
|
|
@item ^
|
3762 |
|
|
@dfn{Bitwise Exclusive Or}.
|
3763 |
|
|
|
3764 |
|
|
@item !
|
3765 |
|
|
@dfn{Bitwise Or Not}.
|
3766 |
|
|
@end table
|
3767 |
|
|
|
3768 |
|
|
@item
|
3769 |
|
|
Low Precedence
|
3770 |
|
|
|
3771 |
|
|
@table @code
|
3772 |
|
|
@cindex addition, permitted arguments
|
3773 |
|
|
@cindex plus, permitted arguments
|
3774 |
|
|
@cindex arguments for addition
|
3775 |
|
|
@item +
|
3776 |
|
|
@dfn{Addition}. If either argument is absolute, the result has the section of
|
3777 |
|
|
the other argument. You may not add together arguments from different
|
3778 |
|
|
sections.
|
3779 |
|
|
|
3780 |
|
|
@cindex subtraction, permitted arguments
|
3781 |
|
|
@cindex minus, permitted arguments
|
3782 |
|
|
@cindex arguments for subtraction
|
3783 |
|
|
@item -
|
3784 |
|
|
@dfn{Subtraction}. If the right argument is absolute, the
|
3785 |
|
|
result has the section of the left argument.
|
3786 |
|
|
If both arguments are in the same section, the result is absolute.
|
3787 |
|
|
You may not subtract arguments from different sections.
|
3788 |
|
|
@c FIXME is there still something useful to say about undefined - undefined ?
|
3789 |
|
|
|
3790 |
|
|
@cindex comparison expressions
|
3791 |
|
|
@cindex expressions, comparison
|
3792 |
|
|
@item ==
|
3793 |
|
|
@dfn{Is Equal To}
|
3794 |
|
|
@item <>
|
3795 |
|
|
@itemx !=
|
3796 |
|
|
@dfn{Is Not Equal To}
|
3797 |
|
|
@item <
|
3798 |
|
|
@dfn{Is Less Than}
|
3799 |
|
|
@item >
|
3800 |
|
|
@dfn{Is Greater Than}
|
3801 |
|
|
@item >=
|
3802 |
|
|
@dfn{Is Greater Than Or Equal To}
|
3803 |
|
|
@item <=
|
3804 |
|
|
@dfn{Is Less Than Or Equal To}
|
3805 |
|
|
|
3806 |
|
|
The comparison operators can be used as infix operators. A true results has a
|
3807 |
|
|
value of -1 whereas a false result has a value of 0. Note, these operators
|
3808 |
|
|
perform signed comparisons.
|
3809 |
|
|
@end table
|
3810 |
|
|
|
3811 |
|
|
@item Lowest Precedence
|
3812 |
|
|
|
3813 |
|
|
@table @code
|
3814 |
|
|
@item &&
|
3815 |
|
|
@dfn{Logical And}.
|
3816 |
|
|
|
3817 |
|
|
@item ||
|
3818 |
|
|
@dfn{Logical Or}.
|
3819 |
|
|
|
3820 |
|
|
These two logical operations can be used to combine the results of sub
|
3821 |
|
|
expressions. Note, unlike the comparison operators a true result returns a
|
3822 |
|
|
value of 1 but a false results does still return 0. Also note that the logical
|
3823 |
|
|
or operator has a slightly lower precedence than logical and.
|
3824 |
|
|
|
3825 |
|
|
@end table
|
3826 |
|
|
@end enumerate
|
3827 |
|
|
|
3828 |
|
|
In short, it's only meaningful to add or subtract the @emph{offsets} in an
|
3829 |
|
|
address; you can only have a defined section in one of the two arguments.
|
3830 |
|
|
|
3831 |
|
|
@node Pseudo Ops
|
3832 |
|
|
@chapter Assembler Directives
|
3833 |
|
|
|
3834 |
|
|
@cindex directives, machine independent
|
3835 |
|
|
@cindex pseudo-ops, machine independent
|
3836 |
|
|
@cindex machine independent directives
|
3837 |
|
|
All assembler directives have names that begin with a period (@samp{.}).
|
3838 |
|
|
The rest of the name is letters, usually in lower case.
|
3839 |
|
|
|
3840 |
|
|
This chapter discusses directives that are available regardless of the
|
3841 |
|
|
target machine configuration for the @sc{gnu} assembler.
|
3842 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
3843 |
|
|
Some machine configurations provide additional directives.
|
3844 |
|
|
@xref{Machine Dependencies}.
|
3845 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3846 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
3847 |
|
|
@ifset machine-directives
|
3848 |
|
|
@xref{Machine Dependencies}, for additional directives.
|
3849 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3850 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3851 |
|
|
|
3852 |
|
|
@menu
|
3853 |
|
|
* Abort:: @code{.abort}
|
3854 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3855 |
|
|
* ABORT (COFF):: @code{.ABORT}
|
3856 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3857 |
|
|
|
3858 |
|
|
* Align:: @code{.align @var{abs-expr} , @var{abs-expr}}
|
3859 |
|
|
* Altmacro:: @code{.altmacro}
|
3860 |
|
|
* Ascii:: @code{.ascii "@var{string}"}@dots{}
|
3861 |
|
|
* Asciz:: @code{.asciz "@var{string}"}@dots{}
|
3862 |
|
|
* Balign:: @code{.balign @var{abs-expr} , @var{abs-expr}}
|
3863 |
|
|
* Byte:: @code{.byte @var{expressions}}
|
3864 |
|
|
* CFI directives:: @code{.cfi_startproc [simple]}, @code{.cfi_endproc}, etc.
|
3865 |
|
|
* Comm:: @code{.comm @var{symbol} , @var{length} }
|
3866 |
|
|
* Data:: @code{.data @var{subsection}}
|
3867 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3868 |
|
|
* Def:: @code{.def @var{name}}
|
3869 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3870 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
3871 |
|
|
* Desc:: @code{.desc @var{symbol}, @var{abs-expression}}
|
3872 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3873 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3874 |
|
|
* Dim:: @code{.dim}
|
3875 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3876 |
|
|
|
3877 |
|
|
* Double:: @code{.double @var{flonums}}
|
3878 |
|
|
* Eject:: @code{.eject}
|
3879 |
|
|
* Else:: @code{.else}
|
3880 |
|
|
* Elseif:: @code{.elseif}
|
3881 |
|
|
* End:: @code{.end}
|
3882 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3883 |
|
|
* Endef:: @code{.endef}
|
3884 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3885 |
|
|
|
3886 |
|
|
* Endfunc:: @code{.endfunc}
|
3887 |
|
|
* Endif:: @code{.endif}
|
3888 |
|
|
* Equ:: @code{.equ @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
3889 |
|
|
* Equiv:: @code{.equiv @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
3890 |
|
|
* Eqv:: @code{.eqv @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
3891 |
|
|
* Err:: @code{.err}
|
3892 |
|
|
* Error:: @code{.error @var{string}}
|
3893 |
|
|
* Exitm:: @code{.exitm}
|
3894 |
|
|
* Extern:: @code{.extern}
|
3895 |
|
|
* Fail:: @code{.fail}
|
3896 |
|
|
* File:: @code{.file}
|
3897 |
|
|
* Fill:: @code{.fill @var{repeat} , @var{size} , @var{value}}
|
3898 |
|
|
* Float:: @code{.float @var{flonums}}
|
3899 |
|
|
* Func:: @code{.func}
|
3900 |
|
|
* Global:: @code{.global @var{symbol}}, @code{.globl @var{symbol}}
|
3901 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3902 |
|
|
* Gnu_attribute:: @code{.gnu_attribute @var{tag},@var{value}}
|
3903 |
|
|
* Hidden:: @code{.hidden @var{names}}
|
3904 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3905 |
|
|
|
3906 |
|
|
* hword:: @code{.hword @var{expressions}}
|
3907 |
|
|
* Ident:: @code{.ident}
|
3908 |
|
|
* If:: @code{.if @var{absolute expression}}
|
3909 |
|
|
* Incbin:: @code{.incbin "@var{file}"[,@var{skip}[,@var{count}]]}
|
3910 |
|
|
* Include:: @code{.include "@var{file}"}
|
3911 |
|
|
* Int:: @code{.int @var{expressions}}
|
3912 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3913 |
|
|
* Internal:: @code{.internal @var{names}}
|
3914 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3915 |
|
|
|
3916 |
|
|
* Irp:: @code{.irp @var{symbol},@var{values}}@dots{}
|
3917 |
|
|
* Irpc:: @code{.irpc @var{symbol},@var{values}}@dots{}
|
3918 |
|
|
* Lcomm:: @code{.lcomm @var{symbol} , @var{length}}
|
3919 |
|
|
* Lflags:: @code{.lflags}
|
3920 |
|
|
@ifclear no-line-dir
|
3921 |
|
|
* Line:: @code{.line @var{line-number}}
|
3922 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3923 |
|
|
|
3924 |
|
|
* Linkonce:: @code{.linkonce [@var{type}]}
|
3925 |
|
|
* List:: @code{.list}
|
3926 |
|
|
* Ln:: @code{.ln @var{line-number}}
|
3927 |
|
|
* Loc:: @code{.loc @var{fileno} @var{lineno}}
|
3928 |
|
|
* Loc_mark_labels:: @code{.loc_mark_labels @var{enable}}
|
3929 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3930 |
|
|
* Local:: @code{.local @var{names}}
|
3931 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3932 |
|
|
|
3933 |
|
|
* Long:: @code{.long @var{expressions}}
|
3934 |
|
|
@ignore
|
3935 |
|
|
* Lsym:: @code{.lsym @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
3936 |
|
|
@end ignore
|
3937 |
|
|
|
3938 |
|
|
* Macro:: @code{.macro @var{name} @var{args}}@dots{}
|
3939 |
|
|
* MRI:: @code{.mri @var{val}}
|
3940 |
|
|
* Noaltmacro:: @code{.noaltmacro}
|
3941 |
|
|
* Nolist:: @code{.nolist}
|
3942 |
|
|
* Octa:: @code{.octa @var{bignums}}
|
3943 |
|
|
* Org:: @code{.org @var{new-lc}, @var{fill}}
|
3944 |
|
|
* P2align:: @code{.p2align @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}}
|
3945 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3946 |
|
|
* PopSection:: @code{.popsection}
|
3947 |
|
|
* Previous:: @code{.previous}
|
3948 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3949 |
|
|
|
3950 |
|
|
* Print:: @code{.print @var{string}}
|
3951 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3952 |
|
|
* Protected:: @code{.protected @var{names}}
|
3953 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3954 |
|
|
|
3955 |
|
|
* Psize:: @code{.psize @var{lines}, @var{columns}}
|
3956 |
|
|
* Purgem:: @code{.purgem @var{name}}
|
3957 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3958 |
|
|
* PushSection:: @code{.pushsection @var{name}}
|
3959 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3960 |
|
|
|
3961 |
|
|
* Quad:: @code{.quad @var{bignums}}
|
3962 |
|
|
* Reloc:: @code{.reloc @var{offset}, @var{reloc_name}[, @var{expression}]}
|
3963 |
|
|
* Rept:: @code{.rept @var{count}}
|
3964 |
|
|
* Sbttl:: @code{.sbttl "@var{subheading}"}
|
3965 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3966 |
|
|
* Scl:: @code{.scl @var{class}}
|
3967 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3968 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
3969 |
|
|
* Section:: @code{.section @var{name}[, @var{flags}]}
|
3970 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3971 |
|
|
|
3972 |
|
|
* Set:: @code{.set @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
3973 |
|
|
* Short:: @code{.short @var{expressions}}
|
3974 |
|
|
* Single:: @code{.single @var{flonums}}
|
3975 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
3976 |
|
|
* Size:: @code{.size [@var{name} , @var{expression}]}
|
3977 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3978 |
|
|
@ifclear no-space-dir
|
3979 |
|
|
* Skip:: @code{.skip @var{size} , @var{fill}}
|
3980 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3981 |
|
|
|
3982 |
|
|
* Sleb128:: @code{.sleb128 @var{expressions}}
|
3983 |
|
|
@ifclear no-space-dir
|
3984 |
|
|
* Space:: @code{.space @var{size} , @var{fill}}
|
3985 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
3986 |
|
|
@ifset have-stabs
|
3987 |
|
|
* Stab:: @code{.stabd, .stabn, .stabs}
|
3988 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3989 |
|
|
|
3990 |
|
|
* String:: @code{.string "@var{str}"}, @code{.string8 "@var{str}"}, @code{.string16 "@var{str}"}, @code{.string32 "@var{str}"}, @code{.string64 "@var{str}"}
|
3991 |
|
|
* Struct:: @code{.struct @var{expression}}
|
3992 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
3993 |
|
|
* SubSection:: @code{.subsection}
|
3994 |
|
|
* Symver:: @code{.symver @var{name},@var{name2@@nodename}}
|
3995 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
3996 |
|
|
|
3997 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
3998 |
|
|
* Tag:: @code{.tag @var{structname}}
|
3999 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4000 |
|
|
|
4001 |
|
|
* Text:: @code{.text @var{subsection}}
|
4002 |
|
|
* Title:: @code{.title "@var{heading}"}
|
4003 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
4004 |
|
|
* Type:: @code{.type <@var{int} | @var{name} , @var{type description}>}
|
4005 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4006 |
|
|
|
4007 |
|
|
* Uleb128:: @code{.uleb128 @var{expressions}}
|
4008 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
4009 |
|
|
* Val:: @code{.val @var{addr}}
|
4010 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4011 |
|
|
|
4012 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
4013 |
|
|
* Version:: @code{.version "@var{string}"}
|
4014 |
|
|
* VTableEntry:: @code{.vtable_entry @var{table}, @var{offset}}
|
4015 |
|
|
* VTableInherit:: @code{.vtable_inherit @var{child}, @var{parent}}
|
4016 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4017 |
|
|
|
4018 |
|
|
* Warning:: @code{.warning @var{string}}
|
4019 |
|
|
* Weak:: @code{.weak @var{names}}
|
4020 |
|
|
* Weakref:: @code{.weakref @var{alias}, @var{symbol}}
|
4021 |
|
|
* Word:: @code{.word @var{expressions}}
|
4022 |
|
|
* Deprecated:: Deprecated Directives
|
4023 |
|
|
@end menu
|
4024 |
|
|
|
4025 |
|
|
@node Abort
|
4026 |
|
|
@section @code{.abort}
|
4027 |
|
|
|
4028 |
|
|
@cindex @code{abort} directive
|
4029 |
|
|
@cindex stopping the assembly
|
4030 |
|
|
This directive stops the assembly immediately. It is for
|
4031 |
|
|
compatibility with other assemblers. The original idea was that the
|
4032 |
|
|
assembly language source would be piped into the assembler. If the sender
|
4033 |
|
|
of the source quit, it could use this directive tells @command{@value{AS}} to
|
4034 |
|
|
quit also. One day @code{.abort} will not be supported.
|
4035 |
|
|
|
4036 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
4037 |
|
|
@node ABORT (COFF)
|
4038 |
|
|
@section @code{.ABORT} (COFF)
|
4039 |
|
|
|
4040 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ABORT} directive
|
4041 |
|
|
When producing COFF output, @command{@value{AS}} accepts this directive as a
|
4042 |
|
|
synonym for @samp{.abort}.
|
4043 |
|
|
|
4044 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
4045 |
|
|
When producing @code{b.out} output, @command{@value{AS}} accepts this directive,
|
4046 |
|
|
but ignores it.
|
4047 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4048 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4049 |
|
|
|
4050 |
|
|
@node Align
|
4051 |
|
|
@section @code{.align @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}}
|
4052 |
|
|
|
4053 |
|
|
@cindex padding the location counter
|
4054 |
|
|
@cindex @code{align} directive
|
4055 |
|
|
Pad the location counter (in the current subsection) to a particular storage
|
4056 |
|
|
boundary. The first expression (which must be absolute) is the alignment
|
4057 |
|
|
required, as described below.
|
4058 |
|
|
|
4059 |
|
|
The second expression (also absolute) gives the fill value to be stored in the
|
4060 |
|
|
padding bytes. It (and the comma) may be omitted. If it is omitted, the
|
4061 |
|
|
padding bytes are normally zero. However, on some systems, if the section is
|
4062 |
|
|
marked as containing code and the fill value is omitted, the space is filled
|
4063 |
|
|
with no-op instructions.
|
4064 |
|
|
|
4065 |
|
|
The third expression is also absolute, and is also optional. If it is present,
|
4066 |
|
|
it is the maximum number of bytes that should be skipped by this alignment
|
4067 |
|
|
directive. If doing the alignment would require skipping more bytes than the
|
4068 |
|
|
specified maximum, then the alignment is not done at all. You can omit the
|
4069 |
|
|
fill value (the second argument) entirely by simply using two commas after the
|
4070 |
|
|
required alignment; this can be useful if you want the alignment to be filled
|
4071 |
|
|
with no-op instructions when appropriate.
|
4072 |
|
|
|
4073 |
|
|
The way the required alignment is specified varies from system to system.
|
4074 |
|
|
For the arc, hppa, i386 using ELF, i860, iq2000, m68k, or32,
|
4075 |
|
|
s390, sparc, tic4x, tic80 and xtensa, the first expression is the
|
4076 |
|
|
alignment request in bytes. For example @samp{.align 8} advances
|
4077 |
|
|
the location counter until it is a multiple of 8. If the location counter
|
4078 |
|
|
is already a multiple of 8, no change is needed. For the tic54x, the
|
4079 |
|
|
first expression is the alignment request in words.
|
4080 |
|
|
|
4081 |
|
|
For other systems, including ppc, i386 using a.out format, arm and
|
4082 |
|
|
strongarm, it is the
|
4083 |
|
|
number of low-order zero bits the location counter must have after
|
4084 |
|
|
advancement. For example @samp{.align 3} advances the location
|
4085 |
|
|
counter until it a multiple of 8. If the location counter is already a
|
4086 |
|
|
multiple of 8, no change is needed.
|
4087 |
|
|
|
4088 |
|
|
This inconsistency is due to the different behaviors of the various
|
4089 |
|
|
native assemblers for these systems which GAS must emulate.
|
4090 |
|
|
GAS also provides @code{.balign} and @code{.p2align} directives,
|
4091 |
|
|
described later, which have a consistent behavior across all
|
4092 |
|
|
architectures (but are specific to GAS).
|
4093 |
|
|
|
4094 |
|
|
@node Altmacro
|
4095 |
|
|
@section @code{.altmacro}
|
4096 |
|
|
Enable alternate macro mode, enabling:
|
4097 |
|
|
|
4098 |
|
|
@ftable @code
|
4099 |
|
|
@item LOCAL @var{name} [ , @dots{} ]
|
4100 |
|
|
One additional directive, @code{LOCAL}, is available. It is used to
|
4101 |
|
|
generate a string replacement for each of the @var{name} arguments, and
|
4102 |
|
|
replace any instances of @var{name} in each macro expansion. The
|
4103 |
|
|
replacement string is unique in the assembly, and different for each
|
4104 |
|
|
separate macro expansion. @code{LOCAL} allows you to write macros that
|
4105 |
|
|
define symbols, without fear of conflict between separate macro expansions.
|
4106 |
|
|
|
4107 |
|
|
@item String delimiters
|
4108 |
|
|
You can write strings delimited in these other ways besides
|
4109 |
|
|
@code{"@var{string}"}:
|
4110 |
|
|
|
4111 |
|
|
@table @code
|
4112 |
|
|
@item '@var{string}'
|
4113 |
|
|
You can delimit strings with single-quote characters.
|
4114 |
|
|
|
4115 |
|
|
@item <@var{string}>
|
4116 |
|
|
You can delimit strings with matching angle brackets.
|
4117 |
|
|
@end table
|
4118 |
|
|
|
4119 |
|
|
@item single-character string escape
|
4120 |
|
|
To include any single character literally in a string (even if the
|
4121 |
|
|
character would otherwise have some special meaning), you can prefix the
|
4122 |
|
|
character with @samp{!} (an exclamation mark). For example, you can
|
4123 |
|
|
write @samp{<4.3 !> 5.4!!>} to get the literal text @samp{4.3 > 5.4!}.
|
4124 |
|
|
|
4125 |
|
|
@item Expression results as strings
|
4126 |
|
|
You can write @samp{%@var{expr}} to evaluate the expression @var{expr}
|
4127 |
|
|
and use the result as a string.
|
4128 |
|
|
@end ftable
|
4129 |
|
|
|
4130 |
|
|
@node Ascii
|
4131 |
|
|
@section @code{.ascii "@var{string}"}@dots{}
|
4132 |
|
|
|
4133 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ascii} directive
|
4134 |
|
|
@cindex string literals
|
4135 |
|
|
@code{.ascii} expects zero or more string literals (@pxref{Strings})
|
4136 |
|
|
separated by commas. It assembles each string (with no automatic
|
4137 |
|
|
trailing zero byte) into consecutive addresses.
|
4138 |
|
|
|
4139 |
|
|
@node Asciz
|
4140 |
|
|
@section @code{.asciz "@var{string}"}@dots{}
|
4141 |
|
|
|
4142 |
|
|
@cindex @code{asciz} directive
|
4143 |
|
|
@cindex zero-terminated strings
|
4144 |
|
|
@cindex null-terminated strings
|
4145 |
|
|
@code{.asciz} is just like @code{.ascii}, but each string is followed by
|
4146 |
|
|
a zero byte. The ``z'' in @samp{.asciz} stands for ``zero''.
|
4147 |
|
|
|
4148 |
|
|
@node Balign
|
4149 |
|
|
@section @code{.balign[wl] @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}}
|
4150 |
|
|
|
4151 |
|
|
@cindex padding the location counter given number of bytes
|
4152 |
|
|
@cindex @code{balign} directive
|
4153 |
|
|
Pad the location counter (in the current subsection) to a particular
|
4154 |
|
|
storage boundary. The first expression (which must be absolute) is the
|
4155 |
|
|
alignment request in bytes. For example @samp{.balign 8} advances
|
4156 |
|
|
the location counter until it is a multiple of 8. If the location counter
|
4157 |
|
|
is already a multiple of 8, no change is needed.
|
4158 |
|
|
|
4159 |
|
|
The second expression (also absolute) gives the fill value to be stored in the
|
4160 |
|
|
padding bytes. It (and the comma) may be omitted. If it is omitted, the
|
4161 |
|
|
padding bytes are normally zero. However, on some systems, if the section is
|
4162 |
|
|
marked as containing code and the fill value is omitted, the space is filled
|
4163 |
|
|
with no-op instructions.
|
4164 |
|
|
|
4165 |
|
|
The third expression is also absolute, and is also optional. If it is present,
|
4166 |
|
|
it is the maximum number of bytes that should be skipped by this alignment
|
4167 |
|
|
directive. If doing the alignment would require skipping more bytes than the
|
4168 |
|
|
specified maximum, then the alignment is not done at all. You can omit the
|
4169 |
|
|
fill value (the second argument) entirely by simply using two commas after the
|
4170 |
|
|
required alignment; this can be useful if you want the alignment to be filled
|
4171 |
|
|
with no-op instructions when appropriate.
|
4172 |
|
|
|
4173 |
|
|
@cindex @code{balignw} directive
|
4174 |
|
|
@cindex @code{balignl} directive
|
4175 |
|
|
The @code{.balignw} and @code{.balignl} directives are variants of the
|
4176 |
|
|
@code{.balign} directive. The @code{.balignw} directive treats the fill
|
4177 |
|
|
pattern as a two byte word value. The @code{.balignl} directives treats the
|
4178 |
|
|
fill pattern as a four byte longword value. For example, @code{.balignw
|
4179 |
|
|
4,0x368d} will align to a multiple of 4. If it skips two bytes, they will be
|
4180 |
|
|
filled in with the value 0x368d (the exact placement of the bytes depends upon
|
4181 |
|
|
the endianness of the processor). If it skips 1 or 3 bytes, the fill value is
|
4182 |
|
|
undefined.
|
4183 |
|
|
|
4184 |
|
|
@node Byte
|
4185 |
|
|
@section @code{.byte @var{expressions}}
|
4186 |
|
|
|
4187 |
|
|
@cindex @code{byte} directive
|
4188 |
|
|
@cindex integers, one byte
|
4189 |
|
|
@code{.byte} expects zero or more expressions, separated by commas.
|
4190 |
|
|
Each expression is assembled into the next byte.
|
4191 |
|
|
|
4192 |
|
|
@node CFI directives
|
4193 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_startproc [simple]}
|
4194 |
|
|
@cindex @code{cfi_startproc} directive
|
4195 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_startproc} is used at the beginning of each function that
|
4196 |
|
|
should have an entry in @code{.eh_frame}. It initializes some internal
|
4197 |
|
|
data structures. Don't forget to close the function by
|
4198 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_endproc}.
|
4199 |
|
|
|
4200 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_sections @var{section_list}}
|
4201 |
|
|
@cindex @code{cfi_sections} directive
|
4202 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_sections} may be used to specify whether CFI directives
|
4203 |
|
|
should emit @code{.eh_frame} section and/or @code{.debug_frame} section.
|
4204 |
|
|
If @var{section_list} is @code{.eh_frame}, @code{.eh_frame} is emitted,
|
4205 |
|
|
if @var{section_list} is @code{.debug_frame}, @code{.debug_frame} is emitted.
|
4206 |
|
|
To emit both use @code{.eh_frame, .debug_frame}. The default if this
|
4207 |
|
|
directive is not used is @code{.cfi_sections .eh_frame}.
|
4208 |
|
|
|
4209 |
|
|
Unless @code{.cfi_startproc} is used along with parameter @code{simple}
|
4210 |
|
|
it also emits some architecture dependent initial CFI instructions.
|
4211 |
|
|
|
4212 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_endproc}
|
4213 |
|
|
@cindex @code{cfi_endproc} directive
|
4214 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_endproc} is used at the end of a function where it closes its
|
4215 |
|
|
unwind entry previously opened by
|
4216 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_startproc}, and emits it to @code{.eh_frame}.
|
4217 |
|
|
|
4218 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_personality @var{encoding} [, @var{exp}]}
|
4219 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_personality} defines personality routine and its encoding.
|
4220 |
|
|
@var{encoding} must be a constant determining how the personality
|
4221 |
|
|
should be encoded. If it is 255 (@code{DW_EH_PE_omit}), second
|
4222 |
|
|
argument is not present, otherwise second argument should be
|
4223 |
|
|
a constant or a symbol name. When using indirect encodings,
|
4224 |
|
|
the symbol provided should be the location where personality
|
4225 |
|
|
can be loaded from, not the personality routine itself.
|
4226 |
|
|
The default after @code{.cfi_startproc} is @code{.cfi_personality 0xff},
|
4227 |
|
|
no personality routine.
|
4228 |
|
|
|
4229 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_lsda @var{encoding} [, @var{exp}]}
|
4230 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_lsda} defines LSDA and its encoding.
|
4231 |
|
|
@var{encoding} must be a constant determining how the LSDA
|
4232 |
|
|
should be encoded. If it is 255 (@code{DW_EH_PE_omit}), second
|
4233 |
|
|
argument is not present, otherwise second argument should be a constant
|
4234 |
|
|
or a symbol name. The default after @code{.cfi_startproc} is @code{.cfi_lsda 0xff},
|
4235 |
|
|
no LSDA.
|
4236 |
|
|
|
4237 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_def_cfa @var{register}, @var{offset}}
|
4238 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_def_cfa} defines a rule for computing CFA as: @i{take
|
4239 |
|
|
address from @var{register} and add @var{offset} to it}.
|
4240 |
|
|
|
4241 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_def_cfa_register @var{register}}
|
4242 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_def_cfa_register} modifies a rule for computing CFA. From
|
4243 |
|
|
now on @var{register} will be used instead of the old one. Offset
|
4244 |
|
|
remains the same.
|
4245 |
|
|
|
4246 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_def_cfa_offset @var{offset}}
|
4247 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_def_cfa_offset} modifies a rule for computing CFA. Register
|
4248 |
|
|
remains the same, but @var{offset} is new. Note that it is the
|
4249 |
|
|
absolute offset that will be added to a defined register to compute
|
4250 |
|
|
CFA address.
|
4251 |
|
|
|
4252 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_adjust_cfa_offset @var{offset}}
|
4253 |
|
|
Same as @code{.cfi_def_cfa_offset} but @var{offset} is a relative
|
4254 |
|
|
value that is added/substracted from the previous offset.
|
4255 |
|
|
|
4256 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_offset @var{register}, @var{offset}}
|
4257 |
|
|
Previous value of @var{register} is saved at offset @var{offset} from
|
4258 |
|
|
CFA.
|
4259 |
|
|
|
4260 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_rel_offset @var{register}, @var{offset}}
|
4261 |
|
|
Previous value of @var{register} is saved at offset @var{offset} from
|
4262 |
|
|
the current CFA register. This is transformed to @code{.cfi_offset}
|
4263 |
|
|
using the known displacement of the CFA register from the CFA.
|
4264 |
|
|
This is often easier to use, because the number will match the
|
4265 |
|
|
code it's annotating.
|
4266 |
|
|
|
4267 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_register @var{register1}, @var{register2}}
|
4268 |
|
|
Previous value of @var{register1} is saved in register @var{register2}.
|
4269 |
|
|
|
4270 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_restore @var{register}}
|
4271 |
|
|
@code{.cfi_restore} says that the rule for @var{register} is now the
|
4272 |
|
|
same as it was at the beginning of the function, after all initial
|
4273 |
|
|
instruction added by @code{.cfi_startproc} were executed.
|
4274 |
|
|
|
4275 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_undefined @var{register}}
|
4276 |
|
|
From now on the previous value of @var{register} can't be restored anymore.
|
4277 |
|
|
|
4278 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_same_value @var{register}}
|
4279 |
|
|
Current value of @var{register} is the same like in the previous frame,
|
4280 |
|
|
i.e. no restoration needed.
|
4281 |
|
|
|
4282 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_remember_state},
|
4283 |
|
|
First save all current rules for all registers by @code{.cfi_remember_state},
|
4284 |
|
|
then totally screw them up by subsequent @code{.cfi_*} directives and when
|
4285 |
|
|
everything is hopelessly bad, use @code{.cfi_restore_state} to restore
|
4286 |
|
|
the previous saved state.
|
4287 |
|
|
|
4288 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_return_column @var{register}}
|
4289 |
|
|
Change return column @var{register}, i.e. the return address is either
|
4290 |
|
|
directly in @var{register} or can be accessed by rules for @var{register}.
|
4291 |
|
|
|
4292 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_signal_frame}
|
4293 |
|
|
Mark current function as signal trampoline.
|
4294 |
|
|
|
4295 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_window_save}
|
4296 |
|
|
SPARC register window has been saved.
|
4297 |
|
|
|
4298 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_escape} @var{expression}[, @dots{}]
|
4299 |
|
|
Allows the user to add arbitrary bytes to the unwind info. One
|
4300 |
|
|
might use this to add OS-specific CFI opcodes, or generic CFI
|
4301 |
|
|
opcodes that GAS does not yet support.
|
4302 |
|
|
|
4303 |
|
|
@section @code{.cfi_val_encoded_addr @var{register}, @var{encoding}, @var{label}}
|
4304 |
|
|
The current value of @var{register} is @var{label}. The value of @var{label}
|
4305 |
|
|
will be encoded in the output file according to @var{encoding}; see the
|
4306 |
|
|
description of @code{.cfi_personality} for details on this encoding.
|
4307 |
|
|
|
4308 |
|
|
The usefulness of equating a register to a fixed label is probably
|
4309 |
|
|
limited to the return address register. Here, it can be useful to
|
4310 |
|
|
mark a code segment that has only one return address which is reached
|
4311 |
|
|
by a direct branch and no copy of the return address exists in memory
|
4312 |
|
|
or another register.
|
4313 |
|
|
|
4314 |
|
|
@node Comm
|
4315 |
|
|
@section @code{.comm @var{symbol} , @var{length} }
|
4316 |
|
|
|
4317 |
|
|
@cindex @code{comm} directive
|
4318 |
|
|
@cindex symbol, common
|
4319 |
|
|
@code{.comm} declares a common symbol named @var{symbol}. When linking, a
|
4320 |
|
|
common symbol in one object file may be merged with a defined or common symbol
|
4321 |
|
|
of the same name in another object file. If @code{@value{LD}} does not see a
|
4322 |
|
|
definition for the symbol--just one or more common symbols--then it will
|
4323 |
|
|
allocate @var{length} bytes of uninitialized memory. @var{length} must be an
|
4324 |
|
|
absolute expression. If @code{@value{LD}} sees multiple common symbols with
|
4325 |
|
|
the same name, and they do not all have the same size, it will allocate space
|
4326 |
|
|
using the largest size.
|
4327 |
|
|
|
4328 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
4329 |
|
|
When using ELF or (as a GNU extension) PE, the @code{.comm} directive takes
|
4330 |
|
|
an optional third argument. This is the desired alignment of the symbol,
|
4331 |
|
|
specified for ELF as a byte boundary (for example, an alignment of 16 means
|
4332 |
|
|
that the least significant 4 bits of the address should be zero), and for PE
|
4333 |
|
|
as a power of two (for example, an alignment of 5 means aligned to a 32-byte
|
4334 |
|
|
boundary). The alignment must be an absolute expression, and it must be a
|
4335 |
|
|
power of two. If @code{@value{LD}} allocates uninitialized memory for the
|
4336 |
|
|
common symbol, it will use the alignment when placing the symbol. If no
|
4337 |
|
|
alignment is specified, @command{@value{AS}} will set the alignment to the
|
4338 |
|
|
largest power of two less than or equal to the size of the symbol, up to a
|
4339 |
|
|
maximum of 16 on ELF, or the default section alignment of 4 on PE@footnote{This
|
4340 |
|
|
is not the same as the executable image file alignment controlled by @code{@value{LD}}'s
|
4341 |
|
|
@samp{--section-alignment} option; image file sections in PE are aligned to
|
4342 |
|
|
multiples of 4096, which is far too large an alignment for ordinary variables.
|
4343 |
|
|
It is rather the default alignment for (non-debug) sections within object
|
4344 |
|
|
(@samp{*.o}) files, which are less strictly aligned.}.
|
4345 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4346 |
|
|
|
4347 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
4348 |
|
|
The syntax for @code{.comm} differs slightly on the HPPA. The syntax is
|
4349 |
|
|
@samp{@var{symbol} .comm, @var{length}}; @var{symbol} is optional.
|
4350 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4351 |
|
|
|
4352 |
|
|
@node Data
|
4353 |
|
|
@section @code{.data @var{subsection}}
|
4354 |
|
|
|
4355 |
|
|
@cindex @code{data} directive
|
4356 |
|
|
@code{.data} tells @command{@value{AS}} to assemble the following statements onto the
|
4357 |
|
|
end of the data subsection numbered @var{subsection} (which is an
|
4358 |
|
|
absolute expression). If @var{subsection} is omitted, it defaults
|
4359 |
|
|
to zero.
|
4360 |
|
|
|
4361 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
4362 |
|
|
@node Def
|
4363 |
|
|
@section @code{.def @var{name}}
|
4364 |
|
|
|
4365 |
|
|
@cindex @code{def} directive
|
4366 |
|
|
@cindex COFF symbols, debugging
|
4367 |
|
|
@cindex debugging COFF symbols
|
4368 |
|
|
Begin defining debugging information for a symbol @var{name}; the
|
4369 |
|
|
definition extends until the @code{.endef} directive is encountered.
|
4370 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
4371 |
|
|
|
4372 |
|
|
This directive is only observed when @command{@value{AS}} is configured for COFF
|
4373 |
|
|
format output; when producing @code{b.out}, @samp{.def} is recognized,
|
4374 |
|
|
but ignored.
|
4375 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4376 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4377 |
|
|
|
4378 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
4379 |
|
|
@node Desc
|
4380 |
|
|
@section @code{.desc @var{symbol}, @var{abs-expression}}
|
4381 |
|
|
|
4382 |
|
|
@cindex @code{desc} directive
|
4383 |
|
|
@cindex COFF symbol descriptor
|
4384 |
|
|
@cindex symbol descriptor, COFF
|
4385 |
|
|
This directive sets the descriptor of the symbol (@pxref{Symbol Attributes})
|
4386 |
|
|
to the low 16 bits of an absolute expression.
|
4387 |
|
|
|
4388 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
4389 |
|
|
The @samp{.desc} directive is not available when @command{@value{AS}} is
|
4390 |
|
|
configured for COFF output; it is only for @code{a.out} or @code{b.out}
|
4391 |
|
|
object format. For the sake of compatibility, @command{@value{AS}} accepts
|
4392 |
|
|
it, but produces no output, when configured for COFF.
|
4393 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4394 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4395 |
|
|
|
4396 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
4397 |
|
|
@node Dim
|
4398 |
|
|
@section @code{.dim}
|
4399 |
|
|
|
4400 |
|
|
@cindex @code{dim} directive
|
4401 |
|
|
@cindex COFF auxiliary symbol information
|
4402 |
|
|
@cindex auxiliary symbol information, COFF
|
4403 |
|
|
This directive is generated by compilers to include auxiliary debugging
|
4404 |
|
|
information in the symbol table. It is only permitted inside
|
4405 |
|
|
@code{.def}/@code{.endef} pairs.
|
4406 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
4407 |
|
|
|
4408 |
|
|
@samp{.dim} is only meaningful when generating COFF format output; when
|
4409 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is generating @code{b.out}, it accepts this directive but
|
4410 |
|
|
ignores it.
|
4411 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4412 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4413 |
|
|
|
4414 |
|
|
@node Double
|
4415 |
|
|
@section @code{.double @var{flonums}}
|
4416 |
|
|
|
4417 |
|
|
@cindex @code{double} directive
|
4418 |
|
|
@cindex floating point numbers (double)
|
4419 |
|
|
@code{.double} expects zero or more flonums, separated by commas. It
|
4420 |
|
|
assembles floating point numbers.
|
4421 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
4422 |
|
|
The exact kind of floating point numbers emitted depends on how
|
4423 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is configured. @xref{Machine Dependencies}.
|
4424 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4425 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
4426 |
|
|
@ifset IEEEFLOAT
|
4427 |
|
|
On the @value{TARGET} family @samp{.double} emits 64-bit floating-point numbers
|
4428 |
|
|
in @sc{ieee} format.
|
4429 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4430 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
4431 |
|
|
|
4432 |
|
|
@node Eject
|
4433 |
|
|
@section @code{.eject}
|
4434 |
|
|
|
4435 |
|
|
@cindex @code{eject} directive
|
4436 |
|
|
@cindex new page, in listings
|
4437 |
|
|
@cindex page, in listings
|
4438 |
|
|
@cindex listing control: new page
|
4439 |
|
|
Force a page break at this point, when generating assembly listings.
|
4440 |
|
|
|
4441 |
|
|
@node Else
|
4442 |
|
|
@section @code{.else}
|
4443 |
|
|
|
4444 |
|
|
@cindex @code{else} directive
|
4445 |
|
|
@code{.else} is part of the @command{@value{AS}} support for conditional
|
4446 |
|
|
assembly; see @ref{If,,@code{.if}}. It marks the beginning of a section
|
4447 |
|
|
of code to be assembled if the condition for the preceding @code{.if}
|
4448 |
|
|
was false.
|
4449 |
|
|
|
4450 |
|
|
@node Elseif
|
4451 |
|
|
@section @code{.elseif}
|
4452 |
|
|
|
4453 |
|
|
@cindex @code{elseif} directive
|
4454 |
|
|
@code{.elseif} is part of the @command{@value{AS}} support for conditional
|
4455 |
|
|
assembly; see @ref{If,,@code{.if}}. It is shorthand for beginning a new
|
4456 |
|
|
@code{.if} block that would otherwise fill the entire @code{.else} section.
|
4457 |
|
|
|
4458 |
|
|
@node End
|
4459 |
|
|
@section @code{.end}
|
4460 |
|
|
|
4461 |
|
|
@cindex @code{end} directive
|
4462 |
|
|
@code{.end} marks the end of the assembly file. @command{@value{AS}} does not
|
4463 |
|
|
process anything in the file past the @code{.end} directive.
|
4464 |
|
|
|
4465 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
4466 |
|
|
@node Endef
|
4467 |
|
|
@section @code{.endef}
|
4468 |
|
|
|
4469 |
|
|
@cindex @code{endef} directive
|
4470 |
|
|
This directive flags the end of a symbol definition begun with
|
4471 |
|
|
@code{.def}.
|
4472 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
4473 |
|
|
|
4474 |
|
|
@samp{.endef} is only meaningful when generating COFF format output; if
|
4475 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is configured to generate @code{b.out}, it accepts this
|
4476 |
|
|
directive but ignores it.
|
4477 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4478 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4479 |
|
|
|
4480 |
|
|
@node Endfunc
|
4481 |
|
|
@section @code{.endfunc}
|
4482 |
|
|
@cindex @code{endfunc} directive
|
4483 |
|
|
@code{.endfunc} marks the end of a function specified with @code{.func}.
|
4484 |
|
|
|
4485 |
|
|
@node Endif
|
4486 |
|
|
@section @code{.endif}
|
4487 |
|
|
|
4488 |
|
|
@cindex @code{endif} directive
|
4489 |
|
|
@code{.endif} is part of the @command{@value{AS}} support for conditional assembly;
|
4490 |
|
|
it marks the end of a block of code that is only assembled
|
4491 |
|
|
conditionally. @xref{If,,@code{.if}}.
|
4492 |
|
|
|
4493 |
|
|
@node Equ
|
4494 |
|
|
@section @code{.equ @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
4495 |
|
|
|
4496 |
|
|
@cindex @code{equ} directive
|
4497 |
|
|
@cindex assigning values to symbols
|
4498 |
|
|
@cindex symbols, assigning values to
|
4499 |
|
|
This directive sets the value of @var{symbol} to @var{expression}.
|
4500 |
|
|
It is synonymous with @samp{.set}; see @ref{Set,,@code{.set}}.
|
4501 |
|
|
|
4502 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
4503 |
|
|
The syntax for @code{equ} on the HPPA is
|
4504 |
|
|
@samp{@var{symbol} .equ @var{expression}}.
|
4505 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4506 |
|
|
|
4507 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
4508 |
|
|
The syntax for @code{equ} on the Z80 is
|
4509 |
|
|
@samp{@var{symbol} equ @var{expression}}.
|
4510 |
|
|
On the Z80 it is an eror if @var{symbol} is already defined,
|
4511 |
|
|
but the symbol is not protected from later redefinition.
|
4512 |
|
|
Compare @ref{Equiv}.
|
4513 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4514 |
|
|
|
4515 |
|
|
@node Equiv
|
4516 |
|
|
@section @code{.equiv @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
4517 |
|
|
@cindex @code{equiv} directive
|
4518 |
|
|
The @code{.equiv} directive is like @code{.equ} and @code{.set}, except that
|
4519 |
|
|
the assembler will signal an error if @var{symbol} is already defined. Note a
|
4520 |
|
|
symbol which has been referenced but not actually defined is considered to be
|
4521 |
|
|
undefined.
|
4522 |
|
|
|
4523 |
|
|
Except for the contents of the error message, this is roughly equivalent to
|
4524 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
4525 |
|
|
.ifdef SYM
|
4526 |
|
|
.err
|
4527 |
|
|
.endif
|
4528 |
|
|
.equ SYM,VAL
|
4529 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
4530 |
|
|
plus it protects the symbol from later redefinition.
|
4531 |
|
|
|
4532 |
|
|
@node Eqv
|
4533 |
|
|
@section @code{.eqv @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
4534 |
|
|
@cindex @code{eqv} directive
|
4535 |
|
|
The @code{.eqv} directive is like @code{.equiv}, but no attempt is made to
|
4536 |
|
|
evaluate the expression or any part of it immediately. Instead each time
|
4537 |
|
|
the resulting symbol is used in an expression, a snapshot of its current
|
4538 |
|
|
value is taken.
|
4539 |
|
|
|
4540 |
|
|
@node Err
|
4541 |
|
|
@section @code{.err}
|
4542 |
|
|
@cindex @code{err} directive
|
4543 |
|
|
If @command{@value{AS}} assembles a @code{.err} directive, it will print an error
|
4544 |
|
|
message and, unless the @option{-Z} option was used, it will not generate an
|
4545 |
|
|
object file. This can be used to signal an error in conditionally compiled code.
|
4546 |
|
|
|
4547 |
|
|
@node Error
|
4548 |
|
|
@section @code{.error "@var{string}"}
|
4549 |
|
|
@cindex error directive
|
4550 |
|
|
|
4551 |
|
|
Similarly to @code{.err}, this directive emits an error, but you can specify a
|
4552 |
|
|
string that will be emitted as the error message. If you don't specify the
|
4553 |
|
|
message, it defaults to @code{".error directive invoked in source file"}.
|
4554 |
|
|
@xref{Errors, ,Error and Warning Messages}.
|
4555 |
|
|
|
4556 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
4557 |
|
|
.error "This code has not been assembled and tested."
|
4558 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
4559 |
|
|
|
4560 |
|
|
@node Exitm
|
4561 |
|
|
@section @code{.exitm}
|
4562 |
|
|
Exit early from the current macro definition. @xref{Macro}.
|
4563 |
|
|
|
4564 |
|
|
@node Extern
|
4565 |
|
|
@section @code{.extern}
|
4566 |
|
|
|
4567 |
|
|
@cindex @code{extern} directive
|
4568 |
|
|
@code{.extern} is accepted in the source program---for compatibility
|
4569 |
|
|
with other assemblers---but it is ignored. @command{@value{AS}} treats
|
4570 |
|
|
all undefined symbols as external.
|
4571 |
|
|
|
4572 |
|
|
@node Fail
|
4573 |
|
|
@section @code{.fail @var{expression}}
|
4574 |
|
|
|
4575 |
|
|
@cindex @code{fail} directive
|
4576 |
|
|
Generates an error or a warning. If the value of the @var{expression} is 500
|
4577 |
|
|
or more, @command{@value{AS}} will print a warning message. If the value is less
|
4578 |
|
|
than 500, @command{@value{AS}} will print an error message. The message will
|
4579 |
|
|
include the value of @var{expression}. This can occasionally be useful inside
|
4580 |
|
|
complex nested macros or conditional assembly.
|
4581 |
|
|
|
4582 |
|
|
@node File
|
4583 |
|
|
@section @code{.file}
|
4584 |
|
|
@cindex @code{file} directive
|
4585 |
|
|
|
4586 |
|
|
@ifclear no-file-dir
|
4587 |
|
|
There are two different versions of the @code{.file} directive. Targets
|
4588 |
|
|
that support DWARF2 line number information use the DWARF2 version of
|
4589 |
|
|
@code{.file}. Other targets use the default version.
|
4590 |
|
|
|
4591 |
|
|
@subheading Default Version
|
4592 |
|
|
|
4593 |
|
|
@cindex logical file name
|
4594 |
|
|
@cindex file name, logical
|
4595 |
|
|
This version of the @code{.file} directive tells @command{@value{AS}} that we
|
4596 |
|
|
are about to start a new logical file. The syntax is:
|
4597 |
|
|
|
4598 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
4599 |
|
|
.file @var{string}
|
4600 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
4601 |
|
|
|
4602 |
|
|
@var{string} is the new file name. In general, the filename is
|
4603 |
|
|
recognized whether or not it is surrounded by quotes @samp{"}; but if you wish
|
4604 |
|
|
to specify an empty file name, you must give the quotes--@code{""}. This
|
4605 |
|
|
statement may go away in future: it is only recognized to be compatible with
|
4606 |
|
|
old @command{@value{AS}} programs.
|
4607 |
|
|
|
4608 |
|
|
@subheading DWARF2 Version
|
4609 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
4610 |
|
|
|
4611 |
|
|
When emitting DWARF2 line number information, @code{.file} assigns filenames
|
4612 |
|
|
to the @code{.debug_line} file name table. The syntax is:
|
4613 |
|
|
|
4614 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
4615 |
|
|
.file @var{fileno} @var{filename}
|
4616 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
4617 |
|
|
|
4618 |
|
|
The @var{fileno} operand should be a unique positive integer to use as the
|
4619 |
|
|
index of the entry in the table. The @var{filename} operand is a C string
|
4620 |
|
|
literal.
|
4621 |
|
|
|
4622 |
|
|
The detail of filename indices is exposed to the user because the filename
|
4623 |
|
|
table is shared with the @code{.debug_info} section of the DWARF2 debugging
|
4624 |
|
|
information, and thus the user must know the exact indices that table
|
4625 |
|
|
entries will have.
|
4626 |
|
|
|
4627 |
|
|
@node Fill
|
4628 |
|
|
@section @code{.fill @var{repeat} , @var{size} , @var{value}}
|
4629 |
|
|
|
4630 |
|
|
@cindex @code{fill} directive
|
4631 |
|
|
@cindex writing patterns in memory
|
4632 |
|
|
@cindex patterns, writing in memory
|
4633 |
|
|
@var{repeat}, @var{size} and @var{value} are absolute expressions.
|
4634 |
|
|
This emits @var{repeat} copies of @var{size} bytes. @var{Repeat}
|
4635 |
|
|
may be zero or more. @var{Size} may be zero or more, but if it is
|
4636 |
|
|
more than 8, then it is deemed to have the value 8, compatible with
|
4637 |
|
|
other people's assemblers. The contents of each @var{repeat} bytes
|
4638 |
|
|
is taken from an 8-byte number. The highest order 4 bytes are
|
4639 |
|
|
zero. The lowest order 4 bytes are @var{value} rendered in the
|
4640 |
|
|
byte-order of an integer on the computer @command{@value{AS}} is assembling for.
|
4641 |
|
|
Each @var{size} bytes in a repetition is taken from the lowest order
|
4642 |
|
|
@var{size} bytes of this number. Again, this bizarre behavior is
|
4643 |
|
|
compatible with other people's assemblers.
|
4644 |
|
|
|
4645 |
|
|
@var{size} and @var{value} are optional.
|
4646 |
|
|
If the second comma and @var{value} are absent, @var{value} is
|
4647 |
|
|
assumed zero. If the first comma and following tokens are absent,
|
4648 |
|
|
@var{size} is assumed to be 1.
|
4649 |
|
|
|
4650 |
|
|
@node Float
|
4651 |
|
|
@section @code{.float @var{flonums}}
|
4652 |
|
|
|
4653 |
|
|
@cindex floating point numbers (single)
|
4654 |
|
|
@cindex @code{float} directive
|
4655 |
|
|
This directive assembles zero or more flonums, separated by commas. It
|
4656 |
|
|
has the same effect as @code{.single}.
|
4657 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
4658 |
|
|
The exact kind of floating point numbers emitted depends on how
|
4659 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is configured.
|
4660 |
|
|
@xref{Machine Dependencies}.
|
4661 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4662 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
4663 |
|
|
@ifset IEEEFLOAT
|
4664 |
|
|
On the @value{TARGET} family, @code{.float} emits 32-bit floating point numbers
|
4665 |
|
|
in @sc{ieee} format.
|
4666 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4667 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
4668 |
|
|
|
4669 |
|
|
@node Func
|
4670 |
|
|
@section @code{.func @var{name}[,@var{label}]}
|
4671 |
|
|
@cindex @code{func} directive
|
4672 |
|
|
@code{.func} emits debugging information to denote function @var{name}, and
|
4673 |
|
|
is ignored unless the file is assembled with debugging enabled.
|
4674 |
|
|
Only @samp{--gstabs[+]} is currently supported.
|
4675 |
|
|
@var{label} is the entry point of the function and if omitted @var{name}
|
4676 |
|
|
prepended with the @samp{leading char} is used.
|
4677 |
|
|
@samp{leading char} is usually @code{_} or nothing, depending on the target.
|
4678 |
|
|
All functions are currently defined to have @code{void} return type.
|
4679 |
|
|
The function must be terminated with @code{.endfunc}.
|
4680 |
|
|
|
4681 |
|
|
@node Global
|
4682 |
|
|
@section @code{.global @var{symbol}}, @code{.globl @var{symbol}}
|
4683 |
|
|
|
4684 |
|
|
@cindex @code{global} directive
|
4685 |
|
|
@cindex symbol, making visible to linker
|
4686 |
|
|
@code{.global} makes the symbol visible to @code{@value{LD}}. If you define
|
4687 |
|
|
@var{symbol} in your partial program, its value is made available to
|
4688 |
|
|
other partial programs that are linked with it. Otherwise,
|
4689 |
|
|
@var{symbol} takes its attributes from a symbol of the same name
|
4690 |
|
|
from another file linked into the same program.
|
4691 |
|
|
|
4692 |
|
|
Both spellings (@samp{.globl} and @samp{.global}) are accepted, for
|
4693 |
|
|
compatibility with other assemblers.
|
4694 |
|
|
|
4695 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
4696 |
|
|
On the HPPA, @code{.global} is not always enough to make it accessible to other
|
4697 |
|
|
partial programs. You may need the HPPA-only @code{.EXPORT} directive as well.
|
4698 |
|
|
@xref{HPPA Directives, ,HPPA Assembler Directives}.
|
4699 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4700 |
|
|
|
4701 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
4702 |
|
|
@node Gnu_attribute
|
4703 |
|
|
@section @code{.gnu_attribute @var{tag},@var{value}}
|
4704 |
|
|
Record a @sc{gnu} object attribute for this file. @xref{Object Attributes}.
|
4705 |
|
|
|
4706 |
|
|
@node Hidden
|
4707 |
|
|
@section @code{.hidden @var{names}}
|
4708 |
|
|
|
4709 |
|
|
@cindex @code{hidden} directive
|
4710 |
|
|
@cindex visibility
|
4711 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF visibility directives. The other two are
|
4712 |
|
|
@code{.internal} (@pxref{Internal,,@code{.internal}}) and
|
4713 |
|
|
@code{.protected} (@pxref{Protected,,@code{.protected}}).
|
4714 |
|
|
|
4715 |
|
|
This directive overrides the named symbols default visibility (which is set by
|
4716 |
|
|
their binding: local, global or weak). The directive sets the visibility to
|
4717 |
|
|
@code{hidden} which means that the symbols are not visible to other components.
|
4718 |
|
|
Such symbols are always considered to be @code{protected} as well.
|
4719 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4720 |
|
|
|
4721 |
|
|
@node hword
|
4722 |
|
|
@section @code{.hword @var{expressions}}
|
4723 |
|
|
|
4724 |
|
|
@cindex @code{hword} directive
|
4725 |
|
|
@cindex integers, 16-bit
|
4726 |
|
|
@cindex numbers, 16-bit
|
4727 |
|
|
@cindex sixteen bit integers
|
4728 |
|
|
This expects zero or more @var{expressions}, and emits
|
4729 |
|
|
a 16 bit number for each.
|
4730 |
|
|
|
4731 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
4732 |
|
|
This directive is a synonym for @samp{.short}; depending on the target
|
4733 |
|
|
architecture, it may also be a synonym for @samp{.word}.
|
4734 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4735 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
4736 |
|
|
@ifset W32
|
4737 |
|
|
This directive is a synonym for @samp{.short}.
|
4738 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4739 |
|
|
@ifset W16
|
4740 |
|
|
This directive is a synonym for both @samp{.short} and @samp{.word}.
|
4741 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4742 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
4743 |
|
|
|
4744 |
|
|
@node Ident
|
4745 |
|
|
@section @code{.ident}
|
4746 |
|
|
|
4747 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ident} directive
|
4748 |
|
|
|
4749 |
|
|
This directive is used by some assemblers to place tags in object files. The
|
4750 |
|
|
behavior of this directive varies depending on the target. When using the
|
4751 |
|
|
a.out object file format, @command{@value{AS}} simply accepts the directive for
|
4752 |
|
|
source-file compatibility with existing assemblers, but does not emit anything
|
4753 |
|
|
for it. When using COFF, comments are emitted to the @code{.comment} or
|
4754 |
|
|
@code{.rdata} section, depending on the target. When using ELF, comments are
|
4755 |
|
|
emitted to the @code{.comment} section.
|
4756 |
|
|
|
4757 |
|
|
@node If
|
4758 |
|
|
@section @code{.if @var{absolute expression}}
|
4759 |
|
|
|
4760 |
|
|
@cindex conditional assembly
|
4761 |
|
|
@cindex @code{if} directive
|
4762 |
|
|
@code{.if} marks the beginning of a section of code which is only
|
4763 |
|
|
considered part of the source program being assembled if the argument
|
4764 |
|
|
(which must be an @var{absolute expression}) is non-zero. The end of
|
4765 |
|
|
the conditional section of code must be marked by @code{.endif}
|
4766 |
|
|
(@pxref{Endif,,@code{.endif}}); optionally, you may include code for the
|
4767 |
|
|
alternative condition, flagged by @code{.else} (@pxref{Else,,@code{.else}}).
|
4768 |
|
|
If you have several conditions to check, @code{.elseif} may be used to avoid
|
4769 |
|
|
nesting blocks if/else within each subsequent @code{.else} block.
|
4770 |
|
|
|
4771 |
|
|
The following variants of @code{.if} are also supported:
|
4772 |
|
|
@table @code
|
4773 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifdef} directive
|
4774 |
|
|
@item .ifdef @var{symbol}
|
4775 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the specified @var{symbol}
|
4776 |
|
|
has been defined. Note a symbol which has been referenced but not yet defined
|
4777 |
|
|
is considered to be undefined.
|
4778 |
|
|
|
4779 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifb} directive
|
4780 |
|
|
@item .ifb @var{text}
|
4781 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the operand is blank (empty).
|
4782 |
|
|
|
4783 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifc} directive
|
4784 |
|
|
@item .ifc @var{string1},@var{string2}
|
4785 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the two strings are the same. The
|
4786 |
|
|
strings may be optionally quoted with single quotes. If they are not quoted,
|
4787 |
|
|
the first string stops at the first comma, and the second string stops at the
|
4788 |
|
|
end of the line. Strings which contain whitespace should be quoted. The
|
4789 |
|
|
string comparison is case sensitive.
|
4790 |
|
|
|
4791 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifeq} directive
|
4792 |
|
|
@item .ifeq @var{absolute expression}
|
4793 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the argument is zero.
|
4794 |
|
|
|
4795 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifeqs} directive
|
4796 |
|
|
@item .ifeqs @var{string1},@var{string2}
|
4797 |
|
|
Another form of @code{.ifc}. The strings must be quoted using double quotes.
|
4798 |
|
|
|
4799 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifge} directive
|
4800 |
|
|
@item .ifge @var{absolute expression}
|
4801 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the argument is greater than or
|
4802 |
|
|
equal to zero.
|
4803 |
|
|
|
4804 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifgt} directive
|
4805 |
|
|
@item .ifgt @var{absolute expression}
|
4806 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the argument is greater than zero.
|
4807 |
|
|
|
4808 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifle} directive
|
4809 |
|
|
@item .ifle @var{absolute expression}
|
4810 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the argument is less than or equal
|
4811 |
|
|
to zero.
|
4812 |
|
|
|
4813 |
|
|
@cindex @code{iflt} directive
|
4814 |
|
|
@item .iflt @var{absolute expression}
|
4815 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the argument is less than zero.
|
4816 |
|
|
|
4817 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifnb} directive
|
4818 |
|
|
@item .ifnb @var{text}
|
4819 |
|
|
Like @code{.ifb}, but the sense of the test is reversed: this assembles the
|
4820 |
|
|
following section of code if the operand is non-blank (non-empty).
|
4821 |
|
|
|
4822 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifnc} directive
|
4823 |
|
|
@item .ifnc @var{string1},@var{string2}.
|
4824 |
|
|
Like @code{.ifc}, but the sense of the test is reversed: this assembles the
|
4825 |
|
|
following section of code if the two strings are not the same.
|
4826 |
|
|
|
4827 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifndef} directive
|
4828 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifnotdef} directive
|
4829 |
|
|
@item .ifndef @var{symbol}
|
4830 |
|
|
@itemx .ifnotdef @var{symbol}
|
4831 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the specified @var{symbol}
|
4832 |
|
|
has not been defined. Both spelling variants are equivalent. Note a symbol
|
4833 |
|
|
which has been referenced but not yet defined is considered to be undefined.
|
4834 |
|
|
|
4835 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifne} directive
|
4836 |
|
|
@item .ifne @var{absolute expression}
|
4837 |
|
|
Assembles the following section of code if the argument is not equal to zero
|
4838 |
|
|
(in other words, this is equivalent to @code{.if}).
|
4839 |
|
|
|
4840 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ifnes} directive
|
4841 |
|
|
@item .ifnes @var{string1},@var{string2}
|
4842 |
|
|
Like @code{.ifeqs}, but the sense of the test is reversed: this assembles the
|
4843 |
|
|
following section of code if the two strings are not the same.
|
4844 |
|
|
@end table
|
4845 |
|
|
|
4846 |
|
|
@node Incbin
|
4847 |
|
|
@section @code{.incbin "@var{file}"[,@var{skip}[,@var{count}]]}
|
4848 |
|
|
|
4849 |
|
|
@cindex @code{incbin} directive
|
4850 |
|
|
@cindex binary files, including
|
4851 |
|
|
The @code{incbin} directive includes @var{file} verbatim at the current
|
4852 |
|
|
location. You can control the search paths used with the @samp{-I} command-line
|
4853 |
|
|
option (@pxref{Invoking,,Command-Line Options}). Quotation marks are required
|
4854 |
|
|
around @var{file}.
|
4855 |
|
|
|
4856 |
|
|
The @var{skip} argument skips a number of bytes from the start of the
|
4857 |
|
|
@var{file}. The @var{count} argument indicates the maximum number of bytes to
|
4858 |
|
|
read. Note that the data is not aligned in any way, so it is the user's
|
4859 |
|
|
responsibility to make sure that proper alignment is provided both before and
|
4860 |
|
|
after the @code{incbin} directive.
|
4861 |
|
|
|
4862 |
|
|
@node Include
|
4863 |
|
|
@section @code{.include "@var{file}"}
|
4864 |
|
|
|
4865 |
|
|
@cindex @code{include} directive
|
4866 |
|
|
@cindex supporting files, including
|
4867 |
|
|
@cindex files, including
|
4868 |
|
|
This directive provides a way to include supporting files at specified
|
4869 |
|
|
points in your source program. The code from @var{file} is assembled as
|
4870 |
|
|
if it followed the point of the @code{.include}; when the end of the
|
4871 |
|
|
included file is reached, assembly of the original file continues. You
|
4872 |
|
|
can control the search paths used with the @samp{-I} command-line option
|
4873 |
|
|
(@pxref{Invoking,,Command-Line Options}). Quotation marks are required
|
4874 |
|
|
around @var{file}.
|
4875 |
|
|
|
4876 |
|
|
@node Int
|
4877 |
|
|
@section @code{.int @var{expressions}}
|
4878 |
|
|
|
4879 |
|
|
@cindex @code{int} directive
|
4880 |
|
|
@cindex integers, 32-bit
|
4881 |
|
|
Expect zero or more @var{expressions}, of any section, separated by commas.
|
4882 |
|
|
For each expression, emit a number that, at run time, is the value of that
|
4883 |
|
|
expression. The byte order and bit size of the number depends on what kind
|
4884 |
|
|
of target the assembly is for.
|
4885 |
|
|
|
4886 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
4887 |
|
|
@ifset H8
|
4888 |
|
|
On most forms of the H8/300, @code{.int} emits 16-bit
|
4889 |
|
|
integers. On the H8/300H and the Renesas SH, however, @code{.int} emits
|
4890 |
|
|
32-bit integers.
|
4891 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4892 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
4893 |
|
|
|
4894 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
4895 |
|
|
@node Internal
|
4896 |
|
|
@section @code{.internal @var{names}}
|
4897 |
|
|
|
4898 |
|
|
@cindex @code{internal} directive
|
4899 |
|
|
@cindex visibility
|
4900 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF visibility directives. The other two are
|
4901 |
|
|
@code{.hidden} (@pxref{Hidden,,@code{.hidden}}) and
|
4902 |
|
|
@code{.protected} (@pxref{Protected,,@code{.protected}}).
|
4903 |
|
|
|
4904 |
|
|
This directive overrides the named symbols default visibility (which is set by
|
4905 |
|
|
their binding: local, global or weak). The directive sets the visibility to
|
4906 |
|
|
@code{internal} which means that the symbols are considered to be @code{hidden}
|
4907 |
|
|
(i.e., not visible to other components), and that some extra, processor specific
|
4908 |
|
|
processing must also be performed upon the symbols as well.
|
4909 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4910 |
|
|
|
4911 |
|
|
@node Irp
|
4912 |
|
|
@section @code{.irp @var{symbol},@var{values}}@dots{}
|
4913 |
|
|
|
4914 |
|
|
@cindex @code{irp} directive
|
4915 |
|
|
Evaluate a sequence of statements assigning different values to @var{symbol}.
|
4916 |
|
|
The sequence of statements starts at the @code{.irp} directive, and is
|
4917 |
|
|
terminated by an @code{.endr} directive. For each @var{value}, @var{symbol} is
|
4918 |
|
|
set to @var{value}, and the sequence of statements is assembled. If no
|
4919 |
|
|
@var{value} is listed, the sequence of statements is assembled once, with
|
4920 |
|
|
@var{symbol} set to the null string. To refer to @var{symbol} within the
|
4921 |
|
|
sequence of statements, use @var{\symbol}.
|
4922 |
|
|
|
4923 |
|
|
For example, assembling
|
4924 |
|
|
|
4925 |
|
|
@example
|
4926 |
|
|
.irp param,1,2,3
|
4927 |
|
|
move d\param,sp@@-
|
4928 |
|
|
.endr
|
4929 |
|
|
@end example
|
4930 |
|
|
|
4931 |
|
|
is equivalent to assembling
|
4932 |
|
|
|
4933 |
|
|
@example
|
4934 |
|
|
move d1,sp@@-
|
4935 |
|
|
move d2,sp@@-
|
4936 |
|
|
move d3,sp@@-
|
4937 |
|
|
@end example
|
4938 |
|
|
|
4939 |
|
|
For some caveats with the spelling of @var{symbol}, see also @ref{Macro}.
|
4940 |
|
|
|
4941 |
|
|
@node Irpc
|
4942 |
|
|
@section @code{.irpc @var{symbol},@var{values}}@dots{}
|
4943 |
|
|
|
4944 |
|
|
@cindex @code{irpc} directive
|
4945 |
|
|
Evaluate a sequence of statements assigning different values to @var{symbol}.
|
4946 |
|
|
The sequence of statements starts at the @code{.irpc} directive, and is
|
4947 |
|
|
terminated by an @code{.endr} directive. For each character in @var{value},
|
4948 |
|
|
@var{symbol} is set to the character, and the sequence of statements is
|
4949 |
|
|
assembled. If no @var{value} is listed, the sequence of statements is
|
4950 |
|
|
assembled once, with @var{symbol} set to the null string. To refer to
|
4951 |
|
|
@var{symbol} within the sequence of statements, use @var{\symbol}.
|
4952 |
|
|
|
4953 |
|
|
For example, assembling
|
4954 |
|
|
|
4955 |
|
|
@example
|
4956 |
|
|
.irpc param,123
|
4957 |
|
|
move d\param,sp@@-
|
4958 |
|
|
.endr
|
4959 |
|
|
@end example
|
4960 |
|
|
|
4961 |
|
|
is equivalent to assembling
|
4962 |
|
|
|
4963 |
|
|
@example
|
4964 |
|
|
move d1,sp@@-
|
4965 |
|
|
move d2,sp@@-
|
4966 |
|
|
move d3,sp@@-
|
4967 |
|
|
@end example
|
4968 |
|
|
|
4969 |
|
|
For some caveats with the spelling of @var{symbol}, see also the discussion
|
4970 |
|
|
at @xref{Macro}.
|
4971 |
|
|
|
4972 |
|
|
@node Lcomm
|
4973 |
|
|
@section @code{.lcomm @var{symbol} , @var{length}}
|
4974 |
|
|
|
4975 |
|
|
@cindex @code{lcomm} directive
|
4976 |
|
|
@cindex local common symbols
|
4977 |
|
|
@cindex symbols, local common
|
4978 |
|
|
Reserve @var{length} (an absolute expression) bytes for a local common
|
4979 |
|
|
denoted by @var{symbol}. The section and value of @var{symbol} are
|
4980 |
|
|
those of the new local common. The addresses are allocated in the bss
|
4981 |
|
|
section, so that at run-time the bytes start off zeroed. @var{Symbol}
|
4982 |
|
|
is not declared global (@pxref{Global,,@code{.global}}), so is normally
|
4983 |
|
|
not visible to @code{@value{LD}}.
|
4984 |
|
|
|
4985 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
4986 |
|
|
Some targets permit a third argument to be used with @code{.lcomm}. This
|
4987 |
|
|
argument specifies the desired alignment of the symbol in the bss section.
|
4988 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4989 |
|
|
|
4990 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
4991 |
|
|
The syntax for @code{.lcomm} differs slightly on the HPPA. The syntax is
|
4992 |
|
|
@samp{@var{symbol} .lcomm, @var{length}}; @var{symbol} is optional.
|
4993 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
4994 |
|
|
|
4995 |
|
|
@node Lflags
|
4996 |
|
|
@section @code{.lflags}
|
4997 |
|
|
|
4998 |
|
|
@cindex @code{lflags} directive (ignored)
|
4999 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} accepts this directive, for compatibility with other
|
5000 |
|
|
assemblers, but ignores it.
|
5001 |
|
|
|
5002 |
|
|
@ifclear no-line-dir
|
5003 |
|
|
@node Line
|
5004 |
|
|
@section @code{.line @var{line-number}}
|
5005 |
|
|
|
5006 |
|
|
@cindex @code{line} directive
|
5007 |
|
|
@cindex logical line number
|
5008 |
|
|
@ifset aout-bout
|
5009 |
|
|
Change the logical line number. @var{line-number} must be an absolute
|
5010 |
|
|
expression. The next line has that logical line number. Therefore any other
|
5011 |
|
|
statements on the current line (after a statement separator character) are
|
5012 |
|
|
reported as on logical line number @var{line-number} @minus{} 1. One day
|
5013 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} will no longer support this directive: it is recognized only
|
5014 |
|
|
for compatibility with existing assembler programs.
|
5015 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5016 |
|
|
|
5017 |
|
|
Even though this is a directive associated with the @code{a.out} or
|
5018 |
|
|
@code{b.out} object-code formats, @command{@value{AS}} still recognizes it
|
5019 |
|
|
when producing COFF output, and treats @samp{.line} as though it
|
5020 |
|
|
were the COFF @samp{.ln} @emph{if} it is found outside a
|
5021 |
|
|
@code{.def}/@code{.endef} pair.
|
5022 |
|
|
|
5023 |
|
|
Inside a @code{.def}, @samp{.line} is, instead, one of the directives
|
5024 |
|
|
used by compilers to generate auxiliary symbol information for
|
5025 |
|
|
debugging.
|
5026 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
5027 |
|
|
|
5028 |
|
|
@node Linkonce
|
5029 |
|
|
@section @code{.linkonce [@var{type}]}
|
5030 |
|
|
@cindex COMDAT
|
5031 |
|
|
@cindex @code{linkonce} directive
|
5032 |
|
|
@cindex common sections
|
5033 |
|
|
Mark the current section so that the linker only includes a single copy of it.
|
5034 |
|
|
This may be used to include the same section in several different object files,
|
5035 |
|
|
but ensure that the linker will only include it once in the final output file.
|
5036 |
|
|
The @code{.linkonce} pseudo-op must be used for each instance of the section.
|
5037 |
|
|
Duplicate sections are detected based on the section name, so it should be
|
5038 |
|
|
unique.
|
5039 |
|
|
|
5040 |
|
|
This directive is only supported by a few object file formats; as of this
|
5041 |
|
|
writing, the only object file format which supports it is the Portable
|
5042 |
|
|
Executable format used on Windows NT.
|
5043 |
|
|
|
5044 |
|
|
The @var{type} argument is optional. If specified, it must be one of the
|
5045 |
|
|
following strings. For example:
|
5046 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5047 |
|
|
.linkonce same_size
|
5048 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5049 |
|
|
Not all types may be supported on all object file formats.
|
5050 |
|
|
|
5051 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5052 |
|
|
@item discard
|
5053 |
|
|
Silently discard duplicate sections. This is the default.
|
5054 |
|
|
|
5055 |
|
|
@item one_only
|
5056 |
|
|
Warn if there are duplicate sections, but still keep only one copy.
|
5057 |
|
|
|
5058 |
|
|
@item same_size
|
5059 |
|
|
Warn if any of the duplicates have different sizes.
|
5060 |
|
|
|
5061 |
|
|
@item same_contents
|
5062 |
|
|
Warn if any of the duplicates do not have exactly the same contents.
|
5063 |
|
|
@end table
|
5064 |
|
|
|
5065 |
|
|
@node List
|
5066 |
|
|
@section @code{.list}
|
5067 |
|
|
|
5068 |
|
|
@cindex @code{list} directive
|
5069 |
|
|
@cindex listing control, turning on
|
5070 |
|
|
Control (in conjunction with the @code{.nolist} directive) whether or
|
5071 |
|
|
not assembly listings are generated. These two directives maintain an
|
5072 |
|
|
internal counter (which is zero initially). @code{.list} increments the
|
5073 |
|
|
counter, and @code{.nolist} decrements it. Assembly listings are
|
5074 |
|
|
generated whenever the counter is greater than zero.
|
5075 |
|
|
|
5076 |
|
|
By default, listings are disabled. When you enable them (with the
|
5077 |
|
|
@samp{-a} command line option; @pxref{Invoking,,Command-Line Options}),
|
5078 |
|
|
the initial value of the listing counter is one.
|
5079 |
|
|
|
5080 |
|
|
@node Ln
|
5081 |
|
|
@section @code{.ln @var{line-number}}
|
5082 |
|
|
|
5083 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ln} directive
|
5084 |
|
|
@ifclear no-line-dir
|
5085 |
|
|
@samp{.ln} is a synonym for @samp{.line}.
|
5086 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
5087 |
|
|
@ifset no-line-dir
|
5088 |
|
|
Tell @command{@value{AS}} to change the logical line number. @var{line-number}
|
5089 |
|
|
must be an absolute expression. The next line has that logical
|
5090 |
|
|
line number, so any other statements on the current line (after a
|
5091 |
|
|
statement separator character @code{;}) are reported as on logical
|
5092 |
|
|
line number @var{line-number} @minus{} 1.
|
5093 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
5094 |
|
|
|
5095 |
|
|
This directive is accepted, but ignored, when @command{@value{AS}} is
|
5096 |
|
|
configured for @code{b.out}; its effect is only associated with COFF
|
5097 |
|
|
output format.
|
5098 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5099 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5100 |
|
|
|
5101 |
|
|
@node Loc
|
5102 |
|
|
@section @code{.loc @var{fileno} @var{lineno} [@var{column}] [@var{options}]}
|
5103 |
|
|
@cindex @code{loc} directive
|
5104 |
|
|
When emitting DWARF2 line number information,
|
5105 |
|
|
the @code{.loc} directive will add a row to the @code{.debug_line} line
|
5106 |
|
|
number matrix corresponding to the immediately following assembly
|
5107 |
|
|
instruction. The @var{fileno}, @var{lineno}, and optional @var{column}
|
5108 |
|
|
arguments will be applied to the @code{.debug_line} state machine before
|
5109 |
|
|
the row is added.
|
5110 |
|
|
|
5111 |
|
|
The @var{options} are a sequence of the following tokens in any order:
|
5112 |
|
|
|
5113 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5114 |
|
|
@item basic_block
|
5115 |
|
|
This option will set the @code{basic_block} register in the
|
5116 |
|
|
@code{.debug_line} state machine to @code{true}.
|
5117 |
|
|
|
5118 |
|
|
@item prologue_end
|
5119 |
|
|
This option will set the @code{prologue_end} register in the
|
5120 |
|
|
@code{.debug_line} state machine to @code{true}.
|
5121 |
|
|
|
5122 |
|
|
@item epilogue_begin
|
5123 |
|
|
This option will set the @code{epilogue_begin} register in the
|
5124 |
|
|
@code{.debug_line} state machine to @code{true}.
|
5125 |
|
|
|
5126 |
|
|
@item is_stmt @var{value}
|
5127 |
|
|
This option will set the @code{is_stmt} register in the
|
5128 |
|
|
@code{.debug_line} state machine to @code{value}, which must be
|
5129 |
|
|
either 0 or 1.
|
5130 |
|
|
|
5131 |
|
|
@item isa @var{value}
|
5132 |
|
|
This directive will set the @code{isa} register in the @code{.debug_line}
|
5133 |
|
|
state machine to @var{value}, which must be an unsigned integer.
|
5134 |
|
|
|
5135 |
|
|
@item discriminator @var{value}
|
5136 |
|
|
This directive will set the @code{discriminator} register in the @code{.debug_line}
|
5137 |
|
|
state machine to @var{value}, which must be an unsigned integer.
|
5138 |
|
|
|
5139 |
|
|
@end table
|
5140 |
|
|
|
5141 |
|
|
@node Loc_mark_labels
|
5142 |
|
|
@section @code{.loc_mark_labels @var{enable}}
|
5143 |
|
|
@cindex @code{loc_mark_labels} directive
|
5144 |
|
|
When emitting DWARF2 line number information,
|
5145 |
|
|
the @code{.loc_mark_labels} directive makes the assembler emit an entry
|
5146 |
|
|
to the @code{.debug_line} line number matrix with the @code{basic_block}
|
5147 |
|
|
register in the state machine set whenever a code label is seen.
|
5148 |
|
|
The @var{enable} argument should be either 1 or 0, to enable or disable
|
5149 |
|
|
this function respectively.
|
5150 |
|
|
|
5151 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5152 |
|
|
@node Local
|
5153 |
|
|
@section @code{.local @var{names}}
|
5154 |
|
|
|
5155 |
|
|
@cindex @code{local} directive
|
5156 |
|
|
This directive, which is available for ELF targets, marks each symbol in
|
5157 |
|
|
the comma-separated list of @code{names} as a local symbol so that it
|
5158 |
|
|
will not be externally visible. If the symbols do not already exist,
|
5159 |
|
|
they will be created.
|
5160 |
|
|
|
5161 |
|
|
For targets where the @code{.lcomm} directive (@pxref{Lcomm}) does not
|
5162 |
|
|
accept an alignment argument, which is the case for most ELF targets,
|
5163 |
|
|
the @code{.local} directive can be used in combination with @code{.comm}
|
5164 |
|
|
(@pxref{Comm}) to define aligned local common data.
|
5165 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5166 |
|
|
|
5167 |
|
|
@node Long
|
5168 |
|
|
@section @code{.long @var{expressions}}
|
5169 |
|
|
|
5170 |
|
|
@cindex @code{long} directive
|
5171 |
|
|
@code{.long} is the same as @samp{.int}. @xref{Int,,@code{.int}}.
|
5172 |
|
|
|
5173 |
|
|
@ignore
|
5174 |
|
|
@c no one seems to know what this is for or whether this description is
|
5175 |
|
|
@c what it really ought to do
|
5176 |
|
|
@node Lsym
|
5177 |
|
|
@section @code{.lsym @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
5178 |
|
|
|
5179 |
|
|
@cindex @code{lsym} directive
|
5180 |
|
|
@cindex symbol, not referenced in assembly
|
5181 |
|
|
@code{.lsym} creates a new symbol named @var{symbol}, but does not put it in
|
5182 |
|
|
the hash table, ensuring it cannot be referenced by name during the
|
5183 |
|
|
rest of the assembly. This sets the attributes of the symbol to be
|
5184 |
|
|
the same as the expression value:
|
5185 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5186 |
|
|
@var{other} = @var{descriptor} = 0
|
5187 |
|
|
@var{type} = @r{(section of @var{expression})}
|
5188 |
|
|
@var{value} = @var{expression}
|
5189 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5190 |
|
|
@noindent
|
5191 |
|
|
The new symbol is not flagged as external.
|
5192 |
|
|
@end ignore
|
5193 |
|
|
|
5194 |
|
|
@node Macro
|
5195 |
|
|
@section @code{.macro}
|
5196 |
|
|
|
5197 |
|
|
@cindex macros
|
5198 |
|
|
The commands @code{.macro} and @code{.endm} allow you to define macros that
|
5199 |
|
|
generate assembly output. For example, this definition specifies a macro
|
5200 |
|
|
@code{sum} that puts a sequence of numbers into memory:
|
5201 |
|
|
|
5202 |
|
|
@example
|
5203 |
|
|
.macro sum from=0, to=5
|
5204 |
|
|
.long \from
|
5205 |
|
|
.if \to-\from
|
5206 |
|
|
sum "(\from+1)",\to
|
5207 |
|
|
.endif
|
5208 |
|
|
.endm
|
5209 |
|
|
@end example
|
5210 |
|
|
|
5211 |
|
|
@noindent
|
5212 |
|
|
With that definition, @samp{SUM 0,5} is equivalent to this assembly input:
|
5213 |
|
|
|
5214 |
|
|
@example
|
5215 |
|
|
.long 0
|
5216 |
|
|
.long 1
|
5217 |
|
|
.long 2
|
5218 |
|
|
.long 3
|
5219 |
|
|
.long 4
|
5220 |
|
|
.long 5
|
5221 |
|
|
@end example
|
5222 |
|
|
|
5223 |
|
|
@ftable @code
|
5224 |
|
|
@item .macro @var{macname}
|
5225 |
|
|
@itemx .macro @var{macname} @var{macargs} @dots{}
|
5226 |
|
|
@cindex @code{macro} directive
|
5227 |
|
|
Begin the definition of a macro called @var{macname}. If your macro
|
5228 |
|
|
definition requires arguments, specify their names after the macro name,
|
5229 |
|
|
separated by commas or spaces. You can qualify the macro argument to
|
5230 |
|
|
indicate whether all invocations must specify a non-blank value (through
|
5231 |
|
|
@samp{:@code{req}}), or whether it takes all of the remaining arguments
|
5232 |
|
|
(through @samp{:@code{vararg}}). You can supply a default value for any
|
5233 |
|
|
macro argument by following the name with @samp{=@var{deflt}}. You
|
5234 |
|
|
cannot define two macros with the same @var{macname} unless it has been
|
5235 |
|
|
subject to the @code{.purgem} directive (@pxref{Purgem}) between the two
|
5236 |
|
|
definitions. For example, these are all valid @code{.macro} statements:
|
5237 |
|
|
|
5238 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5239 |
|
|
@item .macro comm
|
5240 |
|
|
Begin the definition of a macro called @code{comm}, which takes no
|
5241 |
|
|
arguments.
|
5242 |
|
|
|
5243 |
|
|
@item .macro plus1 p, p1
|
5244 |
|
|
@itemx .macro plus1 p p1
|
5245 |
|
|
Either statement begins the definition of a macro called @code{plus1},
|
5246 |
|
|
which takes two arguments; within the macro definition, write
|
5247 |
|
|
@samp{\p} or @samp{\p1} to evaluate the arguments.
|
5248 |
|
|
|
5249 |
|
|
@item .macro reserve_str p1=0 p2
|
5250 |
|
|
Begin the definition of a macro called @code{reserve_str}, with two
|
5251 |
|
|
arguments. The first argument has a default value, but not the second.
|
5252 |
|
|
After the definition is complete, you can call the macro either as
|
5253 |
|
|
@samp{reserve_str @var{a},@var{b}} (with @samp{\p1} evaluating to
|
5254 |
|
|
@var{a} and @samp{\p2} evaluating to @var{b}), or as @samp{reserve_str
|
5255 |
|
|
,@var{b}} (with @samp{\p1} evaluating as the default, in this case
|
5256 |
|
|
@samp{0}, and @samp{\p2} evaluating to @var{b}).
|
5257 |
|
|
|
5258 |
|
|
@item .macro m p1:req, p2=0, p3:vararg
|
5259 |
|
|
Begin the definition of a macro called @code{m}, with at least three
|
5260 |
|
|
arguments. The first argument must always have a value specified, but
|
5261 |
|
|
not the second, which instead has a default value. The third formal
|
5262 |
|
|
will get assigned all remaining arguments specified at invocation time.
|
5263 |
|
|
|
5264 |
|
|
When you call a macro, you can specify the argument values either by
|
5265 |
|
|
position, or by keyword. For example, @samp{sum 9,17} is equivalent to
|
5266 |
|
|
@samp{sum to=17, from=9}.
|
5267 |
|
|
|
5268 |
|
|
@end table
|
5269 |
|
|
|
5270 |
|
|
Note that since each of the @var{macargs} can be an identifier exactly
|
5271 |
|
|
as any other one permitted by the target architecture, there may be
|
5272 |
|
|
occasional problems if the target hand-crafts special meanings to certain
|
5273 |
|
|
characters when they occur in a special position. For example, if the colon
|
5274 |
|
|
(@code{:}) is generally permitted to be part of a symbol name, but the
|
5275 |
|
|
architecture specific code special-cases it when occurring as the final
|
5276 |
|
|
character of a symbol (to denote a label), then the macro parameter
|
5277 |
|
|
replacement code will have no way of knowing that and consider the whole
|
5278 |
|
|
construct (including the colon) an identifier, and check only this
|
5279 |
|
|
identifier for being the subject to parameter substitution. So for example
|
5280 |
|
|
this macro definition:
|
5281 |
|
|
|
5282 |
|
|
@example
|
5283 |
|
|
.macro label l
|
5284 |
|
|
\l:
|
5285 |
|
|
.endm
|
5286 |
|
|
@end example
|
5287 |
|
|
|
5288 |
|
|
might not work as expected. Invoking @samp{label foo} might not create a label
|
5289 |
|
|
called @samp{foo} but instead just insert the text @samp{\l:} into the
|
5290 |
|
|
assembler source, probably generating an error about an unrecognised
|
5291 |
|
|
identifier.
|
5292 |
|
|
|
5293 |
|
|
Similarly problems might occur with the period character (@samp{.})
|
5294 |
|
|
which is often allowed inside opcode names (and hence identifier names). So
|
5295 |
|
|
for example constructing a macro to build an opcode from a base name and a
|
5296 |
|
|
length specifier like this:
|
5297 |
|
|
|
5298 |
|
|
@example
|
5299 |
|
|
.macro opcode base length
|
5300 |
|
|
\base.\length
|
5301 |
|
|
.endm
|
5302 |
|
|
@end example
|
5303 |
|
|
|
5304 |
|
|
and invoking it as @samp{opcode store l} will not create a @samp{store.l}
|
5305 |
|
|
instruction but instead generate some kind of error as the assembler tries to
|
5306 |
|
|
interpret the text @samp{\base.\length}.
|
5307 |
|
|
|
5308 |
|
|
There are several possible ways around this problem:
|
5309 |
|
|
|
5310 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5311 |
|
|
@item Insert white space
|
5312 |
|
|
If it is possible to use white space characters then this is the simplest
|
5313 |
|
|
solution. eg:
|
5314 |
|
|
|
5315 |
|
|
@example
|
5316 |
|
|
.macro label l
|
5317 |
|
|
\l :
|
5318 |
|
|
.endm
|
5319 |
|
|
@end example
|
5320 |
|
|
|
5321 |
|
|
@item Use @samp{\()}
|
5322 |
|
|
The string @samp{\()} can be used to separate the end of a macro argument from
|
5323 |
|
|
the following text. eg:
|
5324 |
|
|
|
5325 |
|
|
@example
|
5326 |
|
|
.macro opcode base length
|
5327 |
|
|
\base\().\length
|
5328 |
|
|
.endm
|
5329 |
|
|
@end example
|
5330 |
|
|
|
5331 |
|
|
@item Use the alternate macro syntax mode
|
5332 |
|
|
In the alternative macro syntax mode the ampersand character (@samp{&}) can be
|
5333 |
|
|
used as a separator. eg:
|
5334 |
|
|
|
5335 |
|
|
@example
|
5336 |
|
|
.altmacro
|
5337 |
|
|
.macro label l
|
5338 |
|
|
l&:
|
5339 |
|
|
.endm
|
5340 |
|
|
@end example
|
5341 |
|
|
@end table
|
5342 |
|
|
|
5343 |
|
|
Note: this problem of correctly identifying string parameters to pseudo ops
|
5344 |
|
|
also applies to the identifiers used in @code{.irp} (@pxref{Irp})
|
5345 |
|
|
and @code{.irpc} (@pxref{Irpc}) as well.
|
5346 |
|
|
|
5347 |
|
|
@item .endm
|
5348 |
|
|
@cindex @code{endm} directive
|
5349 |
|
|
Mark the end of a macro definition.
|
5350 |
|
|
|
5351 |
|
|
@item .exitm
|
5352 |
|
|
@cindex @code{exitm} directive
|
5353 |
|
|
Exit early from the current macro definition.
|
5354 |
|
|
|
5355 |
|
|
@cindex number of macros executed
|
5356 |
|
|
@cindex macros, count executed
|
5357 |
|
|
@item \@@
|
5358 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} maintains a counter of how many macros it has
|
5359 |
|
|
executed in this pseudo-variable; you can copy that number to your
|
5360 |
|
|
output with @samp{\@@}, but @emph{only within a macro definition}.
|
5361 |
|
|
|
5362 |
|
|
@item LOCAL @var{name} [ , @dots{} ]
|
5363 |
|
|
@emph{Warning: @code{LOCAL} is only available if you select ``alternate
|
5364 |
|
|
macro syntax'' with @samp{--alternate} or @code{.altmacro}.}
|
5365 |
|
|
@xref{Altmacro,,@code{.altmacro}}.
|
5366 |
|
|
@end ftable
|
5367 |
|
|
|
5368 |
|
|
@node MRI
|
5369 |
|
|
@section @code{.mri @var{val}}
|
5370 |
|
|
|
5371 |
|
|
@cindex @code{mri} directive
|
5372 |
|
|
@cindex MRI mode, temporarily
|
5373 |
|
|
If @var{val} is non-zero, this tells @command{@value{AS}} to enter MRI mode. If
|
5374 |
|
|
@var{val} is zero, this tells @command{@value{AS}} to exit MRI mode. This change
|
5375 |
|
|
affects code assembled until the next @code{.mri} directive, or until the end
|
5376 |
|
|
of the file. @xref{M, MRI mode, MRI mode}.
|
5377 |
|
|
|
5378 |
|
|
@node Noaltmacro
|
5379 |
|
|
@section @code{.noaltmacro}
|
5380 |
|
|
Disable alternate macro mode. @xref{Altmacro}.
|
5381 |
|
|
|
5382 |
|
|
@node Nolist
|
5383 |
|
|
@section @code{.nolist}
|
5384 |
|
|
|
5385 |
|
|
@cindex @code{nolist} directive
|
5386 |
|
|
@cindex listing control, turning off
|
5387 |
|
|
Control (in conjunction with the @code{.list} directive) whether or
|
5388 |
|
|
not assembly listings are generated. These two directives maintain an
|
5389 |
|
|
internal counter (which is zero initially). @code{.list} increments the
|
5390 |
|
|
counter, and @code{.nolist} decrements it. Assembly listings are
|
5391 |
|
|
generated whenever the counter is greater than zero.
|
5392 |
|
|
|
5393 |
|
|
@node Octa
|
5394 |
|
|
@section @code{.octa @var{bignums}}
|
5395 |
|
|
|
5396 |
|
|
@c FIXME: double size emitted for "octa" on i960, others? Or warn?
|
5397 |
|
|
@cindex @code{octa} directive
|
5398 |
|
|
@cindex integer, 16-byte
|
5399 |
|
|
@cindex sixteen byte integer
|
5400 |
|
|
This directive expects zero or more bignums, separated by commas. For each
|
5401 |
|
|
bignum, it emits a 16-byte integer.
|
5402 |
|
|
|
5403 |
|
|
The term ``octa'' comes from contexts in which a ``word'' is two bytes;
|
5404 |
|
|
hence @emph{octa}-word for 16 bytes.
|
5405 |
|
|
|
5406 |
|
|
@node Org
|
5407 |
|
|
@section @code{.org @var{new-lc} , @var{fill}}
|
5408 |
|
|
|
5409 |
|
|
@cindex @code{org} directive
|
5410 |
|
|
@cindex location counter, advancing
|
5411 |
|
|
@cindex advancing location counter
|
5412 |
|
|
@cindex current address, advancing
|
5413 |
|
|
Advance the location counter of the current section to
|
5414 |
|
|
@var{new-lc}. @var{new-lc} is either an absolute expression or an
|
5415 |
|
|
expression with the same section as the current subsection. That is,
|
5416 |
|
|
you can't use @code{.org} to cross sections: if @var{new-lc} has the
|
5417 |
|
|
wrong section, the @code{.org} directive is ignored. To be compatible
|
5418 |
|
|
with former assemblers, if the section of @var{new-lc} is absolute,
|
5419 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} issues a warning, then pretends the section of @var{new-lc}
|
5420 |
|
|
is the same as the current subsection.
|
5421 |
|
|
|
5422 |
|
|
@code{.org} may only increase the location counter, or leave it
|
5423 |
|
|
unchanged; you cannot use @code{.org} to move the location counter
|
5424 |
|
|
backwards.
|
5425 |
|
|
|
5426 |
|
|
@c double negative used below "not undefined" because this is a specific
|
5427 |
|
|
@c reference to "undefined" (as SEG_UNKNOWN is called in this manual)
|
5428 |
|
|
@c section. doc@cygnus.com 18feb91
|
5429 |
|
|
Because @command{@value{AS}} tries to assemble programs in one pass, @var{new-lc}
|
5430 |
|
|
may not be undefined. If you really detest this restriction we eagerly await
|
5431 |
|
|
a chance to share your improved assembler.
|
5432 |
|
|
|
5433 |
|
|
Beware that the origin is relative to the start of the section, not
|
5434 |
|
|
to the start of the subsection. This is compatible with other
|
5435 |
|
|
people's assemblers.
|
5436 |
|
|
|
5437 |
|
|
When the location counter (of the current subsection) is advanced, the
|
5438 |
|
|
intervening bytes are filled with @var{fill} which should be an
|
5439 |
|
|
absolute expression. If the comma and @var{fill} are omitted,
|
5440 |
|
|
@var{fill} defaults to zero.
|
5441 |
|
|
|
5442 |
|
|
@node P2align
|
5443 |
|
|
@section @code{.p2align[wl] @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}, @var{abs-expr}}
|
5444 |
|
|
|
5445 |
|
|
@cindex padding the location counter given a power of two
|
5446 |
|
|
@cindex @code{p2align} directive
|
5447 |
|
|
Pad the location counter (in the current subsection) to a particular
|
5448 |
|
|
storage boundary. The first expression (which must be absolute) is the
|
5449 |
|
|
number of low-order zero bits the location counter must have after
|
5450 |
|
|
advancement. For example @samp{.p2align 3} advances the location
|
5451 |
|
|
counter until it a multiple of 8. If the location counter is already a
|
5452 |
|
|
multiple of 8, no change is needed.
|
5453 |
|
|
|
5454 |
|
|
The second expression (also absolute) gives the fill value to be stored in the
|
5455 |
|
|
padding bytes. It (and the comma) may be omitted. If it is omitted, the
|
5456 |
|
|
padding bytes are normally zero. However, on some systems, if the section is
|
5457 |
|
|
marked as containing code and the fill value is omitted, the space is filled
|
5458 |
|
|
with no-op instructions.
|
5459 |
|
|
|
5460 |
|
|
The third expression is also absolute, and is also optional. If it is present,
|
5461 |
|
|
it is the maximum number of bytes that should be skipped by this alignment
|
5462 |
|
|
directive. If doing the alignment would require skipping more bytes than the
|
5463 |
|
|
specified maximum, then the alignment is not done at all. You can omit the
|
5464 |
|
|
fill value (the second argument) entirely by simply using two commas after the
|
5465 |
|
|
required alignment; this can be useful if you want the alignment to be filled
|
5466 |
|
|
with no-op instructions when appropriate.
|
5467 |
|
|
|
5468 |
|
|
@cindex @code{p2alignw} directive
|
5469 |
|
|
@cindex @code{p2alignl} directive
|
5470 |
|
|
The @code{.p2alignw} and @code{.p2alignl} directives are variants of the
|
5471 |
|
|
@code{.p2align} directive. The @code{.p2alignw} directive treats the fill
|
5472 |
|
|
pattern as a two byte word value. The @code{.p2alignl} directives treats the
|
5473 |
|
|
fill pattern as a four byte longword value. For example, @code{.p2alignw
|
5474 |
|
|
2,0x368d} will align to a multiple of 4. If it skips two bytes, they will be
|
5475 |
|
|
filled in with the value 0x368d (the exact placement of the bytes depends upon
|
5476 |
|
|
the endianness of the processor). If it skips 1 or 3 bytes, the fill value is
|
5477 |
|
|
undefined.
|
5478 |
|
|
|
5479 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5480 |
|
|
@node PopSection
|
5481 |
|
|
@section @code{.popsection}
|
5482 |
|
|
|
5483 |
|
|
@cindex @code{popsection} directive
|
5484 |
|
|
@cindex Section Stack
|
5485 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF section stack manipulation directives. The others are
|
5486 |
|
|
@code{.section} (@pxref{Section}), @code{.subsection} (@pxref{SubSection}),
|
5487 |
|
|
@code{.pushsection} (@pxref{PushSection}), and @code{.previous}
|
5488 |
|
|
(@pxref{Previous}).
|
5489 |
|
|
|
5490 |
|
|
This directive replaces the current section (and subsection) with the top
|
5491 |
|
|
section (and subsection) on the section stack. This section is popped off the
|
5492 |
|
|
stack.
|
5493 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5494 |
|
|
|
5495 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5496 |
|
|
@node Previous
|
5497 |
|
|
@section @code{.previous}
|
5498 |
|
|
|
5499 |
|
|
@cindex @code{previous} directive
|
5500 |
|
|
@cindex Section Stack
|
5501 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF section stack manipulation directives. The others are
|
5502 |
|
|
@code{.section} (@pxref{Section}), @code{.subsection} (@pxref{SubSection}),
|
5503 |
|
|
@code{.pushsection} (@pxref{PushSection}), and @code{.popsection}
|
5504 |
|
|
(@pxref{PopSection}).
|
5505 |
|
|
|
5506 |
|
|
This directive swaps the current section (and subsection) with most recently
|
5507 |
|
|
referenced section/subsection pair prior to this one. Multiple
|
5508 |
|
|
@code{.previous} directives in a row will flip between two sections (and their
|
5509 |
|
|
subsections). For example:
|
5510 |
|
|
|
5511 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5512 |
|
|
.section A
|
5513 |
|
|
.subsection 1
|
5514 |
|
|
.word 0x1234
|
5515 |
|
|
.subsection 2
|
5516 |
|
|
.word 0x5678
|
5517 |
|
|
.previous
|
5518 |
|
|
.word 0x9abc
|
5519 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5520 |
|
|
|
5521 |
|
|
Will place 0x1234 and 0x9abc into subsection 1 and 0x5678 into subsection 2 of
|
5522 |
|
|
section A. Whilst:
|
5523 |
|
|
|
5524 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5525 |
|
|
.section A
|
5526 |
|
|
.subsection 1
|
5527 |
|
|
# Now in section A subsection 1
|
5528 |
|
|
.word 0x1234
|
5529 |
|
|
.section B
|
5530 |
|
|
.subsection 0
|
5531 |
|
|
# Now in section B subsection 0
|
5532 |
|
|
.word 0x5678
|
5533 |
|
|
.subsection 1
|
5534 |
|
|
# Now in section B subsection 1
|
5535 |
|
|
.word 0x9abc
|
5536 |
|
|
.previous
|
5537 |
|
|
# Now in section B subsection 0
|
5538 |
|
|
.word 0xdef0
|
5539 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5540 |
|
|
|
5541 |
|
|
Will place 0x1234 into section A, 0x5678 and 0xdef0 into subsection 0 of
|
5542 |
|
|
section B and 0x9abc into subsection 1 of section B.
|
5543 |
|
|
|
5544 |
|
|
In terms of the section stack, this directive swaps the current section with
|
5545 |
|
|
the top section on the section stack.
|
5546 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5547 |
|
|
|
5548 |
|
|
@node Print
|
5549 |
|
|
@section @code{.print @var{string}}
|
5550 |
|
|
|
5551 |
|
|
@cindex @code{print} directive
|
5552 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} will print @var{string} on the standard output during
|
5553 |
|
|
assembly. You must put @var{string} in double quotes.
|
5554 |
|
|
|
5555 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5556 |
|
|
@node Protected
|
5557 |
|
|
@section @code{.protected @var{names}}
|
5558 |
|
|
|
5559 |
|
|
@cindex @code{protected} directive
|
5560 |
|
|
@cindex visibility
|
5561 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF visibility directives. The other two are
|
5562 |
|
|
@code{.hidden} (@pxref{Hidden}) and @code{.internal} (@pxref{Internal}).
|
5563 |
|
|
|
5564 |
|
|
This directive overrides the named symbols default visibility (which is set by
|
5565 |
|
|
their binding: local, global or weak). The directive sets the visibility to
|
5566 |
|
|
@code{protected} which means that any references to the symbols from within the
|
5567 |
|
|
components that defines them must be resolved to the definition in that
|
5568 |
|
|
component, even if a definition in another component would normally preempt
|
5569 |
|
|
this.
|
5570 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5571 |
|
|
|
5572 |
|
|
@node Psize
|
5573 |
|
|
@section @code{.psize @var{lines} , @var{columns}}
|
5574 |
|
|
|
5575 |
|
|
@cindex @code{psize} directive
|
5576 |
|
|
@cindex listing control: paper size
|
5577 |
|
|
@cindex paper size, for listings
|
5578 |
|
|
Use this directive to declare the number of lines---and, optionally, the
|
5579 |
|
|
number of columns---to use for each page, when generating listings.
|
5580 |
|
|
|
5581 |
|
|
If you do not use @code{.psize}, listings use a default line-count
|
5582 |
|
|
of 60. You may omit the comma and @var{columns} specification; the
|
5583 |
|
|
default width is 200 columns.
|
5584 |
|
|
|
5585 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} generates formfeeds whenever the specified number of
|
5586 |
|
|
lines is exceeded (or whenever you explicitly request one, using
|
5587 |
|
|
@code{.eject}).
|
5588 |
|
|
|
5589 |
|
|
If you specify @var{lines} as @code{0}, no formfeeds are generated save
|
5590 |
|
|
those explicitly specified with @code{.eject}.
|
5591 |
|
|
|
5592 |
|
|
@node Purgem
|
5593 |
|
|
@section @code{.purgem @var{name}}
|
5594 |
|
|
|
5595 |
|
|
@cindex @code{purgem} directive
|
5596 |
|
|
Undefine the macro @var{name}, so that later uses of the string will not be
|
5597 |
|
|
expanded. @xref{Macro}.
|
5598 |
|
|
|
5599 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5600 |
|
|
@node PushSection
|
5601 |
|
|
@section @code{.pushsection @var{name} [, @var{subsection}] [, "@var{flags}"[, @@@var{type}[,@var{arguments}]]]}
|
5602 |
|
|
|
5603 |
|
|
@cindex @code{pushsection} directive
|
5604 |
|
|
@cindex Section Stack
|
5605 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF section stack manipulation directives. The others are
|
5606 |
|
|
@code{.section} (@pxref{Section}), @code{.subsection} (@pxref{SubSection}),
|
5607 |
|
|
@code{.popsection} (@pxref{PopSection}), and @code{.previous}
|
5608 |
|
|
(@pxref{Previous}).
|
5609 |
|
|
|
5610 |
|
|
This directive pushes the current section (and subsection) onto the
|
5611 |
|
|
top of the section stack, and then replaces the current section and
|
5612 |
|
|
subsection with @code{name} and @code{subsection}. The optional
|
5613 |
|
|
@code{flags}, @code{type} and @code{arguments} are treated the same
|
5614 |
|
|
as in the @code{.section} (@pxref{Section}) directive.
|
5615 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5616 |
|
|
|
5617 |
|
|
@node Quad
|
5618 |
|
|
@section @code{.quad @var{bignums}}
|
5619 |
|
|
|
5620 |
|
|
@cindex @code{quad} directive
|
5621 |
|
|
@code{.quad} expects zero or more bignums, separated by commas. For
|
5622 |
|
|
each bignum, it emits
|
5623 |
|
|
@ifclear bignum-16
|
5624 |
|
|
an 8-byte integer. If the bignum won't fit in 8 bytes, it prints a
|
5625 |
|
|
warning message; and just takes the lowest order 8 bytes of the bignum.
|
5626 |
|
|
@cindex eight-byte integer
|
5627 |
|
|
@cindex integer, 8-byte
|
5628 |
|
|
|
5629 |
|
|
The term ``quad'' comes from contexts in which a ``word'' is two bytes;
|
5630 |
|
|
hence @emph{quad}-word for 8 bytes.
|
5631 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
5632 |
|
|
@ifset bignum-16
|
5633 |
|
|
a 16-byte integer. If the bignum won't fit in 16 bytes, it prints a
|
5634 |
|
|
warning message; and just takes the lowest order 16 bytes of the bignum.
|
5635 |
|
|
@cindex sixteen-byte integer
|
5636 |
|
|
@cindex integer, 16-byte
|
5637 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5638 |
|
|
|
5639 |
|
|
@node Reloc
|
5640 |
|
|
@section @code{.reloc @var{offset}, @var{reloc_name}[, @var{expression}]}
|
5641 |
|
|
|
5642 |
|
|
@cindex @code{reloc} directive
|
5643 |
|
|
Generate a relocation at @var{offset} of type @var{reloc_name} with value
|
5644 |
|
|
@var{expression}. If @var{offset} is a number, the relocation is generated in
|
5645 |
|
|
the current section. If @var{offset} is an expression that resolves to a
|
5646 |
|
|
symbol plus offset, the relocation is generated in the given symbol's section.
|
5647 |
|
|
@var{expression}, if present, must resolve to a symbol plus addend or to an
|
5648 |
|
|
absolute value, but note that not all targets support an addend. e.g. ELF REL
|
5649 |
|
|
targets such as i386 store an addend in the section contents rather than in the
|
5650 |
|
|
relocation. This low level interface does not support addends stored in the
|
5651 |
|
|
section.
|
5652 |
|
|
|
5653 |
|
|
@node Rept
|
5654 |
|
|
@section @code{.rept @var{count}}
|
5655 |
|
|
|
5656 |
|
|
@cindex @code{rept} directive
|
5657 |
|
|
Repeat the sequence of lines between the @code{.rept} directive and the next
|
5658 |
|
|
@code{.endr} directive @var{count} times.
|
5659 |
|
|
|
5660 |
|
|
For example, assembling
|
5661 |
|
|
|
5662 |
|
|
@example
|
5663 |
|
|
.rept 3
|
5664 |
|
|
.long 0
|
5665 |
|
|
.endr
|
5666 |
|
|
@end example
|
5667 |
|
|
|
5668 |
|
|
is equivalent to assembling
|
5669 |
|
|
|
5670 |
|
|
@example
|
5671 |
|
|
.long 0
|
5672 |
|
|
.long 0
|
5673 |
|
|
.long 0
|
5674 |
|
|
@end example
|
5675 |
|
|
|
5676 |
|
|
@node Sbttl
|
5677 |
|
|
@section @code{.sbttl "@var{subheading}"}
|
5678 |
|
|
|
5679 |
|
|
@cindex @code{sbttl} directive
|
5680 |
|
|
@cindex subtitles for listings
|
5681 |
|
|
@cindex listing control: subtitle
|
5682 |
|
|
Use @var{subheading} as the title (third line, immediately after the
|
5683 |
|
|
title line) when generating assembly listings.
|
5684 |
|
|
|
5685 |
|
|
This directive affects subsequent pages, as well as the current page if
|
5686 |
|
|
it appears within ten lines of the top of a page.
|
5687 |
|
|
|
5688 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
5689 |
|
|
@node Scl
|
5690 |
|
|
@section @code{.scl @var{class}}
|
5691 |
|
|
|
5692 |
|
|
@cindex @code{scl} directive
|
5693 |
|
|
@cindex symbol storage class (COFF)
|
5694 |
|
|
@cindex COFF symbol storage class
|
5695 |
|
|
Set the storage-class value for a symbol. This directive may only be
|
5696 |
|
|
used inside a @code{.def}/@code{.endef} pair. Storage class may flag
|
5697 |
|
|
whether a symbol is static or external, or it may record further
|
5698 |
|
|
symbolic debugging information.
|
5699 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
5700 |
|
|
|
5701 |
|
|
The @samp{.scl} directive is primarily associated with COFF output; when
|
5702 |
|
|
configured to generate @code{b.out} output format, @command{@value{AS}}
|
5703 |
|
|
accepts this directive but ignores it.
|
5704 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5705 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5706 |
|
|
|
5707 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
5708 |
|
|
@node Section
|
5709 |
|
|
@section @code{.section @var{name}}
|
5710 |
|
|
|
5711 |
|
|
@cindex named section
|
5712 |
|
|
Use the @code{.section} directive to assemble the following code into a section
|
5713 |
|
|
named @var{name}.
|
5714 |
|
|
|
5715 |
|
|
This directive is only supported for targets that actually support arbitrarily
|
5716 |
|
|
named sections; on @code{a.out} targets, for example, it is not accepted, even
|
5717 |
|
|
with a standard @code{a.out} section name.
|
5718 |
|
|
|
5719 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
5720 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5721 |
|
|
@c only print the extra heading if both COFF and ELF are set
|
5722 |
|
|
@subheading COFF Version
|
5723 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5724 |
|
|
|
5725 |
|
|
@cindex @code{section} directive (COFF version)
|
5726 |
|
|
For COFF targets, the @code{.section} directive is used in one of the following
|
5727 |
|
|
ways:
|
5728 |
|
|
|
5729 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5730 |
|
|
.section @var{name}[, "@var{flags}"]
|
5731 |
|
|
.section @var{name}[, @var{subsection}]
|
5732 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5733 |
|
|
|
5734 |
|
|
If the optional argument is quoted, it is taken as flags to use for the
|
5735 |
|
|
section. Each flag is a single character. The following flags are recognized:
|
5736 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5737 |
|
|
@item b
|
5738 |
|
|
bss section (uninitialized data)
|
5739 |
|
|
@item n
|
5740 |
|
|
section is not loaded
|
5741 |
|
|
@item w
|
5742 |
|
|
writable section
|
5743 |
|
|
@item d
|
5744 |
|
|
data section
|
5745 |
|
|
@item r
|
5746 |
|
|
read-only section
|
5747 |
|
|
@item x
|
5748 |
|
|
executable section
|
5749 |
|
|
@item s
|
5750 |
|
|
shared section (meaningful for PE targets)
|
5751 |
|
|
@item a
|
5752 |
|
|
ignored. (For compatibility with the ELF version)
|
5753 |
|
|
@item y
|
5754 |
|
|
section is not readable (meaningful for PE targets)
|
5755 |
|
|
@item 0-9
|
5756 |
|
|
single-digit power-of-two section alignment (GNU extension)
|
5757 |
|
|
@end table
|
5758 |
|
|
|
5759 |
|
|
If no flags are specified, the default flags depend upon the section name. If
|
5760 |
|
|
the section name is not recognized, the default will be for the section to be
|
5761 |
|
|
loaded and writable. Note the @code{n} and @code{w} flags remove attributes
|
5762 |
|
|
from the section, rather than adding them, so if they are used on their own it
|
5763 |
|
|
will be as if no flags had been specified at all.
|
5764 |
|
|
|
5765 |
|
|
If the optional argument to the @code{.section} directive is not quoted, it is
|
5766 |
|
|
taken as a subsection number (@pxref{Sub-Sections}).
|
5767 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5768 |
|
|
|
5769 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5770 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
5771 |
|
|
@c only print the extra heading if both COFF and ELF are set
|
5772 |
|
|
@subheading ELF Version
|
5773 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5774 |
|
|
|
5775 |
|
|
@cindex Section Stack
|
5776 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF section stack manipulation directives. The others are
|
5777 |
|
|
@code{.subsection} (@pxref{SubSection}), @code{.pushsection}
|
5778 |
|
|
(@pxref{PushSection}), @code{.popsection} (@pxref{PopSection}), and
|
5779 |
|
|
@code{.previous} (@pxref{Previous}).
|
5780 |
|
|
|
5781 |
|
|
@cindex @code{section} directive (ELF version)
|
5782 |
|
|
For ELF targets, the @code{.section} directive is used like this:
|
5783 |
|
|
|
5784 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5785 |
|
|
.section @var{name} [, "@var{flags}"[, @@@var{type}[,@var{flag_specific_arguments}]]]
|
5786 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5787 |
|
|
|
5788 |
|
|
The optional @var{flags} argument is a quoted string which may contain any
|
5789 |
|
|
combination of the following characters:
|
5790 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5791 |
|
|
@item a
|
5792 |
|
|
section is allocatable
|
5793 |
|
|
@item w
|
5794 |
|
|
section is writable
|
5795 |
|
|
@item x
|
5796 |
|
|
section is executable
|
5797 |
|
|
@item M
|
5798 |
|
|
section is mergeable
|
5799 |
|
|
@item S
|
5800 |
|
|
section contains zero terminated strings
|
5801 |
|
|
@item G
|
5802 |
|
|
section is a member of a section group
|
5803 |
|
|
@item T
|
5804 |
|
|
section is used for thread-local-storage
|
5805 |
|
|
@end table
|
5806 |
|
|
|
5807 |
|
|
The optional @var{type} argument may contain one of the following constants:
|
5808 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5809 |
|
|
@item @@progbits
|
5810 |
|
|
section contains data
|
5811 |
|
|
@item @@nobits
|
5812 |
|
|
section does not contain data (i.e., section only occupies space)
|
5813 |
|
|
@item @@note
|
5814 |
|
|
section contains data which is used by things other than the program
|
5815 |
|
|
@item @@init_array
|
5816 |
|
|
section contains an array of pointers to init functions
|
5817 |
|
|
@item @@fini_array
|
5818 |
|
|
section contains an array of pointers to finish functions
|
5819 |
|
|
@item @@preinit_array
|
5820 |
|
|
section contains an array of pointers to pre-init functions
|
5821 |
|
|
@end table
|
5822 |
|
|
|
5823 |
|
|
Many targets only support the first three section types.
|
5824 |
|
|
|
5825 |
|
|
Note on targets where the @code{@@} character is the start of a comment (eg
|
5826 |
|
|
ARM) then another character is used instead. For example the ARM port uses the
|
5827 |
|
|
@code{%} character.
|
5828 |
|
|
|
5829 |
|
|
If @var{flags} contains the @code{M} symbol then the @var{type} argument must
|
5830 |
|
|
be specified as well as an extra argument---@var{entsize}---like this:
|
5831 |
|
|
|
5832 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5833 |
|
|
.section @var{name} , "@var{flags}"M, @@@var{type}, @var{entsize}
|
5834 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5835 |
|
|
|
5836 |
|
|
Sections with the @code{M} flag but not @code{S} flag must contain fixed size
|
5837 |
|
|
constants, each @var{entsize} octets long. Sections with both @code{M} and
|
5838 |
|
|
@code{S} must contain zero terminated strings where each character is
|
5839 |
|
|
@var{entsize} bytes long. The linker may remove duplicates within sections with
|
5840 |
|
|
the same name, same entity size and same flags. @var{entsize} must be an
|
5841 |
|
|
absolute expression. For sections with both @code{M} and @code{S}, a string
|
5842 |
|
|
which is a suffix of a larger string is considered a duplicate. Thus
|
5843 |
|
|
@code{"def"} will be merged with @code{"abcdef"}; A reference to the first
|
5844 |
|
|
@code{"def"} will be changed to a reference to @code{"abcdef"+3}.
|
5845 |
|
|
|
5846 |
|
|
If @var{flags} contains the @code{G} symbol then the @var{type} argument must
|
5847 |
|
|
be present along with an additional field like this:
|
5848 |
|
|
|
5849 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5850 |
|
|
.section @var{name} , "@var{flags}"G, @@@var{type}, @var{GroupName}[, @var{linkage}]
|
5851 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5852 |
|
|
|
5853 |
|
|
The @var{GroupName} field specifies the name of the section group to which this
|
5854 |
|
|
particular section belongs. The optional linkage field can contain:
|
5855 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5856 |
|
|
@item comdat
|
5857 |
|
|
indicates that only one copy of this section should be retained
|
5858 |
|
|
@item .gnu.linkonce
|
5859 |
|
|
an alias for comdat
|
5860 |
|
|
@end table
|
5861 |
|
|
|
5862 |
|
|
Note: if both the @var{M} and @var{G} flags are present then the fields for
|
5863 |
|
|
the Merge flag should come first, like this:
|
5864 |
|
|
|
5865 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5866 |
|
|
.section @var{name} , "@var{flags}"MG, @@@var{type}, @var{entsize}, @var{GroupName}[, @var{linkage}]
|
5867 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5868 |
|
|
|
5869 |
|
|
If no flags are specified, the default flags depend upon the section name. If
|
5870 |
|
|
the section name is not recognized, the default will be for the section to have
|
5871 |
|
|
none of the above flags: it will not be allocated in memory, nor writable, nor
|
5872 |
|
|
executable. The section will contain data.
|
5873 |
|
|
|
5874 |
|
|
For ELF targets, the assembler supports another type of @code{.section}
|
5875 |
|
|
directive for compatibility with the Solaris assembler:
|
5876 |
|
|
|
5877 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5878 |
|
|
.section "@var{name}"[, @var{flags}...]
|
5879 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5880 |
|
|
|
5881 |
|
|
Note that the section name is quoted. There may be a sequence of comma
|
5882 |
|
|
separated flags:
|
5883 |
|
|
@table @code
|
5884 |
|
|
@item #alloc
|
5885 |
|
|
section is allocatable
|
5886 |
|
|
@item #write
|
5887 |
|
|
section is writable
|
5888 |
|
|
@item #execinstr
|
5889 |
|
|
section is executable
|
5890 |
|
|
@item #tls
|
5891 |
|
|
section is used for thread local storage
|
5892 |
|
|
@end table
|
5893 |
|
|
|
5894 |
|
|
This directive replaces the current section and subsection. See the
|
5895 |
|
|
contents of the gas testsuite directory @code{gas/testsuite/gas/elf} for
|
5896 |
|
|
some examples of how this directive and the other section stack directives
|
5897 |
|
|
work.
|
5898 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5899 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5900 |
|
|
|
5901 |
|
|
@node Set
|
5902 |
|
|
@section @code{.set @var{symbol}, @var{expression}}
|
5903 |
|
|
|
5904 |
|
|
@cindex @code{set} directive
|
5905 |
|
|
@cindex symbol value, setting
|
5906 |
|
|
Set the value of @var{symbol} to @var{expression}. This
|
5907 |
|
|
changes @var{symbol}'s value and type to conform to
|
5908 |
|
|
@var{expression}. If @var{symbol} was flagged as external, it remains
|
5909 |
|
|
flagged (@pxref{Symbol Attributes}).
|
5910 |
|
|
|
5911 |
|
|
You may @code{.set} a symbol many times in the same assembly.
|
5912 |
|
|
|
5913 |
|
|
If you @code{.set} a global symbol, the value stored in the object
|
5914 |
|
|
file is the last value stored into it.
|
5915 |
|
|
|
5916 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
5917 |
|
|
The syntax for @code{set} on the HPPA is
|
5918 |
|
|
@samp{@var{symbol} .set @var{expression}}.
|
5919 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5920 |
|
|
|
5921 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
5922 |
|
|
On Z80 @code{set} is a real instruction, use
|
5923 |
|
|
@samp{@var{symbol} defl @var{expression}} instead.
|
5924 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5925 |
|
|
|
5926 |
|
|
@node Short
|
5927 |
|
|
@section @code{.short @var{expressions}}
|
5928 |
|
|
|
5929 |
|
|
@cindex @code{short} directive
|
5930 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
5931 |
|
|
@code{.short} is normally the same as @samp{.word}.
|
5932 |
|
|
@xref{Word,,@code{.word}}.
|
5933 |
|
|
|
5934 |
|
|
In some configurations, however, @code{.short} and @code{.word} generate
|
5935 |
|
|
numbers of different lengths. @xref{Machine Dependencies}.
|
5936 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5937 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
5938 |
|
|
@ifset W16
|
5939 |
|
|
@code{.short} is the same as @samp{.word}. @xref{Word,,@code{.word}}.
|
5940 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5941 |
|
|
@ifset W32
|
5942 |
|
|
This expects zero or more @var{expressions}, and emits
|
5943 |
|
|
a 16 bit number for each.
|
5944 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5945 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
5946 |
|
|
|
5947 |
|
|
@node Single
|
5948 |
|
|
@section @code{.single @var{flonums}}
|
5949 |
|
|
|
5950 |
|
|
@cindex @code{single} directive
|
5951 |
|
|
@cindex floating point numbers (single)
|
5952 |
|
|
This directive assembles zero or more flonums, separated by commas. It
|
5953 |
|
|
has the same effect as @code{.float}.
|
5954 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
5955 |
|
|
The exact kind of floating point numbers emitted depends on how
|
5956 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is configured. @xref{Machine Dependencies}.
|
5957 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5958 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
5959 |
|
|
@ifset IEEEFLOAT
|
5960 |
|
|
On the @value{TARGET} family, @code{.single} emits 32-bit floating point
|
5961 |
|
|
numbers in @sc{ieee} format.
|
5962 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5963 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
5964 |
|
|
|
5965 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
5966 |
|
|
@node Size
|
5967 |
|
|
@section @code{.size}
|
5968 |
|
|
|
5969 |
|
|
This directive is used to set the size associated with a symbol.
|
5970 |
|
|
|
5971 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
5972 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5973 |
|
|
@c only print the extra heading if both COFF and ELF are set
|
5974 |
|
|
@subheading COFF Version
|
5975 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5976 |
|
|
|
5977 |
|
|
@cindex @code{size} directive (COFF version)
|
5978 |
|
|
For COFF targets, the @code{.size} directive is only permitted inside
|
5979 |
|
|
@code{.def}/@code{.endef} pairs. It is used like this:
|
5980 |
|
|
|
5981 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5982 |
|
|
.size @var{expression}
|
5983 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5984 |
|
|
|
5985 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
5986 |
|
|
@samp{.size} is only meaningful when generating COFF format output; when
|
5987 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is generating @code{b.out}, it accepts this directive but
|
5988 |
|
|
ignores it.
|
5989 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5990 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5991 |
|
|
|
5992 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
5993 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
5994 |
|
|
@c only print the extra heading if both COFF and ELF are set
|
5995 |
|
|
@subheading ELF Version
|
5996 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
5997 |
|
|
|
5998 |
|
|
@cindex @code{size} directive (ELF version)
|
5999 |
|
|
For ELF targets, the @code{.size} directive is used like this:
|
6000 |
|
|
|
6001 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6002 |
|
|
.size @var{name} , @var{expression}
|
6003 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6004 |
|
|
|
6005 |
|
|
This directive sets the size associated with a symbol @var{name}.
|
6006 |
|
|
The size in bytes is computed from @var{expression} which can make use of label
|
6007 |
|
|
arithmetic. This directive is typically used to set the size of function
|
6008 |
|
|
symbols.
|
6009 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6010 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6011 |
|
|
|
6012 |
|
|
@ifclear no-space-dir
|
6013 |
|
|
@node Skip
|
6014 |
|
|
@section @code{.skip @var{size} , @var{fill}}
|
6015 |
|
|
|
6016 |
|
|
@cindex @code{skip} directive
|
6017 |
|
|
@cindex filling memory
|
6018 |
|
|
This directive emits @var{size} bytes, each of value @var{fill}. Both
|
6019 |
|
|
@var{size} and @var{fill} are absolute expressions. If the comma and
|
6020 |
|
|
@var{fill} are omitted, @var{fill} is assumed to be zero. This is the same as
|
6021 |
|
|
@samp{.space}.
|
6022 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
6023 |
|
|
|
6024 |
|
|
@node Sleb128
|
6025 |
|
|
@section @code{.sleb128 @var{expressions}}
|
6026 |
|
|
|
6027 |
|
|
@cindex @code{sleb128} directive
|
6028 |
|
|
@var{sleb128} stands for ``signed little endian base 128.'' This is a
|
6029 |
|
|
compact, variable length representation of numbers used by the DWARF
|
6030 |
|
|
symbolic debugging format. @xref{Uleb128, ,@code{.uleb128}}.
|
6031 |
|
|
|
6032 |
|
|
@ifclear no-space-dir
|
6033 |
|
|
@node Space
|
6034 |
|
|
@section @code{.space @var{size} , @var{fill}}
|
6035 |
|
|
|
6036 |
|
|
@cindex @code{space} directive
|
6037 |
|
|
@cindex filling memory
|
6038 |
|
|
This directive emits @var{size} bytes, each of value @var{fill}. Both
|
6039 |
|
|
@var{size} and @var{fill} are absolute expressions. If the comma
|
6040 |
|
|
and @var{fill} are omitted, @var{fill} is assumed to be zero. This is the same
|
6041 |
|
|
as @samp{.skip}.
|
6042 |
|
|
|
6043 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
6044 |
|
|
@quotation
|
6045 |
|
|
@emph{Warning:} @code{.space} has a completely different meaning for HPPA
|
6046 |
|
|
targets; use @code{.block} as a substitute. See @cite{HP9000 Series 800
|
6047 |
|
|
Assembly Language Reference Manual} (HP 92432-90001) for the meaning of the
|
6048 |
|
|
@code{.space} directive. @xref{HPPA Directives,,HPPA Assembler Directives},
|
6049 |
|
|
for a summary.
|
6050 |
|
|
@end quotation
|
6051 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6052 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
6053 |
|
|
|
6054 |
|
|
@ifset have-stabs
|
6055 |
|
|
@node Stab
|
6056 |
|
|
@section @code{.stabd, .stabn, .stabs}
|
6057 |
|
|
|
6058 |
|
|
@cindex symbolic debuggers, information for
|
6059 |
|
|
@cindex @code{stab@var{x}} directives
|
6060 |
|
|
There are three directives that begin @samp{.stab}.
|
6061 |
|
|
All emit symbols (@pxref{Symbols}), for use by symbolic debuggers.
|
6062 |
|
|
The symbols are not entered in the @command{@value{AS}} hash table: they
|
6063 |
|
|
cannot be referenced elsewhere in the source file.
|
6064 |
|
|
Up to five fields are required:
|
6065 |
|
|
|
6066 |
|
|
@table @var
|
6067 |
|
|
@item string
|
6068 |
|
|
This is the symbol's name. It may contain any character except
|
6069 |
|
|
@samp{\000}, so is more general than ordinary symbol names. Some
|
6070 |
|
|
debuggers used to code arbitrarily complex structures into symbol names
|
6071 |
|
|
using this field.
|
6072 |
|
|
|
6073 |
|
|
@item type
|
6074 |
|
|
An absolute expression. The symbol's type is set to the low 8 bits of
|
6075 |
|
|
this expression. Any bit pattern is permitted, but @code{@value{LD}}
|
6076 |
|
|
and debuggers choke on silly bit patterns.
|
6077 |
|
|
|
6078 |
|
|
@item other
|
6079 |
|
|
An absolute expression. The symbol's ``other'' attribute is set to the
|
6080 |
|
|
low 8 bits of this expression.
|
6081 |
|
|
|
6082 |
|
|
@item desc
|
6083 |
|
|
An absolute expression. The symbol's descriptor is set to the low 16
|
6084 |
|
|
bits of this expression.
|
6085 |
|
|
|
6086 |
|
|
@item value
|
6087 |
|
|
An absolute expression which becomes the symbol's value.
|
6088 |
|
|
@end table
|
6089 |
|
|
|
6090 |
|
|
If a warning is detected while reading a @code{.stabd}, @code{.stabn},
|
6091 |
|
|
or @code{.stabs} statement, the symbol has probably already been created;
|
6092 |
|
|
you get a half-formed symbol in your object file. This is
|
6093 |
|
|
compatible with earlier assemblers!
|
6094 |
|
|
|
6095 |
|
|
@table @code
|
6096 |
|
|
@cindex @code{stabd} directive
|
6097 |
|
|
@item .stabd @var{type} , @var{other} , @var{desc}
|
6098 |
|
|
|
6099 |
|
|
The ``name'' of the symbol generated is not even an empty string.
|
6100 |
|
|
It is a null pointer, for compatibility. Older assemblers used a
|
6101 |
|
|
null pointer so they didn't waste space in object files with empty
|
6102 |
|
|
strings.
|
6103 |
|
|
|
6104 |
|
|
The symbol's value is set to the location counter,
|
6105 |
|
|
relocatably. When your program is linked, the value of this symbol
|
6106 |
|
|
is the address of the location counter when the @code{.stabd} was
|
6107 |
|
|
assembled.
|
6108 |
|
|
|
6109 |
|
|
@cindex @code{stabn} directive
|
6110 |
|
|
@item .stabn @var{type} , @var{other} , @var{desc} , @var{value}
|
6111 |
|
|
The name of the symbol is set to the empty string @code{""}.
|
6112 |
|
|
|
6113 |
|
|
@cindex @code{stabs} directive
|
6114 |
|
|
@item .stabs @var{string} , @var{type} , @var{other} , @var{desc} , @var{value}
|
6115 |
|
|
All five fields are specified.
|
6116 |
|
|
@end table
|
6117 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6118 |
|
|
@c end have-stabs
|
6119 |
|
|
|
6120 |
|
|
@node String
|
6121 |
|
|
@section @code{.string} "@var{str}", @code{.string8} "@var{str}", @code{.string16}
|
6122 |
|
|
"@var{str}", @code{.string32} "@var{str}", @code{.string64} "@var{str}"
|
6123 |
|
|
|
6124 |
|
|
@cindex string, copying to object file
|
6125 |
|
|
@cindex string8, copying to object file
|
6126 |
|
|
@cindex string16, copying to object file
|
6127 |
|
|
@cindex string32, copying to object file
|
6128 |
|
|
@cindex string64, copying to object file
|
6129 |
|
|
@cindex @code{string} directive
|
6130 |
|
|
@cindex @code{string8} directive
|
6131 |
|
|
@cindex @code{string16} directive
|
6132 |
|
|
@cindex @code{string32} directive
|
6133 |
|
|
@cindex @code{string64} directive
|
6134 |
|
|
|
6135 |
|
|
Copy the characters in @var{str} to the object file. You may specify more than
|
6136 |
|
|
one string to copy, separated by commas. Unless otherwise specified for a
|
6137 |
|
|
particular machine, the assembler marks the end of each string with a 0 byte.
|
6138 |
|
|
You can use any of the escape sequences described in @ref{Strings,,Strings}.
|
6139 |
|
|
|
6140 |
|
|
The variants @code{string16}, @code{string32} and @code{string64} differ from
|
6141 |
|
|
the @code{string} pseudo opcode in that each 8-bit character from @var{str} is
|
6142 |
|
|
copied and expanded to 16, 32 or 64 bits respectively. The expanded characters
|
6143 |
|
|
are stored in target endianness byte order.
|
6144 |
|
|
|
6145 |
|
|
Example:
|
6146 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6147 |
|
|
.string32 "BYE"
|
6148 |
|
|
expands to:
|
6149 |
|
|
.string "B\0\0\0Y\0\0\0E\0\0\0" /* On little endian targets. */
|
6150 |
|
|
.string "\0\0\0B\0\0\0Y\0\0\0E" /* On big endian targets. */
|
6151 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6152 |
|
|
|
6153 |
|
|
|
6154 |
|
|
@node Struct
|
6155 |
|
|
@section @code{.struct @var{expression}}
|
6156 |
|
|
|
6157 |
|
|
@cindex @code{struct} directive
|
6158 |
|
|
Switch to the absolute section, and set the section offset to @var{expression},
|
6159 |
|
|
which must be an absolute expression. You might use this as follows:
|
6160 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6161 |
|
|
.struct 0
|
6162 |
|
|
field1:
|
6163 |
|
|
.struct field1 + 4
|
6164 |
|
|
field2:
|
6165 |
|
|
.struct field2 + 4
|
6166 |
|
|
field3:
|
6167 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6168 |
|
|
This would define the symbol @code{field1} to have the value 0, the symbol
|
6169 |
|
|
@code{field2} to have the value 4, and the symbol @code{field3} to have the
|
6170 |
|
|
value 8. Assembly would be left in the absolute section, and you would need to
|
6171 |
|
|
use a @code{.section} directive of some sort to change to some other section
|
6172 |
|
|
before further assembly.
|
6173 |
|
|
|
6174 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6175 |
|
|
@node SubSection
|
6176 |
|
|
@section @code{.subsection @var{name}}
|
6177 |
|
|
|
6178 |
|
|
@cindex @code{subsection} directive
|
6179 |
|
|
@cindex Section Stack
|
6180 |
|
|
This is one of the ELF section stack manipulation directives. The others are
|
6181 |
|
|
@code{.section} (@pxref{Section}), @code{.pushsection} (@pxref{PushSection}),
|
6182 |
|
|
@code{.popsection} (@pxref{PopSection}), and @code{.previous}
|
6183 |
|
|
(@pxref{Previous}).
|
6184 |
|
|
|
6185 |
|
|
This directive replaces the current subsection with @code{name}. The current
|
6186 |
|
|
section is not changed. The replaced subsection is put onto the section stack
|
6187 |
|
|
in place of the then current top of stack subsection.
|
6188 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6189 |
|
|
|
6190 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6191 |
|
|
@node Symver
|
6192 |
|
|
@section @code{.symver}
|
6193 |
|
|
@cindex @code{symver} directive
|
6194 |
|
|
@cindex symbol versioning
|
6195 |
|
|
@cindex versions of symbols
|
6196 |
|
|
Use the @code{.symver} directive to bind symbols to specific version nodes
|
6197 |
|
|
within a source file. This is only supported on ELF platforms, and is
|
6198 |
|
|
typically used when assembling files to be linked into a shared library.
|
6199 |
|
|
There are cases where it may make sense to use this in objects to be bound
|
6200 |
|
|
into an application itself so as to override a versioned symbol from a
|
6201 |
|
|
shared library.
|
6202 |
|
|
|
6203 |
|
|
For ELF targets, the @code{.symver} directive can be used like this:
|
6204 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6205 |
|
|
.symver @var{name}, @var{name2@@nodename}
|
6206 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6207 |
|
|
If the symbol @var{name} is defined within the file
|
6208 |
|
|
being assembled, the @code{.symver} directive effectively creates a symbol
|
6209 |
|
|
alias with the name @var{name2@@nodename}, and in fact the main reason that we
|
6210 |
|
|
just don't try and create a regular alias is that the @var{@@} character isn't
|
6211 |
|
|
permitted in symbol names. The @var{name2} part of the name is the actual name
|
6212 |
|
|
of the symbol by which it will be externally referenced. The name @var{name}
|
6213 |
|
|
itself is merely a name of convenience that is used so that it is possible to
|
6214 |
|
|
have definitions for multiple versions of a function within a single source
|
6215 |
|
|
file, and so that the compiler can unambiguously know which version of a
|
6216 |
|
|
function is being mentioned. The @var{nodename} portion of the alias should be
|
6217 |
|
|
the name of a node specified in the version script supplied to the linker when
|
6218 |
|
|
building a shared library. If you are attempting to override a versioned
|
6219 |
|
|
symbol from a shared library, then @var{nodename} should correspond to the
|
6220 |
|
|
nodename of the symbol you are trying to override.
|
6221 |
|
|
|
6222 |
|
|
If the symbol @var{name} is not defined within the file being assembled, all
|
6223 |
|
|
references to @var{name} will be changed to @var{name2@@nodename}. If no
|
6224 |
|
|
reference to @var{name} is made, @var{name2@@nodename} will be removed from the
|
6225 |
|
|
symbol table.
|
6226 |
|
|
|
6227 |
|
|
Another usage of the @code{.symver} directive is:
|
6228 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6229 |
|
|
.symver @var{name}, @var{name2@@@@nodename}
|
6230 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6231 |
|
|
In this case, the symbol @var{name} must exist and be defined within
|
6232 |
|
|
the file being assembled. It is similar to @var{name2@@nodename}. The
|
6233 |
|
|
difference is @var{name2@@@@nodename} will also be used to resolve
|
6234 |
|
|
references to @var{name2} by the linker.
|
6235 |
|
|
|
6236 |
|
|
The third usage of the @code{.symver} directive is:
|
6237 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6238 |
|
|
.symver @var{name}, @var{name2@@@@@@nodename}
|
6239 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6240 |
|
|
When @var{name} is not defined within the
|
6241 |
|
|
file being assembled, it is treated as @var{name2@@nodename}. When
|
6242 |
|
|
@var{name} is defined within the file being assembled, the symbol
|
6243 |
|
|
name, @var{name}, will be changed to @var{name2@@@@nodename}.
|
6244 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6245 |
|
|
|
6246 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
6247 |
|
|
@node Tag
|
6248 |
|
|
@section @code{.tag @var{structname}}
|
6249 |
|
|
|
6250 |
|
|
@cindex COFF structure debugging
|
6251 |
|
|
@cindex structure debugging, COFF
|
6252 |
|
|
@cindex @code{tag} directive
|
6253 |
|
|
This directive is generated by compilers to include auxiliary debugging
|
6254 |
|
|
information in the symbol table. It is only permitted inside
|
6255 |
|
|
@code{.def}/@code{.endef} pairs. Tags are used to link structure
|
6256 |
|
|
definitions in the symbol table with instances of those structures.
|
6257 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
6258 |
|
|
|
6259 |
|
|
@samp{.tag} is only used when generating COFF format output; when
|
6260 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is generating @code{b.out}, it accepts this directive but
|
6261 |
|
|
ignores it.
|
6262 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6263 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6264 |
|
|
|
6265 |
|
|
@node Text
|
6266 |
|
|
@section @code{.text @var{subsection}}
|
6267 |
|
|
|
6268 |
|
|
@cindex @code{text} directive
|
6269 |
|
|
Tells @command{@value{AS}} to assemble the following statements onto the end of
|
6270 |
|
|
the text subsection numbered @var{subsection}, which is an absolute
|
6271 |
|
|
expression. If @var{subsection} is omitted, subsection number zero
|
6272 |
|
|
is used.
|
6273 |
|
|
|
6274 |
|
|
@node Title
|
6275 |
|
|
@section @code{.title "@var{heading}"}
|
6276 |
|
|
|
6277 |
|
|
@cindex @code{title} directive
|
6278 |
|
|
@cindex listing control: title line
|
6279 |
|
|
Use @var{heading} as the title (second line, immediately after the
|
6280 |
|
|
source file name and pagenumber) when generating assembly listings.
|
6281 |
|
|
|
6282 |
|
|
This directive affects subsequent pages, as well as the current page if
|
6283 |
|
|
it appears within ten lines of the top of a page.
|
6284 |
|
|
|
6285 |
|
|
@ifset COFF-ELF
|
6286 |
|
|
@node Type
|
6287 |
|
|
@section @code{.type}
|
6288 |
|
|
|
6289 |
|
|
This directive is used to set the type of a symbol.
|
6290 |
|
|
|
6291 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
6292 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6293 |
|
|
@c only print the extra heading if both COFF and ELF are set
|
6294 |
|
|
@subheading COFF Version
|
6295 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6296 |
|
|
|
6297 |
|
|
@cindex COFF symbol type
|
6298 |
|
|
@cindex symbol type, COFF
|
6299 |
|
|
@cindex @code{type} directive (COFF version)
|
6300 |
|
|
For COFF targets, this directive is permitted only within
|
6301 |
|
|
@code{.def}/@code{.endef} pairs. It is used like this:
|
6302 |
|
|
|
6303 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6304 |
|
|
.type @var{int}
|
6305 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6306 |
|
|
|
6307 |
|
|
This records the integer @var{int} as the type attribute of a symbol table
|
6308 |
|
|
entry.
|
6309 |
|
|
|
6310 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
6311 |
|
|
@samp{.type} is associated only with COFF format output; when
|
6312 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is configured for @code{b.out} output, it accepts this
|
6313 |
|
|
directive but ignores it.
|
6314 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6315 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6316 |
|
|
|
6317 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6318 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
6319 |
|
|
@c only print the extra heading if both COFF and ELF are set
|
6320 |
|
|
@subheading ELF Version
|
6321 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6322 |
|
|
|
6323 |
|
|
@cindex ELF symbol type
|
6324 |
|
|
@cindex symbol type, ELF
|
6325 |
|
|
@cindex @code{type} directive (ELF version)
|
6326 |
|
|
For ELF targets, the @code{.type} directive is used like this:
|
6327 |
|
|
|
6328 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6329 |
|
|
.type @var{name} , @var{type description}
|
6330 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6331 |
|
|
|
6332 |
|
|
This sets the type of symbol @var{name} to be either a
|
6333 |
|
|
function symbol or an object symbol. There are five different syntaxes
|
6334 |
|
|
supported for the @var{type description} field, in order to provide
|
6335 |
|
|
compatibility with various other assemblers.
|
6336 |
|
|
|
6337 |
|
|
Because some of the characters used in these syntaxes (such as @samp{@@} and
|
6338 |
|
|
@samp{#}) are comment characters for some architectures, some of the syntaxes
|
6339 |
|
|
below do not work on all architectures. The first variant will be accepted by
|
6340 |
|
|
the GNU assembler on all architectures so that variant should be used for
|
6341 |
|
|
maximum portability, if you do not need to assemble your code with other
|
6342 |
|
|
assemblers.
|
6343 |
|
|
|
6344 |
|
|
The syntaxes supported are:
|
6345 |
|
|
|
6346 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6347 |
|
|
.type <name> STT_<TYPE_IN_UPPER_CASE>
|
6348 |
|
|
.type <name>,#<type>
|
6349 |
|
|
.type <name>,@@<type>
|
6350 |
|
|
.type <name>,%<type>
|
6351 |
|
|
.type <name>,"<type>"
|
6352 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6353 |
|
|
|
6354 |
|
|
The types supported are:
|
6355 |
|
|
|
6356 |
|
|
@table @gcctabopt
|
6357 |
|
|
@item STT_FUNC
|
6358 |
|
|
@itemx function
|
6359 |
|
|
Mark the symbol as being a function name.
|
6360 |
|
|
|
6361 |
|
|
@item STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
6362 |
|
|
@itemx gnu_indirect_function
|
6363 |
|
|
Mark the symbol as an indirect function when evaluated during reloc
|
6364 |
|
|
processing. (This is only supported on Linux targeted assemblers).
|
6365 |
|
|
|
6366 |
|
|
@item STT_OBJECT
|
6367 |
|
|
@itemx object
|
6368 |
|
|
Mark the symbol as being a data object.
|
6369 |
|
|
|
6370 |
|
|
@item STT_TLS
|
6371 |
|
|
@itemx tls_object
|
6372 |
|
|
Mark the symbol as being a thead-local data object.
|
6373 |
|
|
|
6374 |
|
|
@item STT_COMMON
|
6375 |
|
|
@itemx common
|
6376 |
|
|
Mark the symbol as being a common data object.
|
6377 |
|
|
|
6378 |
|
|
@item STT_NOTYPE
|
6379 |
|
|
@itemx notype
|
6380 |
|
|
Does not mark the symbol in any way. It is supported just for completeness.
|
6381 |
|
|
|
6382 |
|
|
@item gnu_unique_object
|
6383 |
|
|
Marks the symbol as being a globally unique data object. The dynamic linker
|
6384 |
|
|
will make sure that in the entire process there is just one symbol with this
|
6385 |
|
|
name and type in use. (This is only supported on Linux targeted assemblers).
|
6386 |
|
|
|
6387 |
|
|
@end table
|
6388 |
|
|
|
6389 |
|
|
Note: Some targets support extra types in addition to those listed above.
|
6390 |
|
|
|
6391 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6392 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6393 |
|
|
|
6394 |
|
|
@node Uleb128
|
6395 |
|
|
@section @code{.uleb128 @var{expressions}}
|
6396 |
|
|
|
6397 |
|
|
@cindex @code{uleb128} directive
|
6398 |
|
|
@var{uleb128} stands for ``unsigned little endian base 128.'' This is a
|
6399 |
|
|
compact, variable length representation of numbers used by the DWARF
|
6400 |
|
|
symbolic debugging format. @xref{Sleb128, ,@code{.sleb128}}.
|
6401 |
|
|
|
6402 |
|
|
@ifset COFF
|
6403 |
|
|
@node Val
|
6404 |
|
|
@section @code{.val @var{addr}}
|
6405 |
|
|
|
6406 |
|
|
@cindex @code{val} directive
|
6407 |
|
|
@cindex COFF value attribute
|
6408 |
|
|
@cindex value attribute, COFF
|
6409 |
|
|
This directive, permitted only within @code{.def}/@code{.endef} pairs,
|
6410 |
|
|
records the address @var{addr} as the value attribute of a symbol table
|
6411 |
|
|
entry.
|
6412 |
|
|
@ifset BOUT
|
6413 |
|
|
|
6414 |
|
|
@samp{.val} is used only for COFF output; when @command{@value{AS}} is
|
6415 |
|
|
configured for @code{b.out}, it accepts this directive but ignores it.
|
6416 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6417 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6418 |
|
|
|
6419 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6420 |
|
|
@node Version
|
6421 |
|
|
@section @code{.version "@var{string}"}
|
6422 |
|
|
|
6423 |
|
|
@cindex @code{version} directive
|
6424 |
|
|
This directive creates a @code{.note} section and places into it an ELF
|
6425 |
|
|
formatted note of type NT_VERSION. The note's name is set to @code{string}.
|
6426 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6427 |
|
|
|
6428 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6429 |
|
|
@node VTableEntry
|
6430 |
|
|
@section @code{.vtable_entry @var{table}, @var{offset}}
|
6431 |
|
|
|
6432 |
|
|
@cindex @code{vtable_entry} directive
|
6433 |
|
|
This directive finds or creates a symbol @code{table} and creates a
|
6434 |
|
|
@code{VTABLE_ENTRY} relocation for it with an addend of @code{offset}.
|
6435 |
|
|
|
6436 |
|
|
@node VTableInherit
|
6437 |
|
|
@section @code{.vtable_inherit @var{child}, @var{parent}}
|
6438 |
|
|
|
6439 |
|
|
@cindex @code{vtable_inherit} directive
|
6440 |
|
|
This directive finds the symbol @code{child} and finds or creates the symbol
|
6441 |
|
|
@code{parent} and then creates a @code{VTABLE_INHERIT} relocation for the
|
6442 |
|
|
parent whose addend is the value of the child symbol. As a special case the
|
6443 |
|
|
parent name of @code{0} is treated as referring to the @code{*ABS*} section.
|
6444 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6445 |
|
|
|
6446 |
|
|
@node Warning
|
6447 |
|
|
@section @code{.warning "@var{string}"}
|
6448 |
|
|
@cindex warning directive
|
6449 |
|
|
Similar to the directive @code{.error}
|
6450 |
|
|
(@pxref{Error,,@code{.error "@var{string}"}}), but just emits a warning.
|
6451 |
|
|
|
6452 |
|
|
@node Weak
|
6453 |
|
|
@section @code{.weak @var{names}}
|
6454 |
|
|
|
6455 |
|
|
@cindex @code{weak} directive
|
6456 |
|
|
This directive sets the weak attribute on the comma separated list of symbol
|
6457 |
|
|
@code{names}. If the symbols do not already exist, they will be created.
|
6458 |
|
|
|
6459 |
|
|
On COFF targets other than PE, weak symbols are a GNU extension. This
|
6460 |
|
|
directive sets the weak attribute on the comma separated list of symbol
|
6461 |
|
|
@code{names}. If the symbols do not already exist, they will be created.
|
6462 |
|
|
|
6463 |
|
|
On the PE target, weak symbols are supported natively as weak aliases.
|
6464 |
|
|
When a weak symbol is created that is not an alias, GAS creates an
|
6465 |
|
|
alternate symbol to hold the default value.
|
6466 |
|
|
|
6467 |
|
|
@node Weakref
|
6468 |
|
|
@section @code{.weakref @var{alias}, @var{target}}
|
6469 |
|
|
|
6470 |
|
|
@cindex @code{weakref} directive
|
6471 |
|
|
This directive creates an alias to the target symbol that enables the symbol to
|
6472 |
|
|
be referenced with weak-symbol semantics, but without actually making it weak.
|
6473 |
|
|
If direct references or definitions of the symbol are present, then the symbol
|
6474 |
|
|
will not be weak, but if all references to it are through weak references, the
|
6475 |
|
|
symbol will be marked as weak in the symbol table.
|
6476 |
|
|
|
6477 |
|
|
The effect is equivalent to moving all references to the alias to a separate
|
6478 |
|
|
assembly source file, renaming the alias to the symbol in it, declaring the
|
6479 |
|
|
symbol as weak there, and running a reloadable link to merge the object files
|
6480 |
|
|
resulting from the assembly of the new source file and the old source file that
|
6481 |
|
|
had the references to the alias removed.
|
6482 |
|
|
|
6483 |
|
|
The alias itself never makes to the symbol table, and is entirely handled
|
6484 |
|
|
within the assembler.
|
6485 |
|
|
|
6486 |
|
|
@node Word
|
6487 |
|
|
@section @code{.word @var{expressions}}
|
6488 |
|
|
|
6489 |
|
|
@cindex @code{word} directive
|
6490 |
|
|
This directive expects zero or more @var{expressions}, of any section,
|
6491 |
|
|
separated by commas.
|
6492 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
6493 |
|
|
@ifset W32
|
6494 |
|
|
For each expression, @command{@value{AS}} emits a 32-bit number.
|
6495 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6496 |
|
|
@ifset W16
|
6497 |
|
|
For each expression, @command{@value{AS}} emits a 16-bit number.
|
6498 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6499 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
6500 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
6501 |
|
|
|
6502 |
|
|
The size of the number emitted, and its byte order,
|
6503 |
|
|
depend on what target computer the assembly is for.
|
6504 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6505 |
|
|
|
6506 |
|
|
@c on amd29k, i960, sparc the "special treatment to support compilers" doesn't
|
6507 |
|
|
@c happen---32-bit addressability, period; no long/short jumps.
|
6508 |
|
|
@ifset DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
6509 |
|
|
@cindex difference tables altered
|
6510 |
|
|
@cindex altered difference tables
|
6511 |
|
|
@quotation
|
6512 |
|
|
@emph{Warning: Special Treatment to support Compilers}
|
6513 |
|
|
@end quotation
|
6514 |
|
|
|
6515 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
6516 |
|
|
Machines with a 32-bit address space, but that do less than 32-bit
|
6517 |
|
|
addressing, require the following special treatment. If the machine of
|
6518 |
|
|
interest to you does 32-bit addressing (or doesn't require it;
|
6519 |
|
|
@pxref{Machine Dependencies}), you can ignore this issue.
|
6520 |
|
|
|
6521 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6522 |
|
|
In order to assemble compiler output into something that works,
|
6523 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} occasionally does strange things to @samp{.word} directives.
|
6524 |
|
|
Directives of the form @samp{.word sym1-sym2} are often emitted by
|
6525 |
|
|
compilers as part of jump tables. Therefore, when @command{@value{AS}} assembles a
|
6526 |
|
|
directive of the form @samp{.word sym1-sym2}, and the difference between
|
6527 |
|
|
@code{sym1} and @code{sym2} does not fit in 16 bits, @command{@value{AS}}
|
6528 |
|
|
creates a @dfn{secondary jump table}, immediately before the next label.
|
6529 |
|
|
This secondary jump table is preceded by a short-jump to the
|
6530 |
|
|
first byte after the secondary table. This short-jump prevents the flow
|
6531 |
|
|
of control from accidentally falling into the new table. Inside the
|
6532 |
|
|
table is a long-jump to @code{sym2}. The original @samp{.word}
|
6533 |
|
|
contains @code{sym1} minus the address of the long-jump to
|
6534 |
|
|
@code{sym2}.
|
6535 |
|
|
|
6536 |
|
|
If there were several occurrences of @samp{.word sym1-sym2} before the
|
6537 |
|
|
secondary jump table, all of them are adjusted. If there was a
|
6538 |
|
|
@samp{.word sym3-sym4}, that also did not fit in sixteen bits, a
|
6539 |
|
|
long-jump to @code{sym4} is included in the secondary jump table,
|
6540 |
|
|
and the @code{.word} directives are adjusted to contain @code{sym3}
|
6541 |
|
|
minus the address of the long-jump to @code{sym4}; and so on, for as many
|
6542 |
|
|
entries in the original jump table as necessary.
|
6543 |
|
|
|
6544 |
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
6545 |
|
|
@emph{This feature may be disabled by compiling @command{@value{AS}} with the
|
6546 |
|
|
@samp{-DWORKING_DOT_WORD} option.} This feature is likely to confuse
|
6547 |
|
|
assembly language programmers.
|
6548 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6549 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6550 |
|
|
@c end DIFF-TBL-KLUGE
|
6551 |
|
|
|
6552 |
|
|
@node Deprecated
|
6553 |
|
|
@section Deprecated Directives
|
6554 |
|
|
|
6555 |
|
|
@cindex deprecated directives
|
6556 |
|
|
@cindex obsolescent directives
|
6557 |
|
|
One day these directives won't work.
|
6558 |
|
|
They are included for compatibility with older assemblers.
|
6559 |
|
|
@table @t
|
6560 |
|
|
@item .abort
|
6561 |
|
|
@item .line
|
6562 |
|
|
@end table
|
6563 |
|
|
|
6564 |
|
|
@ifset ELF
|
6565 |
|
|
@node Object Attributes
|
6566 |
|
|
@chapter Object Attributes
|
6567 |
|
|
@cindex object attributes
|
6568 |
|
|
|
6569 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} assembles source files written for a specific architecture
|
6570 |
|
|
into object files for that architecture. But not all object files are alike.
|
6571 |
|
|
Many architectures support incompatible variations. For instance, floating
|
6572 |
|
|
point arguments might be passed in floating point registers if the object file
|
6573 |
|
|
requires hardware floating point support---or floating point arguments might be
|
6574 |
|
|
passed in integer registers if the object file supports processors with no
|
6575 |
|
|
hardware floating point unit. Or, if two objects are built for different
|
6576 |
|
|
generations of the same architecture, the combination may require the
|
6577 |
|
|
newer generation at run-time.
|
6578 |
|
|
|
6579 |
|
|
This information is useful during and after linking. At link time,
|
6580 |
|
|
@command{@value{LD}} can warn about incompatible object files. After link
|
6581 |
|
|
time, tools like @command{gdb} can use it to process the linked file
|
6582 |
|
|
correctly.
|
6583 |
|
|
|
6584 |
|
|
Compatibility information is recorded as a series of object attributes. Each
|
6585 |
|
|
attribute has a @dfn{vendor}, @dfn{tag}, and @dfn{value}. The vendor is a
|
6586 |
|
|
string, and indicates who sets the meaning of the tag. The tag is an integer,
|
6587 |
|
|
and indicates what property the attribute describes. The value may be a string
|
6588 |
|
|
or an integer, and indicates how the property affects this object. Missing
|
6589 |
|
|
attributes are the same as attributes with a zero value or empty string value.
|
6590 |
|
|
|
6591 |
|
|
Object attributes were developed as part of the ABI for the ARM Architecture.
|
6592 |
|
|
The file format is documented in @cite{ELF for the ARM Architecture}.
|
6593 |
|
|
|
6594 |
|
|
@menu
|
6595 |
|
|
* GNU Object Attributes:: @sc{gnu} Object Attributes
|
6596 |
|
|
* Defining New Object Attributes:: Defining New Object Attributes
|
6597 |
|
|
@end menu
|
6598 |
|
|
|
6599 |
|
|
@node GNU Object Attributes
|
6600 |
|
|
@section @sc{gnu} Object Attributes
|
6601 |
|
|
|
6602 |
|
|
The @code{.gnu_attribute} directive records an object attribute
|
6603 |
|
|
with vendor @samp{gnu}.
|
6604 |
|
|
|
6605 |
|
|
Except for @samp{Tag_compatibility}, which has both an integer and a string for
|
6606 |
|
|
its value, @sc{gnu} attributes have a string value if the tag number is odd and
|
6607 |
|
|
an integer value if the tag number is even. The second bit (@code{@var{tag} &
|
6608 |
|
|
2} is set for architecture-independent attributes and clear for
|
6609 |
|
|
architecture-dependent ones.
|
6610 |
|
|
|
6611 |
|
|
@subsection Common @sc{gnu} attributes
|
6612 |
|
|
|
6613 |
|
|
These attributes are valid on all architectures.
|
6614 |
|
|
|
6615 |
|
|
@table @r
|
6616 |
|
|
@item Tag_compatibility (32)
|
6617 |
|
|
The compatibility attribute takes an integer flag value and a vendor name. If
|
6618 |
|
|
the flag value is 0, the file is compatible with other toolchains. If it is 1,
|
6619 |
|
|
then the file is only compatible with the named toolchain. If it is greater
|
6620 |
|
|
than 1, the file can only be processed by other toolchains under some private
|
6621 |
|
|
arrangement indicated by the flag value and the vendor name.
|
6622 |
|
|
@end table
|
6623 |
|
|
|
6624 |
|
|
@subsection MIPS Attributes
|
6625 |
|
|
|
6626 |
|
|
@table @r
|
6627 |
|
|
@item Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP (4)
|
6628 |
|
|
The floating-point ABI used by this object file. The value will be:
|
6629 |
|
|
|
6630 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
6631 |
|
|
@item
|
6632 |
|
|
|
6633 |
|
|
@item
|
6634 |
|
|
1 for files using the hardware floating-point with a standard double-precision
|
6635 |
|
|
FPU.
|
6636 |
|
|
@item
|
6637 |
|
|
2 for files using the hardware floating-point ABI with a single-precision FPU.
|
6638 |
|
|
@item
|
6639 |
|
|
3 for files using the software floating-point ABI.
|
6640 |
|
|
@item
|
6641 |
|
|
4 for files using the hardware floating-point ABI with 64-bit wide
|
6642 |
|
|
double-precision floating-point registers and 32-bit wide general
|
6643 |
|
|
purpose registers.
|
6644 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
6645 |
|
|
@end table
|
6646 |
|
|
|
6647 |
|
|
@subsection PowerPC Attributes
|
6648 |
|
|
|
6649 |
|
|
@table @r
|
6650 |
|
|
@item Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP (4)
|
6651 |
|
|
The floating-point ABI used by this object file. The value will be:
|
6652 |
|
|
|
6653 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
6654 |
|
|
@item
|
6655 |
|
|
|
6656 |
|
|
@item
|
6657 |
|
|
1 for files using double-precision hardware floating-point ABI.
|
6658 |
|
|
@item
|
6659 |
|
|
2 for files using the software floating-point ABI.
|
6660 |
|
|
@item
|
6661 |
|
|
3 for files using single-precision hardware floating-point ABI.
|
6662 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
6663 |
|
|
|
6664 |
|
|
@item Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector (8)
|
6665 |
|
|
The vector ABI used by this object file. The value will be:
|
6666 |
|
|
|
6667 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
6668 |
|
|
@item
|
6669 |
|
|
|
6670 |
|
|
@item
|
6671 |
|
|
1 for files using general purpose registers to pass vectors.
|
6672 |
|
|
@item
|
6673 |
|
|
2 for files using AltiVec registers to pass vectors.
|
6674 |
|
|
@item
|
6675 |
|
|
3 for files using SPE registers to pass vectors.
|
6676 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
6677 |
|
|
@end table
|
6678 |
|
|
|
6679 |
|
|
@node Defining New Object Attributes
|
6680 |
|
|
@section Defining New Object Attributes
|
6681 |
|
|
|
6682 |
|
|
If you want to define a new @sc{gnu} object attribute, here are the places you
|
6683 |
|
|
will need to modify. New attributes should be discussed on the @samp{binutils}
|
6684 |
|
|
mailing list.
|
6685 |
|
|
|
6686 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
6687 |
|
|
@item
|
6688 |
|
|
This manual, which is the official register of attributes.
|
6689 |
|
|
@item
|
6690 |
|
|
The header for your architecture @file{include/elf}, to define the tag.
|
6691 |
|
|
@item
|
6692 |
|
|
The @file{bfd} support file for your architecture, to merge the attribute
|
6693 |
|
|
and issue any appropriate link warnings.
|
6694 |
|
|
@item
|
6695 |
|
|
Test cases in @file{ld/testsuite} for merging and link warnings.
|
6696 |
|
|
@item
|
6697 |
|
|
@file{binutils/readelf.c} to display your attribute.
|
6698 |
|
|
@item
|
6699 |
|
|
GCC, if you want the compiler to mark the attribute automatically.
|
6700 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
6701 |
|
|
|
6702 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6703 |
|
|
|
6704 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
6705 |
|
|
@node Machine Dependencies
|
6706 |
|
|
@chapter Machine Dependent Features
|
6707 |
|
|
|
6708 |
|
|
@cindex machine dependencies
|
6709 |
|
|
The machine instruction sets are (almost by definition) different on
|
6710 |
|
|
each machine where @command{@value{AS}} runs. Floating point representations
|
6711 |
|
|
vary as well, and @command{@value{AS}} often supports a few additional
|
6712 |
|
|
directives or command-line options for compatibility with other
|
6713 |
|
|
assemblers on a particular platform. Finally, some versions of
|
6714 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} support special pseudo-instructions for branch
|
6715 |
|
|
optimization.
|
6716 |
|
|
|
6717 |
|
|
This chapter discusses most of these differences, though it does not
|
6718 |
|
|
include details on any machine's instruction set. For details on that
|
6719 |
|
|
subject, see the hardware manufacturer's manual.
|
6720 |
|
|
|
6721 |
|
|
@menu
|
6722 |
|
|
@ifset ALPHA
|
6723 |
|
|
* Alpha-Dependent:: Alpha Dependent Features
|
6724 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6725 |
|
|
@ifset ARC
|
6726 |
|
|
* ARC-Dependent:: ARC Dependent Features
|
6727 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6728 |
|
|
@ifset ARM
|
6729 |
|
|
* ARM-Dependent:: ARM Dependent Features
|
6730 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6731 |
|
|
@ifset AVR
|
6732 |
|
|
* AVR-Dependent:: AVR Dependent Features
|
6733 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6734 |
|
|
@ifset Blackfin
|
6735 |
|
|
* Blackfin-Dependent:: Blackfin Dependent Features
|
6736 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6737 |
|
|
@ifset CR16
|
6738 |
|
|
* CR16-Dependent:: CR16 Dependent Features
|
6739 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6740 |
|
|
@ifset CRIS
|
6741 |
|
|
* CRIS-Dependent:: CRIS Dependent Features
|
6742 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6743 |
|
|
@ifset D10V
|
6744 |
|
|
* D10V-Dependent:: D10V Dependent Features
|
6745 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6746 |
|
|
@ifset D30V
|
6747 |
|
|
* D30V-Dependent:: D30V Dependent Features
|
6748 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6749 |
|
|
@ifset H8/300
|
6750 |
|
|
* H8/300-Dependent:: Renesas H8/300 Dependent Features
|
6751 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6752 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
6753 |
|
|
* HPPA-Dependent:: HPPA Dependent Features
|
6754 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6755 |
|
|
@ifset I370
|
6756 |
|
|
* ESA/390-Dependent:: IBM ESA/390 Dependent Features
|
6757 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6758 |
|
|
@ifset I80386
|
6759 |
|
|
* i386-Dependent:: Intel 80386 and AMD x86-64 Dependent Features
|
6760 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6761 |
|
|
@ifset I860
|
6762 |
|
|
* i860-Dependent:: Intel 80860 Dependent Features
|
6763 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6764 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
6765 |
|
|
* i960-Dependent:: Intel 80960 Dependent Features
|
6766 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6767 |
|
|
@ifset IA64
|
6768 |
|
|
* IA-64-Dependent:: Intel IA-64 Dependent Features
|
6769 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6770 |
|
|
@ifset IP2K
|
6771 |
|
|
* IP2K-Dependent:: IP2K Dependent Features
|
6772 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6773 |
|
|
@ifset LM32
|
6774 |
|
|
* LM32-Dependent:: LM32 Dependent Features
|
6775 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6776 |
|
|
@ifset M32C
|
6777 |
|
|
* M32C-Dependent:: M32C Dependent Features
|
6778 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6779 |
|
|
@ifset M32R
|
6780 |
|
|
* M32R-Dependent:: M32R Dependent Features
|
6781 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6782 |
|
|
@ifset M680X0
|
6783 |
|
|
* M68K-Dependent:: M680x0 Dependent Features
|
6784 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6785 |
|
|
@ifset M68HC11
|
6786 |
|
|
* M68HC11-Dependent:: M68HC11 and 68HC12 Dependent Features
|
6787 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6788 |
|
|
@ifset MICROBLAZE
|
6789 |
|
|
* MicroBlaze-Dependent:: MICROBLAZE Dependent Features
|
6790 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6791 |
|
|
@ifset MIPS
|
6792 |
|
|
* MIPS-Dependent:: MIPS Dependent Features
|
6793 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6794 |
|
|
@ifset MMIX
|
6795 |
|
|
* MMIX-Dependent:: MMIX Dependent Features
|
6796 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6797 |
|
|
@ifset MSP430
|
6798 |
|
|
* MSP430-Dependent:: MSP430 Dependent Features
|
6799 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6800 |
|
|
@ifset SH
|
6801 |
|
|
* SH-Dependent:: Renesas / SuperH SH Dependent Features
|
6802 |
|
|
* SH64-Dependent:: SuperH SH64 Dependent Features
|
6803 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6804 |
|
|
@ifset PDP11
|
6805 |
|
|
* PDP-11-Dependent:: PDP-11 Dependent Features
|
6806 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6807 |
|
|
@ifset PJ
|
6808 |
|
|
* PJ-Dependent:: picoJava Dependent Features
|
6809 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6810 |
|
|
@ifset PPC
|
6811 |
|
|
* PPC-Dependent:: PowerPC Dependent Features
|
6812 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6813 |
|
|
@ifset S390
|
6814 |
|
|
* S/390-Dependent:: IBM S/390 Dependent Features
|
6815 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6816 |
|
|
@ifset SCORE
|
6817 |
|
|
* SCORE-Dependent:: SCORE Dependent Features
|
6818 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6819 |
|
|
@ifset SPARC
|
6820 |
|
|
* Sparc-Dependent:: SPARC Dependent Features
|
6821 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6822 |
|
|
@ifset TIC54X
|
6823 |
|
|
* TIC54X-Dependent:: TI TMS320C54x Dependent Features
|
6824 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6825 |
|
|
@ifset V850
|
6826 |
|
|
* V850-Dependent:: V850 Dependent Features
|
6827 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6828 |
|
|
@ifset XTENSA
|
6829 |
|
|
* Xtensa-Dependent:: Xtensa Dependent Features
|
6830 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6831 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
6832 |
|
|
* Z80-Dependent:: Z80 Dependent Features
|
6833 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6834 |
|
|
@ifset Z8000
|
6835 |
|
|
* Z8000-Dependent:: Z8000 Dependent Features
|
6836 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6837 |
|
|
@ifset VAX
|
6838 |
|
|
* Vax-Dependent:: VAX Dependent Features
|
6839 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6840 |
|
|
@end menu
|
6841 |
|
|
|
6842 |
|
|
@lowersections
|
6843 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6844 |
|
|
|
6845 |
|
|
@c The following major nodes are *sections* in the GENERIC version, *chapters*
|
6846 |
|
|
@c in single-cpu versions. This is mainly achieved by @lowersections. There is a
|
6847 |
|
|
@c peculiarity: to preserve cross-references, there must be a node called
|
6848 |
|
|
@c "Machine Dependencies". Hence the conditional nodenames in each
|
6849 |
|
|
@c major node below. Node defaulting in makeinfo requires adjacency of
|
6850 |
|
|
@c node and sectioning commands; hence the repetition of @chapter BLAH
|
6851 |
|
|
@c in both conditional blocks.
|
6852 |
|
|
|
6853 |
|
|
@ifset ALPHA
|
6854 |
|
|
@include c-alpha.texi
|
6855 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6856 |
|
|
|
6857 |
|
|
@ifset ARC
|
6858 |
|
|
@include c-arc.texi
|
6859 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6860 |
|
|
|
6861 |
|
|
@ifset ARM
|
6862 |
|
|
@include c-arm.texi
|
6863 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6864 |
|
|
|
6865 |
|
|
@ifset AVR
|
6866 |
|
|
@include c-avr.texi
|
6867 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6868 |
|
|
|
6869 |
|
|
@ifset Blackfin
|
6870 |
|
|
@include c-bfin.texi
|
6871 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6872 |
|
|
|
6873 |
|
|
@ifset CR16
|
6874 |
|
|
@include c-cr16.texi
|
6875 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6876 |
|
|
|
6877 |
|
|
@ifset CRIS
|
6878 |
|
|
@include c-cris.texi
|
6879 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6880 |
|
|
|
6881 |
|
|
@ifset Renesas-all
|
6882 |
|
|
@ifclear GENERIC
|
6883 |
|
|
@node Machine Dependencies
|
6884 |
|
|
@chapter Machine Dependent Features
|
6885 |
|
|
|
6886 |
|
|
The machine instruction sets are different on each Renesas chip family,
|
6887 |
|
|
and there are also some syntax differences among the families. This
|
6888 |
|
|
chapter describes the specific @command{@value{AS}} features for each
|
6889 |
|
|
family.
|
6890 |
|
|
|
6891 |
|
|
@menu
|
6892 |
|
|
* H8/300-Dependent:: Renesas H8/300 Dependent Features
|
6893 |
|
|
* SH-Dependent:: Renesas SH Dependent Features
|
6894 |
|
|
@end menu
|
6895 |
|
|
@lowersections
|
6896 |
|
|
@end ifclear
|
6897 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6898 |
|
|
|
6899 |
|
|
@ifset D10V
|
6900 |
|
|
@include c-d10v.texi
|
6901 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6902 |
|
|
|
6903 |
|
|
@ifset D30V
|
6904 |
|
|
@include c-d30v.texi
|
6905 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6906 |
|
|
|
6907 |
|
|
@ifset H8/300
|
6908 |
|
|
@include c-h8300.texi
|
6909 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6910 |
|
|
|
6911 |
|
|
@ifset HPPA
|
6912 |
|
|
@include c-hppa.texi
|
6913 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6914 |
|
|
|
6915 |
|
|
@ifset I370
|
6916 |
|
|
@include c-i370.texi
|
6917 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6918 |
|
|
|
6919 |
|
|
@ifset I80386
|
6920 |
|
|
@include c-i386.texi
|
6921 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6922 |
|
|
|
6923 |
|
|
@ifset I860
|
6924 |
|
|
@include c-i860.texi
|
6925 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6926 |
|
|
|
6927 |
|
|
@ifset I960
|
6928 |
|
|
@include c-i960.texi
|
6929 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6930 |
|
|
|
6931 |
|
|
@ifset IA64
|
6932 |
|
|
@include c-ia64.texi
|
6933 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6934 |
|
|
|
6935 |
|
|
@ifset IP2K
|
6936 |
|
|
@include c-ip2k.texi
|
6937 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6938 |
|
|
|
6939 |
|
|
@ifset LM32
|
6940 |
|
|
@include c-lm32.texi
|
6941 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6942 |
|
|
|
6943 |
|
|
@ifset M32C
|
6944 |
|
|
@include c-m32c.texi
|
6945 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6946 |
|
|
|
6947 |
|
|
@ifset M32R
|
6948 |
|
|
@include c-m32r.texi
|
6949 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6950 |
|
|
|
6951 |
|
|
@ifset M680X0
|
6952 |
|
|
@include c-m68k.texi
|
6953 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6954 |
|
|
|
6955 |
|
|
@ifset M68HC11
|
6956 |
|
|
@include c-m68hc11.texi
|
6957 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6958 |
|
|
|
6959 |
|
|
@ifset MICROBLAZE
|
6960 |
|
|
@include c-microblaze.texi
|
6961 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6962 |
|
|
|
6963 |
|
|
@ifset MIPS
|
6964 |
|
|
@include c-mips.texi
|
6965 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6966 |
|
|
|
6967 |
|
|
@ifset MMIX
|
6968 |
|
|
@include c-mmix.texi
|
6969 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6970 |
|
|
|
6971 |
|
|
@ifset MSP430
|
6972 |
|
|
@include c-msp430.texi
|
6973 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6974 |
|
|
|
6975 |
|
|
@ifset NS32K
|
6976 |
|
|
@include c-ns32k.texi
|
6977 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6978 |
|
|
|
6979 |
|
|
@ifset PDP11
|
6980 |
|
|
@include c-pdp11.texi
|
6981 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6982 |
|
|
|
6983 |
|
|
@ifset PJ
|
6984 |
|
|
@include c-pj.texi
|
6985 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6986 |
|
|
|
6987 |
|
|
@ifset PPC
|
6988 |
|
|
@include c-ppc.texi
|
6989 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6990 |
|
|
|
6991 |
|
|
@ifset S390
|
6992 |
|
|
@include c-s390.texi
|
6993 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6994 |
|
|
|
6995 |
|
|
@ifset SCORE
|
6996 |
|
|
@include c-score.texi
|
6997 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
6998 |
|
|
|
6999 |
|
|
@ifset SH
|
7000 |
|
|
@include c-sh.texi
|
7001 |
|
|
@include c-sh64.texi
|
7002 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7003 |
|
|
|
7004 |
|
|
@ifset SPARC
|
7005 |
|
|
@include c-sparc.texi
|
7006 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7007 |
|
|
|
7008 |
|
|
@ifset TIC54X
|
7009 |
|
|
@include c-tic54x.texi
|
7010 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7011 |
|
|
|
7012 |
|
|
@ifset Z80
|
7013 |
|
|
@include c-z80.texi
|
7014 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7015 |
|
|
|
7016 |
|
|
@ifset Z8000
|
7017 |
|
|
@include c-z8k.texi
|
7018 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7019 |
|
|
|
7020 |
|
|
@ifset VAX
|
7021 |
|
|
@include c-vax.texi
|
7022 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7023 |
|
|
|
7024 |
|
|
@ifset V850
|
7025 |
|
|
@include c-v850.texi
|
7026 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7027 |
|
|
|
7028 |
|
|
@ifset XTENSA
|
7029 |
|
|
@include c-xtensa.texi
|
7030 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7031 |
|
|
|
7032 |
|
|
@ifset GENERIC
|
7033 |
|
|
@c reverse effect of @down at top of generic Machine-Dep chapter
|
7034 |
|
|
@raisesections
|
7035 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7036 |
|
|
|
7037 |
|
|
@node Reporting Bugs
|
7038 |
|
|
@chapter Reporting Bugs
|
7039 |
|
|
@cindex bugs in assembler
|
7040 |
|
|
@cindex reporting bugs in assembler
|
7041 |
|
|
|
7042 |
|
|
Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{@value{AS}} reliable.
|
7043 |
|
|
|
7044 |
|
|
Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it may
|
7045 |
|
|
not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help the
|
7046 |
|
|
entire community by making the next version of @command{@value{AS}} work better.
|
7047 |
|
|
Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @command{@value{AS}}.
|
7048 |
|
|
|
7049 |
|
|
In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
|
7050 |
|
|
information that enables us to fix the bug.
|
7051 |
|
|
|
7052 |
|
|
@menu
|
7053 |
|
|
* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
|
7054 |
|
|
* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
|
7055 |
|
|
@end menu
|
7056 |
|
|
|
7057 |
|
|
@node Bug Criteria
|
7058 |
|
|
@section Have You Found a Bug?
|
7059 |
|
|
@cindex bug criteria
|
7060 |
|
|
|
7061 |
|
|
If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
|
7062 |
|
|
|
7063 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
7064 |
|
|
@cindex fatal signal
|
7065 |
|
|
@cindex assembler crash
|
7066 |
|
|
@cindex crash of assembler
|
7067 |
|
|
@item
|
7068 |
|
|
If the assembler gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
|
7069 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} bug. Reliable assemblers never crash.
|
7070 |
|
|
|
7071 |
|
|
@cindex error on valid input
|
7072 |
|
|
@item
|
7073 |
|
|
If @command{@value{AS}} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
|
7074 |
|
|
|
7075 |
|
|
@cindex invalid input
|
7076 |
|
|
@item
|
7077 |
|
|
If @command{@value{AS}} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
|
7078 |
|
|
is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of ``invalid input'' might
|
7079 |
|
|
be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support for traditional practice''.
|
7080 |
|
|
|
7081 |
|
|
@item
|
7082 |
|
|
If you are an experienced user of assemblers, your suggestions for improvement
|
7083 |
|
|
of @command{@value{AS}} are welcome in any case.
|
7084 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
7085 |
|
|
|
7086 |
|
|
@node Bug Reporting
|
7087 |
|
|
@section How to Report Bugs
|
7088 |
|
|
@cindex bug reports
|
7089 |
|
|
@cindex assembler bugs, reporting
|
7090 |
|
|
|
7091 |
|
|
A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products. If
|
7092 |
|
|
you obtained @command{@value{AS}} from a support organization, we recommend you
|
7093 |
|
|
contact that organization first.
|
7094 |
|
|
|
7095 |
|
|
You can find contact information for many support companies and
|
7096 |
|
|
individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
|
7097 |
|
|
distribution.
|
7098 |
|
|
|
7099 |
|
|
@ifset BUGURL
|
7100 |
|
|
In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for @command{@value{AS}}
|
7101 |
|
|
to @value{BUGURL}.
|
7102 |
|
|
@end ifset
|
7103 |
|
|
|
7104 |
|
|
The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
|
7105 |
|
|
@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
|
7106 |
|
|
fact or leave it out, state it!
|
7107 |
|
|
|
7108 |
|
|
Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the problem
|
7109 |
|
|
and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might assume that the
|
7110 |
|
|
name of a symbol you use in an example does not matter. Well, probably it does
|
7111 |
|
|
not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a stray memory reference which
|
7112 |
|
|
happens to fetch from the location where that name is stored in memory;
|
7113 |
|
|
perhaps, if the name were different, the contents of that location would fool
|
7114 |
|
|
the assembler into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and
|
7115 |
|
|
give a specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
|
7116 |
|
|
and the most helpful.
|
7117 |
|
|
|
7118 |
|
|
Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the bug if
|
7119 |
|
|
it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports on the assumption
|
7120 |
|
|
that the bug has not been reported previously.
|
7121 |
|
|
|
7122 |
|
|
Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
|
7123 |
|
|
bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
|
7124 |
|
|
respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
|
7125 |
|
|
You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
|
7126 |
|
|
|
7127 |
|
|
To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
|
7128 |
|
|
|
7129 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
7130 |
|
|
@item
|
7131 |
|
|
The version of @command{@value{AS}}. @command{@value{AS}} announces it if you start
|
7132 |
|
|
it with the @samp{--version} argument.
|
7133 |
|
|
|
7134 |
|
|
Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
|
7135 |
|
|
the bug in the current version of @command{@value{AS}}.
|
7136 |
|
|
|
7137 |
|
|
@item
|
7138 |
|
|
Any patches you may have applied to the @command{@value{AS}} source.
|
7139 |
|
|
|
7140 |
|
|
@item
|
7141 |
|
|
The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
|
7142 |
|
|
version number.
|
7143 |
|
|
|
7144 |
|
|
@item
|
7145 |
|
|
What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{@value{AS}}---e.g.
|
7146 |
|
|
``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
|
7147 |
|
|
|
7148 |
|
|
@item
|
7149 |
|
|
The command arguments you gave the assembler to assemble your example and
|
7150 |
|
|
observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important, list them
|
7151 |
|
|
all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
|
7152 |
|
|
|
7153 |
|
|
If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
|
7154 |
|
|
and then we might not encounter the bug.
|
7155 |
|
|
|
7156 |
|
|
@item
|
7157 |
|
|
A complete input file that will reproduce the bug. If the bug is observed when
|
7158 |
|
|
the assembler is invoked via a compiler, send the assembler source, not the
|
7159 |
|
|
high level language source. Most compilers will produce the assembler source
|
7160 |
|
|
when run with the @samp{-S} option. If you are using @code{@value{GCC}}, use
|
7161 |
|
|
the options @samp{-v --save-temps}; this will save the assembler source in a
|
7162 |
|
|
file with an extension of @file{.s}, and also show you exactly how
|
7163 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is being run.
|
7164 |
|
|
|
7165 |
|
|
@item
|
7166 |
|
|
A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
|
7167 |
|
|
incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
|
7168 |
|
|
|
7169 |
|
|
Of course, if the bug is that @command{@value{AS}} gets a fatal signal, then we
|
7170 |
|
|
will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might not
|
7171 |
|
|
notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us a chance to
|
7172 |
|
|
make a mistake.
|
7173 |
|
|
|
7174 |
|
|
Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still say so
|
7175 |
|
|
explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your copy of
|
7176 |
|
|
@command{@value{AS}} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the C
|
7177 |
|
|
library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash and ours
|
7178 |
|
|
would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours fails to crash, we
|
7179 |
|
|
would know that the bug was not happening for us. If you had not told us to
|
7180 |
|
|
expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw any conclusion from our
|
7181 |
|
|
observations.
|
7182 |
|
|
|
7183 |
|
|
@item
|
7184 |
|
|
If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{@value{AS}} source, send us context
|
7185 |
|
|
diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or @samp{-p}
|
7186 |
|
|
option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file. If you even
|
7187 |
|
|
discuss something in the @command{@value{AS}} source, refer to it by context, not
|
7188 |
|
|
by line number.
|
7189 |
|
|
|
7190 |
|
|
The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
|
7191 |
|
|
sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
|
7192 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
7193 |
|
|
|
7194 |
|
|
Here are some things that are not necessary:
|
7195 |
|
|
|
7196 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
7197 |
|
|
@item
|
7198 |
|
|
A description of the envelope of the bug.
|
7199 |
|
|
|
7200 |
|
|
Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
|
7201 |
|
|
which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
|
7202 |
|
|
changes will not affect it.
|
7203 |
|
|
|
7204 |
|
|
This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
|
7205 |
|
|
will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
|
7206 |
|
|
with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
|
7207 |
|
|
We recommend that you save your time for something else.
|
7208 |
|
|
|
7209 |
|
|
Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
|
7210 |
|
|
of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
|
7211 |
|
|
output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
|
7212 |
|
|
less time, and so on.
|
7213 |
|
|
|
7214 |
|
|
However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
|
7215 |
|
|
report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
|
7216 |
|
|
|
7217 |
|
|
@item
|
7218 |
|
|
A patch for the bug.
|
7219 |
|
|
|
7220 |
|
|
A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
|
7221 |
|
|
the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
|
7222 |
|
|
a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
|
7223 |
|
|
to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
|
7224 |
|
|
|
7225 |
|
|
Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{@value{AS}} it is very hard to
|
7226 |
|
|
construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path through
|
7227 |
|
|
the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able to construct
|
7228 |
|
|
one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
|
7229 |
|
|
|
7230 |
|
|
And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
|
7231 |
|
|
patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
|
7232 |
|
|
help us to understand.
|
7233 |
|
|
|
7234 |
|
|
@item
|
7235 |
|
|
A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
|
7236 |
|
|
|
7237 |
|
|
Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
|
7238 |
|
|
things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
|
7239 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
7240 |
|
|
|
7241 |
|
|
@node Acknowledgements
|
7242 |
|
|
@chapter Acknowledgements
|
7243 |
|
|
|
7244 |
|
|
If you have contributed to GAS and your name isn't listed here,
|
7245 |
|
|
it is not meant as a slight. We just don't know about it. Send mail to the
|
7246 |
|
|
maintainer, and we'll correct the situation. Currently
|
7247 |
|
|
@c (January 1994),
|
7248 |
|
|
the maintainer is Ken Raeburn (email address @code{raeburn@@cygnus.com}).
|
7249 |
|
|
|
7250 |
|
|
Dean Elsner wrote the original @sc{gnu} assembler for the VAX.@footnote{Any
|
7251 |
|
|
more details?}
|
7252 |
|
|
|
7253 |
|
|
Jay Fenlason maintained GAS for a while, adding support for GDB-specific debug
|
7254 |
|
|
information and the 68k series machines, most of the preprocessing pass, and
|
7255 |
|
|
extensive changes in @file{messages.c}, @file{input-file.c}, @file{write.c}.
|
7256 |
|
|
|
7257 |
|
|
K. Richard Pixley maintained GAS for a while, adding various enhancements and
|
7258 |
|
|
many bug fixes, including merging support for several processors, breaking GAS
|
7259 |
|
|
up to handle multiple object file format back ends (including heavy rewrite,
|
7260 |
|
|
testing, an integration of the coff and b.out back ends), adding configuration
|
7261 |
|
|
including heavy testing and verification of cross assemblers and file splits
|
7262 |
|
|
and renaming, converted GAS to strictly ANSI C including full prototypes, added
|
7263 |
|
|
support for m680[34]0 and cpu32, did considerable work on i960 including a COFF
|
7264 |
|
|
port (including considerable amounts of reverse engineering), a SPARC opcode
|
7265 |
|
|
file rewrite, DECstation, rs6000, and hp300hpux host ports, updated ``know''
|
7266 |
|
|
assertions and made them work, much other reorganization, cleanup, and lint.
|
7267 |
|
|
|
7268 |
|
|
Ken Raeburn wrote the high-level BFD interface code to replace most of the code
|
7269 |
|
|
in format-specific I/O modules.
|
7270 |
|
|
|
7271 |
|
|
The original VMS support was contributed by David L. Kashtan. Eric Youngdale
|
7272 |
|
|
has done much work with it since.
|
7273 |
|
|
|
7274 |
|
|
The Intel 80386 machine description was written by Eliot Dresselhaus.
|
7275 |
|
|
|
7276 |
|
|
Minh Tran-Le at IntelliCorp contributed some AIX 386 support.
|
7277 |
|
|
|
7278 |
|
|
The Motorola 88k machine description was contributed by Devon Bowen of Buffalo
|
7279 |
|
|
University and Torbjorn Granlund of the Swedish Institute of Computer Science.
|
7280 |
|
|
|
7281 |
|
|
Keith Knowles at the Open Software Foundation wrote the original MIPS back end
|
7282 |
|
|
(@file{tc-mips.c}, @file{tc-mips.h}), and contributed Rose format support
|
7283 |
|
|
(which hasn't been merged in yet). Ralph Campbell worked with the MIPS code to
|
7284 |
|
|
support a.out format.
|
7285 |
|
|
|
7286 |
|
|
Support for the Zilog Z8k and Renesas H8/300 processors (tc-z8k,
|
7287 |
|
|
tc-h8300), and IEEE 695 object file format (obj-ieee), was written by
|
7288 |
|
|
Steve Chamberlain of Cygnus Support. Steve also modified the COFF back end to
|
7289 |
|
|
use BFD for some low-level operations, for use with the H8/300 and AMD 29k
|
7290 |
|
|
targets.
|
7291 |
|
|
|
7292 |
|
|
John Gilmore built the AMD 29000 support, added @code{.include} support, and
|
7293 |
|
|
simplified the configuration of which versions accept which directives. He
|
7294 |
|
|
updated the 68k machine description so that Motorola's opcodes always produced
|
7295 |
|
|
fixed-size instructions (e.g., @code{jsr}), while synthetic instructions
|
7296 |
|
|
remained shrinkable (@code{jbsr}). John fixed many bugs, including true tested
|
7297 |
|
|
cross-compilation support, and one bug in relaxation that took a week and
|
7298 |
|
|
required the proverbial one-bit fix.
|
7299 |
|
|
|
7300 |
|
|
Ian Lance Taylor of Cygnus Support merged the Motorola and MIT syntax for the
|
7301 |
|
|
68k, completed support for some COFF targets (68k, i386 SVR3, and SCO Unix),
|
7302 |
|
|
added support for MIPS ECOFF and ELF targets, wrote the initial RS/6000 and
|
7303 |
|
|
PowerPC assembler, and made a few other minor patches.
|
7304 |
|
|
|
7305 |
|
|
Steve Chamberlain made GAS able to generate listings.
|
7306 |
|
|
|
7307 |
|
|
Hewlett-Packard contributed support for the HP9000/300.
|
7308 |
|
|
|
7309 |
|
|
Jeff Law wrote GAS and BFD support for the native HPPA object format (SOM)
|
7310 |
|
|
along with a fairly extensive HPPA testsuite (for both SOM and ELF object
|
7311 |
|
|
formats). This work was supported by both the Center for Software Science at
|
7312 |
|
|
the University of Utah and Cygnus Support.
|
7313 |
|
|
|
7314 |
|
|
Support for ELF format files has been worked on by Mark Eichin of Cygnus
|
7315 |
|
|
Support (original, incomplete implementation for SPARC), Pete Hoogenboom and
|
7316 |
|
|
Jeff Law at the University of Utah (HPPA mainly), Michael Meissner of the Open
|
7317 |
|
|
Software Foundation (i386 mainly), and Ken Raeburn of Cygnus Support (sparc,
|
7318 |
|
|
and some initial 64-bit support).
|
7319 |
|
|
|
7320 |
|
|
Linas Vepstas added GAS support for the ESA/390 ``IBM 370'' architecture.
|
7321 |
|
|
|
7322 |
|
|
Richard Henderson rewrote the Alpha assembler. Klaus Kaempf wrote GAS and BFD
|
7323 |
|
|
support for openVMS/Alpha.
|
7324 |
|
|
|
7325 |
|
|
Timothy Wall, Michael Hayes, and Greg Smart contributed to the various tic*
|
7326 |
|
|
flavors.
|
7327 |
|
|
|
7328 |
|
|
David Heine, Sterling Augustine, Bob Wilson and John Ruttenberg from Tensilica,
|
7329 |
|
|
Inc.@: added support for Xtensa processors.
|
7330 |
|
|
|
7331 |
|
|
Several engineers at Cygnus Support have also provided many small bug fixes and
|
7332 |
|
|
configuration enhancements.
|
7333 |
|
|
|
7334 |
|
|
Jon Beniston added support for the Lattice Mico32 architecture.
|
7335 |
|
|
|
7336 |
|
|
Many others have contributed large or small bugfixes and enhancements. If
|
7337 |
|
|
you have contributed significant work and are not mentioned on this list, and
|
7338 |
|
|
want to be, let us know. Some of the history has been lost; we are not
|
7339 |
|
|
intentionally leaving anyone out.
|
7340 |
|
|
|
7341 |
|
|
@node GNU Free Documentation License
|
7342 |
|
|
@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
|
7343 |
|
|
@include fdl.texi
|
7344 |
|
|
|
7345 |
|
|
@node AS Index
|
7346 |
|
|
@unnumbered AS Index
|
7347 |
|
|
|
7348 |
|
|
@printindex cp
|
7349 |
|
|
|
7350 |
|
|
@bye
|
7351 |
|
|
@c Local Variables:
|
7352 |
|
|
@c fill-column: 79
|
7353 |
|
|
@c End:
|